doc: enhance target types description
[openocd.git] / doc / openocd.texi
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c %**start of header
3 @setfilename openocd.info
4 @settitle OpenOCD User's Guide
5 @dircategory Development
6 @direntry
7 * OpenOCD: (openocd). OpenOCD User's Guide
8 @end direntry
9 @paragraphindent 0
10 @c %**end of header
11
12 @include version.texi
13
14 @copying
15
16 This User's Guide documents
17 release @value{VERSION},
18 dated @value{UPDATED},
19 of the Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD).
20
21 @itemize @bullet
22 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 The OpenOCD Project
23 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2007-2008 Spencer Oliver @email{spen@@spen-soft.co.uk}
24 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008-2010 Oyvind Harboe @email{oyvind.harboe@@zylin.com}
25 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 Duane Ellis @email{openocd@@duaneellis.com}
26 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2009-2010 David Brownell
27 @end itemize
28
29 @quotation
30 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
31 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.2 or
32 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
33 Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts, and with no Back-Cover
34 Texts. A copy of the license is included in the section entitled ``GNU
35 Free Documentation License''.
36 @end quotation
37 @end copying
38
39 @titlepage
40 @titlefont{@emph{Open On-Chip Debugger:}}
41 @sp 1
42 @title OpenOCD User's Guide
43 @subtitle for release @value{VERSION}
44 @subtitle @value{UPDATED}
45
46 @page
47 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
48 @insertcopying
49 @end titlepage
50
51 @summarycontents
52 @contents
53
54 @ifnottex
55 @node Top
56 @top OpenOCD User's Guide
57
58 @insertcopying
59 @end ifnottex
60
61 @menu
62 * About:: About OpenOCD
63 * Developers:: OpenOCD Developer Resources
64 * Debug Adapter Hardware:: Debug Adapter Hardware
65 * About Jim-Tcl:: About Jim-Tcl
66 * Running:: Running OpenOCD
67 * OpenOCD Project Setup:: OpenOCD Project Setup
68 * Config File Guidelines:: Config File Guidelines
69 * Server Configuration:: Server Configuration
70 * Debug Adapter Configuration:: Debug Adapter Configuration
71 * Reset Configuration:: Reset Configuration
72 * TAP Declaration:: TAP Declaration
73 * CPU Configuration:: CPU Configuration
74 * Flash Commands:: Flash Commands
75 * Flash Programming:: Flash Programming
76 * PLD/FPGA Commands:: PLD/FPGA Commands
77 * General Commands:: General Commands
78 * Architecture and Core Commands:: Architecture and Core Commands
79 * JTAG Commands:: JTAG Commands
80 * Boundary Scan Commands:: Boundary Scan Commands
81 * Utility Commands:: Utility Commands
82 * TFTP:: TFTP
83 * GDB and OpenOCD:: Using GDB and OpenOCD
84 * Tcl Scripting API:: Tcl Scripting API
85 * FAQ:: Frequently Asked Questions
86 * Tcl Crash Course:: Tcl Crash Course
87 * License:: GNU Free Documentation License
88
89 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
90 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
91 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
92 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
93 * OpenOCD Concept Index:: Concept Index
94 * Command and Driver Index:: Command and Driver Index
95 @end menu
96
97 @node About
98 @unnumbered About
99 @cindex about
100
101 OpenOCD was created by Dominic Rath as part of a 2005 diploma thesis written
102 at the University of Applied Sciences Augsburg (@uref{http://www.hs-augsburg.de}).
103 Since that time, the project has grown into an active open-source project,
104 supported by a diverse community of software and hardware developers from
105 around the world.
106
107 @section What is OpenOCD?
108 @cindex TAP
109 @cindex JTAG
110
111 The Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD) aims to provide debugging,
112 in-system programming and boundary-scan testing for embedded target
113 devices.
114
115 It does so with the assistance of a @dfn{debug adapter}, which is
116 a small hardware module which helps provide the right kind of
117 electrical signaling to the target being debugged. These are
118 required since the debug host (on which OpenOCD runs) won't
119 usually have native support for such signaling, or the connector
120 needed to hook up to the target.
121
122 Such debug adapters support one or more @dfn{transport} protocols,
123 each of which involves different electrical signaling (and uses
124 different messaging protocols on top of that signaling). There
125 are many types of debug adapter, and little uniformity in what
126 they are called. (There are also product naming differences.)
127
128 These adapters are sometimes packaged as discrete dongles, which
129 may generically be called @dfn{hardware interface dongles}.
130 Some development boards also integrate them directly, which may
131 let the development board connect directly to the debug
132 host over USB (and sometimes also to power it over USB).
133
134 For example, a @dfn{JTAG Adapter} supports JTAG
135 signaling, and is used to communicate
136 with JTAG (IEEE 1149.1) compliant TAPs on your target board.
137 A @dfn{TAP} is a ``Test Access Port'', a module which processes
138 special instructions and data. TAPs are daisy-chained within and
139 between chips and boards. JTAG supports debugging and boundary
140 scan operations.
141
142 There are also @dfn{SWD Adapters} that support Serial Wire Debug (SWD)
143 signaling to communicate with some newer ARM cores, as well as debug
144 adapters which support both JTAG and SWD transports. SWD supports only
145 debugging, whereas JTAG also supports boundary scan operations.
146
147 For some chips, there are also @dfn{Programming Adapters} supporting
148 special transports used only to write code to flash memory, without
149 support for on-chip debugging or boundary scan.
150 (At this writing, OpenOCD does not support such non-debug adapters.)
151
152
153 @b{Dongles:} OpenOCD currently supports many types of hardware dongles:
154 USB-based, parallel port-based, and other standalone boxes that run
155 OpenOCD internally. @xref{Debug Adapter Hardware}.
156
157 @b{GDB Debug:} It allows ARM7 (ARM7TDMI and ARM720t), ARM9 (ARM920T,
158 ARM922T, ARM926EJ--S, ARM966E--S), XScale (PXA25x, IXP42x), Cortex-M3
159 (Stellaris LM3, STMicroelectronics STM32 and Energy Micro EFM32) and
160 Intel Quark (x10xx) based cores to be debugged via the GDB protocol.
161
162 @b{Flash Programming:} Flash writing is supported for external
163 CFI-compatible NOR flashes (Intel and AMD/Spansion command set) and several
164 internal flashes (LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4300, AT91SAM7, AT91SAM3U,
165 STR7x, STR9x, LM3, STM32x and EFM32). Preliminary support for various NAND flash
166 controllers (LPC3180, Orion, S3C24xx, more) is included.
167
168 @section OpenOCD Web Site
169
170 The OpenOCD web site provides the latest public news from the community:
171
172 @uref{http://openocd.org/}
173
174 @section Latest User's Guide:
175
176 The user's guide you are now reading may not be the latest one
177 available. A version for more recent code may be available.
178 Its HTML form is published regularly at:
179
180 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/html/index.html}
181
182 PDF form is likewise published at:
183
184 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/pdf/openocd.pdf}
185
186 @section OpenOCD User's Forum
187
188 There is an OpenOCD forum (phpBB) hosted by SparkFun,
189 which might be helpful to you. Note that if you want
190 anything to come to the attention of developers, you
191 should post it to the OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
192 instead of this forum.
193
194 @uref{http://forum.sparkfun.com/viewforum.php?f=18}
195
196 @section OpenOCD User's Mailing List
197
198 The OpenOCD User Mailing List provides the primary means of
199 communication between users:
200
201 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-user}
202
203 @section OpenOCD IRC
204
205 Support can also be found on irc:
206 @uref{irc://irc.freenode.net/openocd}
207
208 @node Developers
209 @chapter OpenOCD Developer Resources
210 @cindex developers
211
212 If you are interested in improving the state of OpenOCD's debugging and
213 testing support, new contributions will be welcome. Motivated developers
214 can produce new target, flash or interface drivers, improve the
215 documentation, as well as more conventional bug fixes and enhancements.
216
217 The resources in this chapter are available for developers wishing to explore
218 or expand the OpenOCD source code.
219
220 @section OpenOCD Git Repository
221
222 During the 0.3.x release cycle, OpenOCD switched from Subversion to
223 a Git repository hosted at SourceForge. The repository URL is:
224
225 @uref{git://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
226
227 or via http
228
229 @uref{http://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
230
231 You may prefer to use a mirror and the HTTP protocol:
232
233 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/r/openocd.git}
234
235 With standard Git tools, use @command{git clone} to initialize
236 a local repository, and @command{git pull} to update it.
237 There are also gitweb pages letting you browse the repository
238 with a web browser, or download arbitrary snapshots without
239 needing a Git client:
240
241 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/w/openocd.git}
242
243 The @file{README} file contains the instructions for building the project
244 from the repository or a snapshot.
245
246 Developers that want to contribute patches to the OpenOCD system are
247 @b{strongly} encouraged to work against mainline.
248 Patches created against older versions may require additional
249 work from their submitter in order to be updated for newer releases.
250
251 @section Doxygen Developer Manual
252
253 During the 0.2.x release cycle, the OpenOCD project began
254 providing a Doxygen reference manual. This document contains more
255 technical information about the software internals, development
256 processes, and similar documentation:
257
258 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/html/index.html}
259
260 This document is a work-in-progress, but contributions would be welcome
261 to fill in the gaps. All of the source files are provided in-tree,
262 listed in the Doxyfile configuration at the top of the source tree.
263
264 @section Gerrit Review System
265
266 All changes in the OpenOCD Git repository go through the web-based Gerrit
267 Code Review System:
268
269 @uref{http://openocd.zylin.com/}
270
271 After a one-time registration and repository setup, anyone can push commits
272 from their local Git repository directly into Gerrit.
273 All users and developers are encouraged to review, test, discuss and vote
274 for changes in Gerrit. The feedback provides the basis for a maintainer to
275 eventually submit the change to the main Git repository.
276
277 The @file{HACKING} file, also available as the Patch Guide in the Doxygen
278 Developer Manual, contains basic information about how to connect a
279 repository to Gerrit, prepare and push patches. Patch authors are expected to
280 maintain their changes while they're in Gerrit, respond to feedback and if
281 necessary rework and push improved versions of the change.
282
283 @section OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
284
285 The OpenOCD Developer Mailing List provides the primary means of
286 communication between developers:
287
288 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-devel}
289
290 @section OpenOCD Bug Tracker
291
292 The OpenOCD Bug Tracker is hosted on SourceForge:
293
294 @uref{http://bugs.openocd.org/}
295
296
297 @node Debug Adapter Hardware
298 @chapter Debug Adapter Hardware
299 @cindex dongles
300 @cindex FTDI
301 @cindex wiggler
302 @cindex zy1000
303 @cindex printer port
304 @cindex USB Adapter
305 @cindex RTCK
306
307 Defined: @b{dongle}: A small device that plugs into a computer and serves as
308 an adapter .... [snip]
309
310 In the OpenOCD case, this generally refers to @b{a small adapter} that
311 attaches to your computer via USB or the parallel port. One
312 exception is the Ultimate Solutions ZY1000, packaged as a small box you
313 attach via an ethernet cable. The ZY1000 has the advantage that it does not
314 require any drivers to be installed on the developer PC. It also has
315 a built in web interface. It supports RTCK/RCLK or adaptive clocking
316 and has a built-in relay to power cycle targets remotely.
317
318
319 @section Choosing a Dongle
320
321 There are several things you should keep in mind when choosing a dongle.
322
323 @enumerate
324 @item @b{Transport} Does it support the kind of communication that you need?
325 OpenOCD focusses mostly on JTAG. Your version may also support
326 other ways to communicate with target devices.
327 @item @b{Voltage} What voltage is your target - 1.8, 2.8, 3.3, or 5V?
328 Does your dongle support it? You might need a level converter.
329 @item @b{Pinout} What pinout does your target board use?
330 Does your dongle support it? You may be able to use jumper
331 wires, or an "octopus" connector, to convert pinouts.
332 @item @b{Connection} Does your computer have the USB, parallel, or
333 Ethernet port needed?
334 @item @b{RTCK} Do you expect to use it with ARM chips and boards with
335 RTCK support (also known as ``adaptive clocking'')?
336 @end enumerate
337
338 @section Stand-alone JTAG Probe
339
340 The ZY1000 from Ultimate Solutions is technically not a dongle but a
341 stand-alone JTAG probe that, unlike most dongles, doesn't require any drivers
342 running on the developer's host computer.
343 Once installed on a network using DHCP or a static IP assignment, users can
344 access the ZY1000 probe locally or remotely from any host with access to the
345 IP address assigned to the probe.
346 The ZY1000 provides an intuitive web interface with direct access to the
347 OpenOCD debugger.
348 Users may also run a GDBSERVER directly on the ZY1000 to take full advantage
349 of GCC & GDB to debug any distribution of embedded Linux or NetBSD running on
350 the target.
351 The ZY1000 supports RTCK & RCLK or adaptive clocking and has a built-in relay
352 to power cycle the target remotely.
353
354 For more information, visit:
355
356 @b{ZY1000} See: @url{http://www.ultsol.com/index.php/component/content/article/8/210-zylin-zy1000-main}
357
358 @section USB FT2232 Based
359
360 There are many USB JTAG dongles on the market, many of them based
361 on a chip from ``Future Technology Devices International'' (FTDI)
362 known as the FTDI FT2232; this is a USB full speed (12 Mbps) chip.
363 See: @url{http://www.ftdichip.com} for more information.
364 In summer 2009, USB high speed (480 Mbps) versions of these FTDI
365 chips started to become available in JTAG adapters. Around 2012, a new
366 variant appeared - FT232H - this is a single-channel version of FT2232H.
367 (Adapters using those high speed FT2232H or FT232H chips may support adaptive
368 clocking.)
369
370 The FT2232 chips are flexible enough to support some other
371 transport options, such as SWD or the SPI variants used to
372 program some chips. They have two communications channels,
373 and one can be used for a UART adapter at the same time the
374 other one is used to provide a debug adapter.
375
376 Also, some development boards integrate an FT2232 chip to serve as
377 a built-in low-cost debug adapter and USB-to-serial solution.
378
379 @itemize @bullet
380 @item @b{usbjtag}
381 @* Link @url{http://elk.informatik.fh-augsburg.de/hhweb/doc/openocd/usbjtag/usbjtag.html}
382 @item @b{jtagkey}
383 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey.shtml}
384 @item @b{jtagkey2}
385 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey2.shtml}
386 @item @b{oocdlink}
387 @* See: @url{http://www.oocdlink.com} By Joern Kaipf
388 @item @b{signalyzer}
389 @* See: @url{http://www.signalyzer.com}
390 @item @b{Stellaris Eval Boards}
391 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - The Stellaris eval boards
392 bundle FT2232-based JTAG and SWD support, which can be used to debug
393 the Stellaris chips. Using separate JTAG adapters is optional.
394 These boards can also be used in a "pass through" mode as JTAG adapters
395 to other target boards, disabling the Stellaris chip.
396 @item @b{TI/Luminary ICDI}
397 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - TI/Luminary In-Circuit Debug
398 Interface (ICDI) Boards are included in Stellaris LM3S9B9x
399 Evaluation Kits. Like the non-detachable FT2232 support on the other
400 Stellaris eval boards, they can be used to debug other target boards.
401 @item @b{olimex-jtag}
402 @* See: @url{http://www.olimex.com}
403 @item @b{Flyswatter/Flyswatter2}
404 @* See: @url{http://www.tincantools.com}
405 @item @b{turtelizer2}
406 @* See:
407 @uref{http://www.ethernut.de/en/hardware/turtelizer/index.html, Turtelizer 2}, or
408 @url{http://www.ethernut.de}
409 @item @b{comstick}
410 @* Link: @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=383}
411 @item @b{stm32stick}
412 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/stm32-stick}
413 @item @b{axm0432_jtag}
414 @* Axiom AXM-0432 Link @url{http://www.axman.com} - NOTE: This JTAG does not appear
415 to be available anymore as of April 2012.
416 @item @b{cortino}
417 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=cortino}
418 @item @b{dlp-usb1232h}
419 @* Link @url{http://www.dlpdesign.com/usb/usb1232h.shtml}
420 @item @b{digilent-hs1}
421 @* Link @url{http://www.digilentinc.com/Products/Detail.cfm?Prod=JTAG-HS1}
422 @item @b{opendous}
423 @* Link @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous/wiki/JTAG} FT2232H-based
424 (OpenHardware).
425 @item @b{JTAG-lock-pick Tiny 2}
426 @* Link @url{http://www.distortec.com/jtag-lock-pick-tiny-2} FT232H-based
427
428 @item @b{GW16042}
429 @* Link: @url{http://shop.gateworks.com/index.php?route=product/product&path=70_80&product_id=64}
430 FT2232H-based
431
432 @end itemize
433 @section USB-JTAG / Altera USB-Blaster compatibles
434
435 These devices also show up as FTDI devices, but are not
436 protocol-compatible with the FT2232 devices. They are, however,
437 protocol-compatible among themselves. USB-JTAG devices typically consist
438 of a FT245 followed by a CPLD that understands a particular protocol,
439 or emulates this protocol using some other hardware.
440
441 They may appear under different USB VID/PID depending on the particular
442 product. The driver can be configured to search for any VID/PID pair
443 (see the section on driver commands).
444
445 @itemize
446 @item @b{USB-JTAG} Kolja Waschk's USB Blaster-compatible adapter
447 @* Link: @url{http://ixo-jtag.sourceforge.net/}
448 @item @b{Altera USB-Blaster}
449 @* Link: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_usb_blstr.pdf}
450 @end itemize
451
452 @section USB J-Link based
453 There are several OEM versions of the SEGGER @b{J-Link} adapter. It is
454 an example of a microcontroller based JTAG adapter, it uses an
455 AT91SAM764 internally.
456
457 @itemize @bullet
458 @item @b{SEGGER J-Link}
459 @* Link: @url{http://www.segger.com/jlink.html}
460 @item @b{Atmel SAM-ICE} (Only works with Atmel chips!)
461 @* Link: @url{http://www.atmel.com/tools/atmelsam-ice.aspx}
462 @item @b{IAR J-Link}
463 @end itemize
464
465 @section USB RLINK based
466 Raisonance has an adapter called @b{RLink}. It exists in a stripped-down form on the STM32 Primer,
467 permanently attached to the JTAG lines. It also exists on the STM32 Primer2, but that is wired for
468 SWD and not JTAG, thus not supported.
469
470 @itemize @bullet
471 @item @b{Raisonance RLink}
472 @* Link: @url{http://www.mcu-raisonance.com/~rlink-debugger-programmer__@/microcontrollers__tool~tool__T018:4cn9ziz4bnx6.html}
473 @item @b{STM32 Primer}
474 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer.php}
475 @item @b{STM32 Primer2}
476 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer2.php}
477 @end itemize
478
479 @section USB ST-LINK based
480 STMicroelectronics has an adapter called @b{ST-LINK}.
481 They only work with STMicroelectronics chips, notably STM32 and STM8.
482
483 @itemize @bullet
484 @item @b{ST-LINK}
485 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32VLDISCOVERY.
486 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/219866.jsp}
487 @item @b{ST-LINK/V2}
488 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32F4DISCOVERY.
489 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/251168.jsp}
490 @item @b{STLINK-V3}
491 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits.
492 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/stlink-v3}
493 @end itemize
494
495 For info the original ST-LINK enumerates using the mass storage usb class; however,
496 its implementation is completely broken. The result is this causes issues under Linux.
497 The simplest solution is to get Linux to ignore the ST-LINK using one of the following methods:
498 @itemize @bullet
499 @item modprobe -r usb-storage && modprobe usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i
500 @item add "options usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i" to /etc/modprobe.conf
501 @end itemize
502
503 @section USB TI/Stellaris ICDI based
504 Texas Instruments has an adapter called @b{ICDI}.
505 It is not to be confused with the FTDI based adapters that were originally fitted to their
506 evaluation boards. This is the adapter fitted to the Stellaris LaunchPad.
507
508 @section USB CMSIS-DAP based
509 ARM has released a interface standard called CMSIS-DAP that simplifies connecting
510 debuggers to ARM Cortex based targets @url{http://www.keil.com/support/man/docs/dapdebug/dapdebug_introduction.htm}.
511
512 @section USB Other
513 @itemize @bullet
514 @item @b{USBprog}
515 @* Link: @url{http://shop.embedded-projects.net/} - which uses an Atmel MEGA32 and a UBN9604
516
517 @item @b{USB - Presto}
518 @* Link: @url{http://tools.asix.net/prg_presto.htm}
519
520 @item @b{Versaloon-Link}
521 @* Link: @url{http://www.versaloon.com}
522
523 @item @b{ARM-JTAG-EW}
524 @* Link: @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag-ew.html}
525
526 @item @b{Buspirate}
527 @* Link: @url{http://dangerousprototypes.com/bus-pirate-manual/}
528
529 @item @b{opendous}
530 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous-jtag/} - which uses an AT90USB162
531
532 @item @b{estick}
533 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/estick-jtag/}
534
535 @item @b{Keil ULINK v1}
536 @* Link: @url{http://www.keil.com/ulink1/}
537
538 @item @b{TI XDS110 Debug Probe}
539 @* The XDS110 is included as the embedded debug probe on many Texas Instruments
540 LaunchPad evaluation boards. The XDS110 is also available as a stand-alone USB
541 debug probe with the added capability to supply power to the target board. The
542 following commands are supported by the XDS110 driver:
543 @*@deffn {Config Command} {xds110 serial} serial_string
544 Specifies the serial number of which XDS110 probe to use. Otherwise, the first
545 XDS110 found will be used.
546 @end deffn
547 @*@deffn {Config Command} {xds110 supply} voltage_in_millivolts
548 Available only on the XDS110 stand-alone probe. Sets the voltage level of the
549 XDS110 power supply. A value of 0 leaves the supply off. Otherwise, the supply
550 can be set to any value in the range 1800 to 3600 millivolts.
551 @end deffn
552 @*@deffn {Command} {xds110 info}
553 Displays information about the connected XDS110 debug probe (e.g. firmware
554 version).
555 @end deffn
556 @* Further information can be found at the following sites:
557 @* Link: @url{https://software-dl.ti.com/ccs/esd/documents/xdsdebugprobes/emu_xds110.html}
558 @* Link: @url{https://software-dl.ti.com/ccs/esd/documents/xdsdebugprobes/emu_xds_software_package_download.html#xds110-support-utilities}
559 @end itemize
560
561 @section IBM PC Parallel Printer Port Based
562
563 The two well-known ``JTAG Parallel Ports'' cables are the Xilinx DLC5
564 and the Macraigor Wiggler. There are many clones and variations of
565 these on the market.
566
567 Note that parallel ports are becoming much less common, so if you
568 have the choice you should probably avoid these adapters in favor
569 of USB-based ones.
570
571 @itemize @bullet
572
573 @item @b{Wiggler} - There are many clones of this.
574 @* Link: @url{http://www.macraigor.com/wiggler.htm}
575
576 @item @b{DLC5} - From XILINX - There are many clones of this
577 @* Link: Search the web for: ``XILINX DLC5'' - it is no longer
578 produced, PDF schematics are easily found and it is easy to make.
579
580 @item @b{Amontec - JTAG Accelerator}
581 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtag_accelerator.shtml}
582
583 @item @b{Wiggler2}
584 @* Link: @url{http://www.ccac.rwth-aachen.de/~michaels/index.php/hardware/armjtag}
585
586 @item @b{Wiggler_ntrst_inverted}
587 @* Yet another variation - See the source code, src/jtag/parport.c
588
589 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler}
590 @* Unknown - probably not on the market today
591
592 @item @b{arm-jtag}
593 @* Link: Most likely @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag.html} [another wiggler clone]
594
595 @item @b{chameleon}
596 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/chameleon.shtml}
597
598 @item @b{Triton}
599 @* Unknown.
600
601 @item @b{Lattice}
602 @* ispDownload from Lattice Semiconductor
603 @url{http://www.latticesemi.com/lit/docs/@/devtools/dlcable.pdf}
604
605 @item @b{flashlink}
606 @* From STMicroelectronics;
607 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/com/TECHNICAL_RESOURCES/TECHNICAL_LITERATURE/DATA_BRIEF/DM00039500.pdf}
608
609 @end itemize
610
611 @section Other...
612 @itemize @bullet
613
614 @item @b{ep93xx}
615 @* An EP93xx based Linux machine using the GPIO pins directly.
616
617 @item @b{at91rm9200}
618 @* Like the EP93xx - but an ATMEL AT91RM9200 based solution using the GPIO pins on the chip.
619
620 @item @b{bcm2835gpio}
621 @* A BCM2835-based board (e.g. Raspberry Pi) using the GPIO pins of the expansion header.
622
623 @item @b{imx_gpio}
624 @* A NXP i.MX-based board (e.g. Wandboard) using the GPIO pins (should work on any i.MX processor).
625
626 @item @b{jtag_vpi}
627 @* A JTAG driver acting as a client for the JTAG VPI server interface.
628 @* Link: @url{http://github.com/fjullien/jtag_vpi}
629
630 @item @b{xlnx_pcie_xvc}
631 @* A JTAG driver exposing Xilinx Virtual Cable over PCI Express to OpenOCD as JTAG interface.
632
633 @end itemize
634
635 @node About Jim-Tcl
636 @chapter About Jim-Tcl
637 @cindex Jim-Tcl
638 @cindex tcl
639
640 OpenOCD uses a small ``Tcl Interpreter'' known as Jim-Tcl.
641 This programming language provides a simple and extensible
642 command interpreter.
643
644 All commands presented in this Guide are extensions to Jim-Tcl.
645 You can use them as simple commands, without needing to learn
646 much of anything about Tcl.
647 Alternatively, you can write Tcl programs with them.
648
649 You can learn more about Jim at its website, @url{http://jim.tcl.tk}.
650 There is an active and responsive community, get on the mailing list
651 if you have any questions. Jim-Tcl maintainers also lurk on the
652 OpenOCD mailing list.
653
654 @itemize @bullet
655 @item @b{Jim vs. Tcl}
656 @* Jim-Tcl is a stripped down version of the well known Tcl language,
657 which can be found here: @url{http://www.tcl.tk}. Jim-Tcl has far
658 fewer features. Jim-Tcl is several dozens of .C files and .H files and
659 implements the basic Tcl command set. In contrast: Tcl 8.6 is a
660 4.2 MB .zip file containing 1540 files.
661
662 @item @b{Missing Features}
663 @* Our practice has been: Add/clone the real Tcl feature if/when
664 needed. We welcome Jim-Tcl improvements, not bloat. Also there
665 are a large number of optional Jim-Tcl features that are not
666 enabled in OpenOCD.
667
668 @item @b{Scripts}
669 @* OpenOCD configuration scripts are Jim-Tcl Scripts. OpenOCD's
670 command interpreter today is a mixture of (newer)
671 Jim-Tcl commands, and the (older) original command interpreter.
672
673 @item @b{Commands}
674 @* At the OpenOCD telnet command line (or via the GDB monitor command) one
675 can type a Tcl for() loop, set variables, etc.
676 Some of the commands documented in this guide are implemented
677 as Tcl scripts, from a @file{startup.tcl} file internal to the server.
678
679 @item @b{Historical Note}
680 @* Jim-Tcl was introduced to OpenOCD in spring 2008. Fall 2010,
681 before OpenOCD 0.5 release, OpenOCD switched to using Jim-Tcl
682 as a Git submodule, which greatly simplified upgrading Jim-Tcl
683 to benefit from new features and bugfixes in Jim-Tcl.
684
685 @item @b{Need a crash course in Tcl?}
686 @*@xref{Tcl Crash Course}.
687 @end itemize
688
689 @node Running
690 @chapter Running
691 @cindex command line options
692 @cindex logfile
693 @cindex directory search
694
695 Properly installing OpenOCD sets up your operating system to grant it access
696 to the debug adapters. On Linux, this usually involves installing a file
697 in @file{/etc/udev/rules.d,} so OpenOCD has permissions. An example rules file
698 that works for many common adapters is shipped with OpenOCD in the
699 @file{contrib} directory. MS-Windows needs
700 complex and confusing driver configuration for every peripheral. Such issues
701 are unique to each operating system, and are not detailed in this User's Guide.
702
703 Then later you will invoke the OpenOCD server, with various options to
704 tell it how each debug session should work.
705 The @option{--help} option shows:
706 @verbatim
707 bash$ openocd --help
708
709 --help | -h display this help
710 --version | -v display OpenOCD version
711 --file | -f use configuration file <name>
712 --search | -s dir to search for config files and scripts
713 --debug | -d set debug level to 3
714 | -d<n> set debug level to <level>
715 --log_output | -l redirect log output to file <name>
716 --command | -c run <command>
717 @end verbatim
718
719 If you don't give any @option{-f} or @option{-c} options,
720 OpenOCD tries to read the configuration file @file{openocd.cfg}.
721 To specify one or more different
722 configuration files, use @option{-f} options. For example:
723
724 @example
725 openocd -f config1.cfg -f config2.cfg -f config3.cfg
726 @end example
727
728 Configuration files and scripts are searched for in
729 @enumerate
730 @item the current directory,
731 @item any search dir specified on the command line using the @option{-s} option,
732 @item any search dir specified using the @command{add_script_search_dir} command,
733 @item @file{$HOME/.openocd} (not on Windows),
734 @item a directory in the @env{OPENOCD_SCRIPTS} environment variable (if set),
735 @item the site wide script library @file{$pkgdatadir/site} and
736 @item the OpenOCD-supplied script library @file{$pkgdatadir/scripts}.
737 @end enumerate
738 The first found file with a matching file name will be used.
739
740 @quotation Note
741 Don't try to use configuration script names or paths which
742 include the "#" character. That character begins Tcl comments.
743 @end quotation
744
745 @section Simple setup, no customization
746
747 In the best case, you can use two scripts from one of the script
748 libraries, hook up your JTAG adapter, and start the server ... and
749 your JTAG setup will just work "out of the box". Always try to
750 start by reusing those scripts, but assume you'll need more
751 customization even if this works. @xref{OpenOCD Project Setup}.
752
753 If you find a script for your JTAG adapter, and for your board or
754 target, you may be able to hook up your JTAG adapter then start
755 the server with some variation of one of the following:
756
757 @example
758 openocd -f interface/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
759 openocd -f interface/ftdi/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
760 @end example
761
762 You might also need to configure which reset signals are present,
763 using @option{-c 'reset_config trst_and_srst'} or something similar.
764 If all goes well you'll see output something like
765
766 @example
767 Open On-Chip Debugger 0.4.0 (2010-01-14-15:06)
768 For bug reports, read
769 http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/bugs.html
770 Info : JTAG tap: lm3s.cpu tap/device found: 0x3ba00477
771 (mfg: 0x23b, part: 0xba00, ver: 0x3)
772 @end example
773
774 Seeing that "tap/device found" message, and no warnings, means
775 the JTAG communication is working. That's a key milestone, but
776 you'll probably need more project-specific setup.
777
778 @section What OpenOCD does as it starts
779
780 OpenOCD starts by processing the configuration commands provided
781 on the command line or, if there were no @option{-c command} or
782 @option{-f file.cfg} options given, in @file{openocd.cfg}.
783 @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage}.
784 At the end of the configuration stage it verifies the JTAG scan
785 chain defined using those commands; your configuration should
786 ensure that this always succeeds.
787 Normally, OpenOCD then starts running as a server.
788 Alternatively, commands may be used to terminate the configuration
789 stage early, perform work (such as updating some flash memory),
790 and then shut down without acting as a server.
791
792 Once OpenOCD starts running as a server, it waits for connections from
793 clients (Telnet, GDB, RPC) and processes the commands issued through
794 those channels.
795
796 If you are having problems, you can enable internal debug messages via
797 the @option{-d} option.
798
799 Also it is possible to interleave Jim-Tcl commands w/config scripts using the
800 @option{-c} command line switch.
801
802 To enable debug output (when reporting problems or working on OpenOCD
803 itself), use the @option{-d} command line switch. This sets the
804 @option{debug_level} to "3", outputting the most information,
805 including debug messages. The default setting is "2", outputting only
806 informational messages, warnings and errors. You can also change this
807 setting from within a telnet or gdb session using @command{debug_level<n>}
808 (@pxref{debuglevel,,debug_level}).
809
810 You can redirect all output from the server to a file using the
811 @option{-l <logfile>} switch.
812
813 Note! OpenOCD will launch the GDB & telnet server even if it can not
814 establish a connection with the target. In general, it is possible for
815 the JTAG controller to be unresponsive until the target is set up
816 correctly via e.g. GDB monitor commands in a GDB init script.
817
818 @node OpenOCD Project Setup
819 @chapter OpenOCD Project Setup
820
821 To use OpenOCD with your development projects, you need to do more than
822 just connect the JTAG adapter hardware (dongle) to your development board
823 and start the OpenOCD server.
824 You also need to configure your OpenOCD server so that it knows
825 about your adapter and board, and helps your work.
826 You may also want to connect OpenOCD to GDB, possibly
827 using Eclipse or some other GUI.
828
829 @section Hooking up the JTAG Adapter
830
831 Today's most common case is a dongle with a JTAG cable on one side
832 (such as a ribbon cable with a 10-pin or 20-pin IDC connector)
833 and a USB cable on the other.
834 Instead of USB, some cables use Ethernet;
835 older ones may use a PC parallel port, or even a serial port.
836
837 @enumerate
838 @item @emph{Start with power to your target board turned off},
839 and nothing connected to your JTAG adapter.
840 If you're particularly paranoid, unplug power to the board.
841 It's important to have the ground signal properly set up,
842 unless you are using a JTAG adapter which provides
843 galvanic isolation between the target board and the
844 debugging host.
845
846 @item @emph{Be sure it's the right kind of JTAG connector.}
847 If your dongle has a 20-pin ARM connector, you need some kind
848 of adapter (or octopus, see below) to hook it up to
849 boards using 14-pin or 10-pin connectors ... or to 20-pin
850 connectors which don't use ARM's pinout.
851
852 In the same vein, make sure the voltage levels are compatible.
853 Not all JTAG adapters have the level shifters needed to work
854 with 1.2 Volt boards.
855
856 @item @emph{Be certain the cable is properly oriented} or you might
857 damage your board. In most cases there are only two possible
858 ways to connect the cable.
859 Connect the JTAG cable from your adapter to the board.
860 Be sure it's firmly connected.
861
862 In the best case, the connector is keyed to physically
863 prevent you from inserting it wrong.
864 This is most often done using a slot on the board's male connector
865 housing, which must match a key on the JTAG cable's female connector.
866 If there's no housing, then you must look carefully and
867 make sure pin 1 on the cable hooks up to pin 1 on the board.
868 Ribbon cables are frequently all grey except for a wire on one
869 edge, which is red. The red wire is pin 1.
870
871 Sometimes dongles provide cables where one end is an ``octopus'' of
872 color coded single-wire connectors, instead of a connector block.
873 These are great when converting from one JTAG pinout to another,
874 but are tedious to set up.
875 Use these with connector pinout diagrams to help you match up the
876 adapter signals to the right board pins.
877
878 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's other end} once the JTAG cable is connected.
879 A USB, parallel, or serial port connector will go to the host which
880 you are using to run OpenOCD.
881 For Ethernet, consult the documentation and your network administrator.
882
883 For USB-based JTAG adapters you have an easy sanity check at this point:
884 does the host operating system see the JTAG adapter? If you're running
885 Linux, try the @command{lsusb} command. If that host is an
886 MS-Windows host, you'll need to install a driver before OpenOCD works.
887
888 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's power supply, if needed.}
889 This step is primarily for non-USB adapters,
890 but sometimes USB adapters need extra power.
891
892 @item @emph{Power up the target board.}
893 Unless you just let the magic smoke escape,
894 you're now ready to set up the OpenOCD server
895 so you can use JTAG to work with that board.
896
897 @end enumerate
898
899 Talk with the OpenOCD server using
900 telnet (@code{telnet localhost 4444} on many systems) or GDB.
901 @xref{GDB and OpenOCD}.
902
903 @section Project Directory
904
905 There are many ways you can configure OpenOCD and start it up.
906
907 A simple way to organize them all involves keeping a
908 single directory for your work with a given board.
909 When you start OpenOCD from that directory,
910 it searches there first for configuration files, scripts,
911 files accessed through semihosting,
912 and for code you upload to the target board.
913 It is also the natural place to write files,
914 such as log files and data you download from the board.
915
916 @section Configuration Basics
917
918 There are two basic ways of configuring OpenOCD, and
919 a variety of ways you can mix them.
920 Think of the difference as just being how you start the server:
921
922 @itemize
923 @item Many @option{-f file} or @option{-c command} options on the command line
924 @item No options, but a @dfn{user config file}
925 in the current directory named @file{openocd.cfg}
926 @end itemize
927
928 Here is an example @file{openocd.cfg} file for a setup
929 using a Signalyzer FT2232-based JTAG adapter to talk to
930 a board with an Atmel AT91SAM7X256 microcontroller:
931
932 @example
933 source [find interface/ftdi/signalyzer.cfg]
934
935 # GDB can also flash my flash!
936 gdb_memory_map enable
937 gdb_flash_program enable
938
939 source [find target/sam7x256.cfg]
940 @end example
941
942 Here is the command line equivalent of that configuration:
943
944 @example
945 openocd -f interface/ftdi/signalyzer.cfg \
946 -c "gdb_memory_map enable" \
947 -c "gdb_flash_program enable" \
948 -f target/sam7x256.cfg
949 @end example
950
951 You could wrap such long command lines in shell scripts,
952 each supporting a different development task.
953 One might re-flash the board with a specific firmware version.
954 Another might set up a particular debugging or run-time environment.
955
956 @quotation Important
957 At this writing (October 2009) the command line method has
958 problems with how it treats variables.
959 For example, after @option{-c "set VAR value"}, or doing the
960 same in a script, the variable @var{VAR} will have no value
961 that can be tested in a later script.
962 @end quotation
963
964 Here we will focus on the simpler solution: one user config
965 file, including basic configuration plus any TCL procedures
966 to simplify your work.
967
968 @section User Config Files
969 @cindex config file, user
970 @cindex user config file
971 @cindex config file, overview
972
973 A user configuration file ties together all the parts of a project
974 in one place.
975 One of the following will match your situation best:
976
977 @itemize
978 @item Ideally almost everything comes from configuration files
979 provided by someone else.
980 For example, OpenOCD distributes a @file{scripts} directory
981 (probably in @file{/usr/share/openocd/scripts} on Linux).
982 Board and tool vendors can provide these too, as can individual
983 user sites; the @option{-s} command line option lets you say
984 where to find these files. (@xref{Running}.)
985 The AT91SAM7X256 example above works this way.
986
987 Three main types of non-user configuration file each have their
988 own subdirectory in the @file{scripts} directory:
989
990 @enumerate
991 @item @b{interface} -- one for each different debug adapter;
992 @item @b{board} -- one for each different board
993 @item @b{target} -- the chips which integrate CPUs and other JTAG TAPs
994 @end enumerate
995
996 Best case: include just two files, and they handle everything else.
997 The first is an interface config file.
998 The second is board-specific, and it sets up the JTAG TAPs and
999 their GDB targets (by deferring to some @file{target.cfg} file),
1000 declares all flash memory, and leaves you nothing to do except
1001 meet your deadline:
1002
1003 @example
1004 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
1005 source [find board/csb337.cfg]
1006 @end example
1007
1008 Boards with a single microcontroller often won't need more
1009 than the target config file, as in the AT91SAM7X256 example.
1010 That's because there is no external memory (flash, DDR RAM), and
1011 the board differences are encapsulated by application code.
1012
1013 @item Maybe you don't know yet what your board looks like to JTAG.
1014 Once you know the @file{interface.cfg} file to use, you may
1015 need help from OpenOCD to discover what's on the board.
1016 Once you find the JTAG TAPs, you can just search for appropriate
1017 target and board
1018 configuration files ... or write your own, from the bottom up.
1019 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
1020
1021 @item You can often reuse some standard config files but
1022 need to write a few new ones, probably a @file{board.cfg} file.
1023 You will be using commands described later in this User's Guide,
1024 and working with the guidelines in the next chapter.
1025
1026 For example, there may be configuration files for your JTAG adapter
1027 and target chip, but you need a new board-specific config file
1028 giving access to your particular flash chips.
1029 Or you might need to write another target chip configuration file
1030 for a new chip built around the Cortex-M3 core.
1031
1032 @quotation Note
1033 When you write new configuration files, please submit
1034 them for inclusion in the next OpenOCD release.
1035 For example, a @file{board/newboard.cfg} file will help the
1036 next users of that board, and a @file{target/newcpu.cfg}
1037 will help support users of any board using that chip.
1038 @end quotation
1039
1040 @item
1041 You may may need to write some C code.
1042 It may be as simple as supporting a new FT2232 or parport
1043 based adapter; a bit more involved, like a NAND or NOR flash
1044 controller driver; or a big piece of work like supporting
1045 a new chip architecture.
1046 @end itemize
1047
1048 Reuse the existing config files when you can.
1049 Look first in the @file{scripts/boards} area, then @file{scripts/targets}.
1050 You may find a board configuration that's a good example to follow.
1051
1052 When you write config files, separate the reusable parts
1053 (things every user of that interface, chip, or board needs)
1054 from ones specific to your environment and debugging approach.
1055 @itemize
1056
1057 @item
1058 For example, a @code{gdb-attach} event handler that invokes
1059 the @command{reset init} command will interfere with debugging
1060 early boot code, which performs some of the same actions
1061 that the @code{reset-init} event handler does.
1062
1063 @item
1064 Likewise, the @command{arm9 vector_catch} command (or
1065 @cindex vector_catch
1066 its siblings @command{xscale vector_catch}
1067 and @command{cortex_m vector_catch}) can be a time-saver
1068 during some debug sessions, but don't make everyone use that either.
1069 Keep those kinds of debugging aids in your user config file,
1070 along with messaging and tracing setup.
1071 (@xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.)
1072
1073 @item
1074 You might need to override some defaults.
1075 For example, you might need to move, shrink, or back up the target's
1076 work area if your application needs much SRAM.
1077
1078 @item
1079 TCP/IP port configuration is another example of something which
1080 is environment-specific, and should only appear in
1081 a user config file. @xref{tcpipports,,TCP/IP Ports}.
1082 @end itemize
1083
1084 @section Project-Specific Utilities
1085
1086 A few project-specific utility
1087 routines may well speed up your work.
1088 Write them, and keep them in your project's user config file.
1089
1090 For example, if you are making a boot loader work on a
1091 board, it's nice to be able to debug the ``after it's
1092 loaded to RAM'' parts separately from the finicky early
1093 code which sets up the DDR RAM controller and clocks.
1094 A script like this one, or a more GDB-aware sibling,
1095 may help:
1096
1097 @example
1098 proc ramboot @{ @} @{
1099 # Reset, running the target's "reset-init" scripts
1100 # to initialize clocks and the DDR RAM controller.
1101 # Leave the CPU halted.
1102 reset init
1103
1104 # Load CONFIG_SKIP_LOWLEVEL_INIT version into DDR RAM.
1105 load_image u-boot.bin 0x20000000
1106
1107 # Start running.
1108 resume 0x20000000
1109 @}
1110 @end example
1111
1112 Then once that code is working you will need to make it
1113 boot from NOR flash; a different utility would help.
1114 Alternatively, some developers write to flash using GDB.
1115 (You might use a similar script if you're working with a flash
1116 based microcontroller application instead of a boot loader.)
1117
1118 @example
1119 proc newboot @{ @} @{
1120 # Reset, leaving the CPU halted. The "reset-init" event
1121 # proc gives faster access to the CPU and to NOR flash;
1122 # "reset halt" would be slower.
1123 reset init
1124
1125 # Write standard version of U-Boot into the first two
1126 # sectors of NOR flash ... the standard version should
1127 # do the same lowlevel init as "reset-init".
1128 flash protect 0 0 1 off
1129 flash erase_sector 0 0 1
1130 flash write_bank 0 u-boot.bin 0x0
1131 flash protect 0 0 1 on
1132
1133 # Reboot from scratch using that new boot loader.
1134 reset run
1135 @}
1136 @end example
1137
1138 You may need more complicated utility procedures when booting
1139 from NAND.
1140 That often involves an extra bootloader stage,
1141 running from on-chip SRAM to perform DDR RAM setup so it can load
1142 the main bootloader code (which won't fit into that SRAM).
1143
1144 Other helper scripts might be used to write production system images,
1145 involving considerably more than just a three stage bootloader.
1146
1147 @section Target Software Changes
1148
1149 Sometimes you may want to make some small changes to the software
1150 you're developing, to help make JTAG debugging work better.
1151 For example, in C or assembly language code you might
1152 use @code{#ifdef JTAG_DEBUG} (or its converse) around code
1153 handling issues like:
1154
1155 @itemize @bullet
1156
1157 @item @b{Watchdog Timers}...
1158 Watchdog timers are typically used to automatically reset systems if
1159 some application task doesn't periodically reset the timer. (The
1160 assumption is that the system has locked up if the task can't run.)
1161 When a JTAG debugger halts the system, that task won't be able to run
1162 and reset the timer ... potentially causing resets in the middle of
1163 your debug sessions.
1164
1165 It's rarely a good idea to disable such watchdogs, since their usage
1166 needs to be debugged just like all other parts of your firmware.
1167 That might however be your only option.
1168
1169 Look instead for chip-specific ways to stop the watchdog from counting
1170 while the system is in a debug halt state. It may be simplest to set
1171 that non-counting mode in your debugger startup scripts. You may however
1172 need a different approach when, for example, a motor could be physically
1173 damaged by firmware remaining inactive in a debug halt state. That might
1174 involve a type of firmware mode where that "non-counting" mode is disabled
1175 at the beginning then re-enabled at the end; a watchdog reset might fire
1176 and complicate the debug session, but hardware (or people) would be
1177 protected.@footnote{Note that many systems support a "monitor mode" debug
1178 that is a somewhat cleaner way to address such issues. You can think of
1179 it as only halting part of the system, maybe just one task,
1180 instead of the whole thing.
1181 At this writing, January 2010, OpenOCD based debugging does not support
1182 monitor mode debug, only "halt mode" debug.}
1183
1184 @item @b{ARM Semihosting}...
1185 @cindex ARM semihosting
1186 When linked with a special runtime library provided with many
1187 toolchains@footnote{See chapter 8 "Semihosting" in
1188 @uref{http://infocenter.arm.com/help/topic/com.arm.doc.dui0203i/DUI0203I_rvct_developer_guide.pdf,
1189 ARM DUI 0203I}, the "RealView Compilation Tools Developer Guide".
1190 The CodeSourcery EABI toolchain also includes a semihosting library.},
1191 your target code can use I/O facilities on the debug host. That library
1192 provides a small set of system calls which are handled by OpenOCD.
1193 It can let the debugger provide your system console and a file system,
1194 helping with early debugging or providing a more capable environment
1195 for sometimes-complex tasks like installing system firmware onto
1196 NAND or SPI flash.
1197
1198 @item @b{ARM Wait-For-Interrupt}...
1199 Many ARM chips synchronize the JTAG clock using the core clock.
1200 Low power states which stop that core clock thus prevent JTAG access.
1201 Idle loops in tasking environments often enter those low power states
1202 via the @code{WFI} instruction (or its coprocessor equivalent, before ARMv7).
1203
1204 You may want to @emph{disable that instruction} in source code,
1205 or otherwise prevent using that state,
1206 to ensure you can get JTAG access at any time.@footnote{As a more
1207 polite alternative, some processors have special debug-oriented
1208 registers which can be used to change various features including
1209 how the low power states are clocked while debugging.
1210 The STM32 DBGMCU_CR register is an example; at the cost of extra
1211 power consumption, JTAG can be used during low power states.}
1212 For example, the OpenOCD @command{halt} command may not
1213 work for an idle processor otherwise.
1214
1215 @item @b{Delay after reset}...
1216 Not all chips have good support for debugger access
1217 right after reset; many LPC2xxx chips have issues here.
1218 Similarly, applications that reconfigure pins used for
1219 JTAG access as they start will also block debugger access.
1220
1221 To work with boards like this, @emph{enable a short delay loop}
1222 the first thing after reset, before "real" startup activities.
1223 For example, one second's delay is usually more than enough
1224 time for a JTAG debugger to attach, so that
1225 early code execution can be debugged
1226 or firmware can be replaced.
1227
1228 @item @b{Debug Communications Channel (DCC)}...
1229 Some processors include mechanisms to send messages over JTAG.
1230 Many ARM cores support these, as do some cores from other vendors.
1231 (OpenOCD may be able to use this DCC internally, speeding up some
1232 operations like writing to memory.)
1233
1234 Your application may want to deliver various debugging messages
1235 over JTAG, by @emph{linking with a small library of code}
1236 provided with OpenOCD and using the utilities there to send
1237 various kinds of message.
1238 @xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.
1239
1240 @end itemize
1241
1242 @section Target Hardware Setup
1243
1244 Chip vendors often provide software development boards which
1245 are highly configurable, so that they can support all options
1246 that product boards may require. @emph{Make sure that any
1247 jumpers or switches match the system configuration you are
1248 working with.}
1249
1250 Common issues include:
1251
1252 @itemize @bullet
1253
1254 @item @b{JTAG setup} ...
1255 Boards may support more than one JTAG configuration.
1256 Examples include jumpers controlling pullups versus pulldowns
1257 on the nTRST and/or nSRST signals, and choice of connectors
1258 (e.g. which of two headers on the base board,
1259 or one from a daughtercard).
1260 For some Texas Instruments boards, you may need to jumper the
1261 EMU0 and EMU1 signals (which OpenOCD won't currently control).
1262
1263 @item @b{Boot Modes} ...
1264 Complex chips often support multiple boot modes, controlled
1265 by external jumpers. Make sure this is set up correctly.
1266 For example many i.MX boards from NXP need to be jumpered
1267 to "ATX mode" to start booting using the on-chip ROM, when
1268 using second stage bootloader code stored in a NAND flash chip.
1269
1270 Such explicit configuration is common, and not limited to
1271 booting from NAND. You might also need to set jumpers to
1272 start booting using code loaded from an MMC/SD card; external
1273 SPI flash; Ethernet, UART, or USB links; NOR flash; OneNAND
1274 flash; some external host; or various other sources.
1275
1276
1277 @item @b{Memory Addressing} ...
1278 Boards which support multiple boot modes may also have jumpers
1279 to configure memory addressing. One board, for example, jumpers
1280 external chipselect 0 (used for booting) to address either
1281 a large SRAM (which must be pre-loaded via JTAG), NOR flash,
1282 or NAND flash. When it's jumpered to address NAND flash, that
1283 board must also be told to start booting from on-chip ROM.
1284
1285 Your @file{board.cfg} file may also need to be told this jumper
1286 configuration, so that it can know whether to declare NOR flash
1287 using @command{flash bank} or instead declare NAND flash with
1288 @command{nand device}; and likewise which probe to perform in
1289 its @code{reset-init} handler.
1290
1291 A closely related issue is bus width. Jumpers might need to
1292 distinguish between 8 bit or 16 bit bus access for the flash
1293 used to start booting.
1294
1295 @item @b{Peripheral Access} ...
1296 Development boards generally provide access to every peripheral
1297 on the chip, sometimes in multiple modes (such as by providing
1298 multiple audio codec chips).
1299 This interacts with software
1300 configuration of pin multiplexing, where for example a
1301 given pin may be routed either to the MMC/SD controller
1302 or the GPIO controller. It also often interacts with
1303 configuration jumpers. One jumper may be used to route
1304 signals to an MMC/SD card slot or an expansion bus (which
1305 might in turn affect booting); others might control which
1306 audio or video codecs are used.
1307
1308 @end itemize
1309
1310 Plus you should of course have @code{reset-init} event handlers
1311 which set up the hardware to match that jumper configuration.
1312 That includes in particular any oscillator or PLL used to clock
1313 the CPU, and any memory controllers needed to access external
1314 memory and peripherals. Without such handlers, you won't be
1315 able to access those resources without working target firmware
1316 which can do that setup ... this can be awkward when you're
1317 trying to debug that target firmware. Even if there's a ROM
1318 bootloader which handles a few issues, it rarely provides full
1319 access to all board-specific capabilities.
1320
1321
1322 @node Config File Guidelines
1323 @chapter Config File Guidelines
1324
1325 This chapter is aimed at any user who needs to write a config file,
1326 including developers and integrators of OpenOCD and any user who
1327 needs to get a new board working smoothly.
1328 It provides guidelines for creating those files.
1329
1330 You should find the following directories under
1331 @t{$(INSTALLDIR)/scripts}, with config files maintained upstream. Use
1332 them as-is where you can; or as models for new files.
1333 @itemize @bullet
1334 @item @file{interface} ...
1335 These are for debug adapters. Files that specify configuration to use
1336 specific JTAG, SWD and other adapters go here.
1337 @item @file{board} ...
1338 Think Circuit Board, PWA, PCB, they go by many names. Board files
1339 contain initialization items that are specific to a board.
1340
1341 They reuse target configuration files, since the same
1342 microprocessor chips are used on many boards,
1343 but support for external parts varies widely. For
1344 example, the SDRAM initialization sequence for the board, or the type
1345 of external flash and what address it uses. Any initialization
1346 sequence to enable that external flash or SDRAM should be found in the
1347 board file. Boards may also contain multiple targets: two CPUs; or
1348 a CPU and an FPGA.
1349 @item @file{target} ...
1350 Think chip. The ``target'' directory represents the JTAG TAPs
1351 on a chip
1352 which OpenOCD should control, not a board. Two common types of targets
1353 are ARM chips and FPGA or CPLD chips.
1354 When a chip has multiple TAPs (maybe it has both ARM and DSP cores),
1355 the target config file defines all of them.
1356 @item @emph{more} ... browse for other library files which may be useful.
1357 For example, there are various generic and CPU-specific utilities.
1358 @end itemize
1359
1360 The @file{openocd.cfg} user config
1361 file may override features in any of the above files by
1362 setting variables before sourcing the target file, or by adding
1363 commands specific to their situation.
1364
1365 @section Interface Config Files
1366
1367 The user config file
1368 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1369
1370 @example
1371 source [find interface/FOOBAR.cfg]
1372 @end example
1373
1374 A preconfigured interface file should exist for every debug adapter
1375 in use today with OpenOCD.
1376 That said, perhaps some of these config files
1377 have only been used by the developer who created it.
1378
1379 A separate chapter gives information about how to set these up.
1380 @xref{Debug Adapter Configuration}.
1381 Read the OpenOCD source code (and Developer's Guide)
1382 if you have a new kind of hardware interface
1383 and need to provide a driver for it.
1384
1385 @section Board Config Files
1386 @cindex config file, board
1387 @cindex board config file
1388
1389 The user config file
1390 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1391
1392 @example
1393 source [find board/FOOBAR.cfg]
1394 @end example
1395
1396 The point of a board config file is to package everything
1397 about a given board that user config files need to know.
1398 In summary the board files should contain (if present)
1399
1400 @enumerate
1401 @item One or more @command{source [find target/...cfg]} statements
1402 @item NOR flash configuration (@pxref{norconfiguration,,NOR Configuration})
1403 @item NAND flash configuration (@pxref{nandconfiguration,,NAND Configuration})
1404 @item Target @code{reset} handlers for SDRAM and I/O configuration
1405 @item JTAG adapter reset configuration (@pxref{Reset Configuration})
1406 @item All things that are not ``inside a chip''
1407 @end enumerate
1408
1409 Generic things inside target chips belong in target config files,
1410 not board config files. So for example a @code{reset-init} event
1411 handler should know board-specific oscillator and PLL parameters,
1412 which it passes to target-specific utility code.
1413
1414 The most complex task of a board config file is creating such a
1415 @code{reset-init} event handler.
1416 Define those handlers last, after you verify the rest of the board
1417 configuration works.
1418
1419 @subsection Communication Between Config files
1420
1421 In addition to target-specific utility code, another way that
1422 board and target config files communicate is by following a
1423 convention on how to use certain variables.
1424
1425 The full Tcl/Tk language supports ``namespaces'', but Jim-Tcl does not.
1426 Thus the rule we follow in OpenOCD is this: Variables that begin with
1427 a leading underscore are temporary in nature, and can be modified and
1428 used at will within a target configuration file.
1429
1430 Complex board config files can do the things like this,
1431 for a board with three chips:
1432
1433 @example
1434 # Chip #1: PXA270 for network side, big endian
1435 set CHIPNAME network
1436 set ENDIAN big
1437 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1438 # on return: _TARGETNAME = network.cpu
1439 # other commands can refer to the "network.cpu" target.
1440 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1441
1442 # Chip #2: PXA270 for video side, little endian
1443 set CHIPNAME video
1444 set ENDIAN little
1445 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1446 # on return: _TARGETNAME = video.cpu
1447 # other commands can refer to the "video.cpu" target.
1448 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1449
1450 # Chip #3: Xilinx FPGA for glue logic
1451 set CHIPNAME xilinx
1452 unset ENDIAN
1453 source [find target/spartan3.cfg]
1454 @end example
1455
1456 That example is oversimplified because it doesn't show any flash memory,
1457 or the @code{reset-init} event handlers to initialize external DRAM
1458 or (assuming it needs it) load a configuration into the FPGA.
1459 Such features are usually needed for low-level work with many boards,
1460 where ``low level'' implies that the board initialization software may
1461 not be working. (That's a common reason to need JTAG tools. Another
1462 is to enable working with microcontroller-based systems, which often
1463 have no debugging support except a JTAG connector.)
1464
1465 Target config files may also export utility functions to board and user
1466 config files. Such functions should use name prefixes, to help avoid
1467 naming collisions.
1468
1469 Board files could also accept input variables from user config files.
1470 For example, there might be a @code{J4_JUMPER} setting used to identify
1471 what kind of flash memory a development board is using, or how to set
1472 up other clocks and peripherals.
1473
1474 @subsection Variable Naming Convention
1475 @cindex variable names
1476
1477 Most boards have only one instance of a chip.
1478 However, it should be easy to create a board with more than
1479 one such chip (as shown above).
1480 Accordingly, we encourage these conventions for naming
1481 variables associated with different @file{target.cfg} files,
1482 to promote consistency and
1483 so that board files can override target defaults.
1484
1485 Inputs to target config files include:
1486
1487 @itemize @bullet
1488 @item @code{CHIPNAME} ...
1489 This gives a name to the overall chip, and is used as part of
1490 tap identifier dotted names.
1491 While the default is normally provided by the chip manufacturer,
1492 board files may need to distinguish between instances of a chip.
1493 @item @code{ENDIAN} ...
1494 By default @option{little} - although chips may hard-wire @option{big}.
1495 Chips that can't change endianess don't need to use this variable.
1496 @item @code{CPUTAPID} ...
1497 When OpenOCD examines the JTAG chain, it can be told verify the
1498 chips against the JTAG IDCODE register.
1499 The target file will hold one or more defaults, but sometimes the
1500 chip in a board will use a different ID (perhaps a newer revision).
1501 @end itemize
1502
1503 Outputs from target config files include:
1504
1505 @itemize @bullet
1506 @item @code{_TARGETNAME} ...
1507 By convention, this variable is created by the target configuration
1508 script. The board configuration file may make use of this variable to
1509 configure things like a ``reset init'' script, or other things
1510 specific to that board and that target.
1511 If the chip has 2 targets, the names are @code{_TARGETNAME0},
1512 @code{_TARGETNAME1}, ... etc.
1513 @end itemize
1514
1515 @subsection The reset-init Event Handler
1516 @cindex event, reset-init
1517 @cindex reset-init handler
1518
1519 Board config files run in the OpenOCD configuration stage;
1520 they can't use TAPs or targets, since they haven't been
1521 fully set up yet.
1522 This means you can't write memory or access chip registers;
1523 you can't even verify that a flash chip is present.
1524 That's done later in event handlers, of which the target @code{reset-init}
1525 handler is one of the most important.
1526
1527 Except on microcontrollers, the basic job of @code{reset-init} event
1528 handlers is setting up flash and DRAM, as normally handled by boot loaders.
1529 Microcontrollers rarely use boot loaders; they run right out of their
1530 on-chip flash and SRAM memory. But they may want to use one of these
1531 handlers too, if just for developer convenience.
1532
1533 @quotation Note
1534 Because this is so very board-specific, and chip-specific, no examples
1535 are included here.
1536 Instead, look at the board config files distributed with OpenOCD.
1537 If you have a boot loader, its source code will help; so will
1538 configuration files for other JTAG tools
1539 (@pxref{translatingconfigurationfiles,,Translating Configuration Files}).
1540 @end quotation
1541
1542 Some of this code could probably be shared between different boards.
1543 For example, setting up a DRAM controller often doesn't differ by
1544 much except the bus width (16 bits or 32?) and memory timings, so a
1545 reusable TCL procedure loaded by the @file{target.cfg} file might take
1546 those as parameters.
1547 Similarly with oscillator, PLL, and clock setup;
1548 and disabling the watchdog.
1549 Structure the code cleanly, and provide comments to help
1550 the next developer doing such work.
1551 (@emph{You might be that next person} trying to reuse init code!)
1552
1553 The last thing normally done in a @code{reset-init} handler is probing
1554 whatever flash memory was configured. For most chips that needs to be
1555 done while the associated target is halted, either because JTAG memory
1556 access uses the CPU or to prevent conflicting CPU access.
1557
1558 @subsection JTAG Clock Rate
1559
1560 Before your @code{reset-init} handler has set up
1561 the PLLs and clocking, you may need to run with
1562 a low JTAG clock rate.
1563 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1564 Then you'd increase that rate after your handler has
1565 made it possible to use the faster JTAG clock.
1566 When the initial low speed is board-specific, for example
1567 because it depends on a board-specific oscillator speed, then
1568 you should probably set it up in the board config file;
1569 if it's target-specific, it belongs in the target config file.
1570
1571 For most ARM-based processors the fastest JTAG clock@footnote{A FAQ
1572 @uref{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} gives details.}
1573 is one sixth of the CPU clock; or one eighth for ARM11 cores.
1574 Consult chip documentation to determine the peak JTAG clock rate,
1575 which might be less than that.
1576
1577 @quotation Warning
1578 On most ARMs, JTAG clock detection is coupled to the core clock, so
1579 software using a @option{wait for interrupt} operation blocks JTAG access.
1580 Adaptive clocking provides a partial workaround, but a more complete
1581 solution just avoids using that instruction with JTAG debuggers.
1582 @end quotation
1583
1584 If both the chip and the board support adaptive clocking,
1585 use the @command{jtag_rclk}
1586 command, in case your board is used with JTAG adapter which
1587 also supports it. Otherwise use @command{adapter speed}.
1588 Set the slow rate at the beginning of the reset sequence,
1589 and the faster rate as soon as the clocks are at full speed.
1590
1591 @anchor{theinitboardprocedure}
1592 @subsection The init_board procedure
1593 @cindex init_board procedure
1594
1595 The concept of @code{init_board} procedure is very similar to @code{init_targets}
1596 (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets procedure}.) - it's a replacement of ``linear''
1597 configuration scripts. This procedure is meant to be executed when OpenOCD enters run stage
1598 (@xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage},) after @code{init_targets}. The idea to have
1599 separate @code{init_targets} and @code{init_board} procedures is to allow the first one to configure
1600 everything target specific (internal flash, internal RAM, etc.) and the second one to configure
1601 everything board specific (reset signals, chip frequency, reset-init event handler, external memory, etc.).
1602 Additionally ``linear'' board config file will most likely fail when target config file uses
1603 @code{init_targets} scheme (``linear'' script is executed before @code{init} and @code{init_targets} - after),
1604 so separating these two configuration stages is very convenient, as the easiest way to overcome this
1605 problem is to convert board config file to use @code{init_board} procedure. Board config scripts don't
1606 need to override @code{init_targets} defined in target config files when they only need to add some specifics.
1607
1608 Just as @code{init_targets}, the @code{init_board} procedure can be overridden by ``next level'' script (which sources
1609 the original), allowing greater code reuse.
1610
1611 @example
1612 ### board_file.cfg ###
1613
1614 # source target file that does most of the config in init_targets
1615 source [find target/target.cfg]
1616
1617 proc enable_fast_clock @{@} @{
1618 # enables fast on-board clock source
1619 # configures the chip to use it
1620 @}
1621
1622 # initialize only board specifics - reset, clock, adapter frequency
1623 proc init_board @{@} @{
1624 reset_config trst_and_srst trst_pulls_srst
1625
1626 $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-start @{
1627 adapter speed 100
1628 @}
1629
1630 $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-init @{
1631 enable_fast_clock
1632 adapter speed 10000
1633 @}
1634 @}
1635 @end example
1636
1637 @section Target Config Files
1638 @cindex config file, target
1639 @cindex target config file
1640
1641 Board config files communicate with target config files using
1642 naming conventions as described above, and may source one or
1643 more target config files like this:
1644
1645 @example
1646 source [find target/FOOBAR.cfg]
1647 @end example
1648
1649 The point of a target config file is to package everything
1650 about a given chip that board config files need to know.
1651 In summary the target files should contain
1652
1653 @enumerate
1654 @item Set defaults
1655 @item Add TAPs to the scan chain
1656 @item Add CPU targets (includes GDB support)
1657 @item CPU/Chip/CPU-Core specific features
1658 @item On-Chip flash
1659 @end enumerate
1660
1661 As a rule of thumb, a target file sets up only one chip.
1662 For a microcontroller, that will often include a single TAP,
1663 which is a CPU needing a GDB target, and its on-chip flash.
1664
1665 More complex chips may include multiple TAPs, and the target
1666 config file may need to define them all before OpenOCD
1667 can talk to the chip.
1668 For example, some phone chips have JTAG scan chains that include
1669 an ARM core for operating system use, a DSP,
1670 another ARM core embedded in an image processing engine,
1671 and other processing engines.
1672
1673 @subsection Default Value Boiler Plate Code
1674
1675 All target configuration files should start with code like this,
1676 letting board config files express environment-specific
1677 differences in how things should be set up.
1678
1679 @example
1680 # Boards may override chip names, perhaps based on role,
1681 # but the default should match what the vendor uses
1682 if @{ [info exists CHIPNAME] @} @{
1683 set _CHIPNAME $CHIPNAME
1684 @} else @{
1685 set _CHIPNAME sam7x256
1686 @}
1687
1688 # ONLY use ENDIAN with targets that can change it.
1689 if @{ [info exists ENDIAN] @} @{
1690 set _ENDIAN $ENDIAN
1691 @} else @{
1692 set _ENDIAN little
1693 @}
1694
1695 # TAP identifiers may change as chips mature, for example with
1696 # new revision fields (the "3" here). Pick a good default; you
1697 # can pass several such identifiers to the "jtag newtap" command.
1698 if @{ [info exists CPUTAPID ] @} @{
1699 set _CPUTAPID $CPUTAPID
1700 @} else @{
1701 set _CPUTAPID 0x3f0f0f0f
1702 @}
1703 @end example
1704 @c but 0x3f0f0f0f is for an str73x part ...
1705
1706 @emph{Remember:} Board config files may include multiple target
1707 config files, or the same target file multiple times
1708 (changing at least @code{CHIPNAME}).
1709
1710 Likewise, the target configuration file should define
1711 @code{_TARGETNAME} (or @code{_TARGETNAME0} etc) and
1712 use it later on when defining debug targets:
1713
1714 @example
1715 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1716 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1717 @end example
1718
1719 @subsection Adding TAPs to the Scan Chain
1720 After the ``defaults'' are set up,
1721 add the TAPs on each chip to the JTAG scan chain.
1722 @xref{TAP Declaration}, and the naming convention
1723 for taps.
1724
1725 In the simplest case the chip has only one TAP,
1726 probably for a CPU or FPGA.
1727 The config file for the Atmel AT91SAM7X256
1728 looks (in part) like this:
1729
1730 @example
1731 jtag newtap $_CHIPNAME cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id $_CPUTAPID
1732 @end example
1733
1734 A board with two such at91sam7 chips would be able
1735 to source such a config file twice, with different
1736 values for @code{CHIPNAME}, so
1737 it adds a different TAP each time.
1738
1739 If there are nonzero @option{-expected-id} values,
1740 OpenOCD attempts to verify the actual tap id against those values.
1741 It will issue error messages if there is mismatch, which
1742 can help to pinpoint problems in OpenOCD configurations.
1743
1744 @example
1745 JTAG tap: sam7x256.cpu tap/device found: 0x3f0f0f0f
1746 (Manufacturer: 0x787, Part: 0xf0f0, Version: 0x3)
1747 ERROR: Tap: sam7x256.cpu - Expected id: 0x12345678, Got: 0x3f0f0f0f
1748 ERROR: expected: mfg: 0x33c, part: 0x2345, ver: 0x1
1749 ERROR: got: mfg: 0x787, part: 0xf0f0, ver: 0x3
1750 @end example
1751
1752 There are more complex examples too, with chips that have
1753 multiple TAPs. Ones worth looking at include:
1754
1755 @itemize
1756 @item @file{target/omap3530.cfg} -- with disabled ARM and DSP,
1757 plus a JRC to enable them
1758 @item @file{target/str912.cfg} -- with flash, CPU, and boundary scan
1759 @item @file{target/ti_dm355.cfg} -- with ETM, ARM, and JRC (this JRC
1760 is not currently used)
1761 @end itemize
1762
1763 @subsection Add CPU targets
1764
1765 After adding a TAP for a CPU, you should set it up so that
1766 GDB and other commands can use it.
1767 @xref{CPU Configuration}.
1768 For the at91sam7 example above, the command can look like this;
1769 note that @code{$_ENDIAN} is not needed, since OpenOCD defaults
1770 to little endian, and this chip doesn't support changing that.
1771
1772 @example
1773 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1774 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1775 @end example
1776
1777 Work areas are small RAM areas associated with CPU targets.
1778 They are used by OpenOCD to speed up downloads,
1779 and to download small snippets of code to program flash chips.
1780 If the chip includes a form of ``on-chip-ram'' - and many do - define
1781 a work area if you can.
1782 Again using the at91sam7 as an example, this can look like:
1783
1784 @example
1785 $_TARGETNAME configure -work-area-phys 0x00200000 \
1786 -work-area-size 0x4000 -work-area-backup 0
1787 @end example
1788
1789 @anchor{definecputargetsworkinginsmp}
1790 @subsection Define CPU targets working in SMP
1791 @cindex SMP
1792 After setting targets, you can define a list of targets working in SMP.
1793
1794 @example
1795 set _TARGETNAME_1 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1796 set _TARGETNAME_2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu2
1797 target create $_TARGETNAME_1 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1798 -coreid 0 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG1
1799 target create $_TARGETNAME_2 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1800 -coreid 1 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG2
1801 #define 2 targets working in smp.
1802 target smp $_CHIPNAME.cpu2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1803 @end example
1804 In the above example on cortex_a, 2 cpus are working in SMP.
1805 In SMP only one GDB instance is created and :
1806 @itemize @bullet
1807 @item a set of hardware breakpoint sets the same breakpoint on all targets in the list.
1808 @item halt command triggers the halt of all targets in the list.
1809 @item resume command triggers the write context and the restart of all targets in the list.
1810 @item following a breakpoint: the target stopped by the breakpoint is displayed to the GDB session.
1811 @item dedicated GDB serial protocol packets are implemented for switching/retrieving the target
1812 displayed by the GDB session @pxref{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb,,Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB}.
1813 @end itemize
1814
1815 The SMP behaviour can be disabled/enabled dynamically. On cortex_a following
1816 command have been implemented.
1817 @itemize @bullet
1818 @item cortex_a smp on : enable SMP mode, behaviour is as described above.
1819 @item cortex_a smp off : disable SMP mode, the current target is the one
1820 displayed in the GDB session, only this target is now controlled by GDB
1821 session. This behaviour is useful during system boot up.
1822 @item cortex_a smp : display current SMP mode.
1823 @item cortex_a smp_gdb : display/fix the core id displayed in GDB session see
1824 following example.
1825 @end itemize
1826
1827 @example
1828 >cortex_a smp_gdb
1829 gdb coreid 0 -> -1
1830 #0 : coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1831 #-> -1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1832 > cortex_a smp_gdb 1
1833 gdb coreid 0 -> 1
1834 #0 :coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1835 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1836 > resume
1837 > cortex_a smp_gdb
1838 gdb coreid 1 -> 1
1839 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB ,
1840 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1841 > cortex_a smp_gdb -1
1842 gdb coreid 1 -> -1
1843 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB,
1844 #->-1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1845 @end example
1846
1847
1848 @subsection Chip Reset Setup
1849
1850 As a rule, you should put the @command{reset_config} command
1851 into the board file. Most things you think you know about a
1852 chip can be tweaked by the board.
1853
1854 Some chips have specific ways the TRST and SRST signals are
1855 managed. In the unusual case that these are @emph{chip specific}
1856 and can never be changed by board wiring, they could go here.
1857 For example, some chips can't support JTAG debugging without
1858 both signals.
1859
1860 Provide a @code{reset-assert} event handler if you can.
1861 Such a handler uses JTAG operations to reset the target,
1862 letting this target config be used in systems which don't
1863 provide the optional SRST signal, or on systems where you
1864 don't want to reset all targets at once.
1865 Such a handler might write to chip registers to force a reset,
1866 use a JRC to do that (preferable -- the target may be wedged!),
1867 or force a watchdog timer to trigger.
1868 (For Cortex-M targets, this is not necessary. The target
1869 driver knows how to use trigger an NVIC reset when SRST is
1870 not available.)
1871
1872 Some chips need special attention during reset handling if
1873 they're going to be used with JTAG.
1874 An example might be needing to send some commands right
1875 after the target's TAP has been reset, providing a
1876 @code{reset-deassert-post} event handler that writes a chip
1877 register to report that JTAG debugging is being done.
1878 Another would be reconfiguring the watchdog so that it stops
1879 counting while the core is halted in the debugger.
1880
1881 JTAG clocking constraints often change during reset, and in
1882 some cases target config files (rather than board config files)
1883 are the right places to handle some of those issues.
1884 For example, immediately after reset most chips run using a
1885 slower clock than they will use later.
1886 That means that after reset (and potentially, as OpenOCD
1887 first starts up) they must use a slower JTAG clock rate
1888 than they will use later.
1889 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1890
1891 @quotation Important
1892 When you are debugging code that runs right after chip
1893 reset, getting these issues right is critical.
1894 In particular, if you see intermittent failures when
1895 OpenOCD verifies the scan chain after reset,
1896 look at how you are setting up JTAG clocking.
1897 @end quotation
1898
1899 @anchor{theinittargetsprocedure}
1900 @subsection The init_targets procedure
1901 @cindex init_targets procedure
1902
1903 Target config files can either be ``linear'' (script executed line-by-line when parsed in
1904 configuration stage, @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage},) or they can contain a special
1905 procedure called @code{init_targets}, which will be executed when entering run stage
1906 (after parsing all config files or after @code{init} command, @xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage}.)
1907 Such procedure can be overridden by ``next level'' script (which sources the original).
1908 This concept facilitates code reuse when basic target config files provide generic configuration
1909 procedures and @code{init_targets} procedure, which can then be sourced and enhanced or changed in
1910 a ``more specific'' target config file. This is not possible with ``linear'' config scripts,
1911 because sourcing them executes every initialization commands they provide.
1912
1913 @example
1914 ### generic_file.cfg ###
1915
1916 proc setup_my_chip @{chip_name flash_size ram_size@} @{
1917 # basic initialization procedure ...
1918 @}
1919
1920 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1921 # initializes generic chip with 4kB of flash and 1kB of RAM
1922 setup_my_chip MY_GENERIC_CHIP 4096 1024
1923 @}
1924
1925 ### specific_file.cfg ###
1926
1927 source [find target/generic_file.cfg]
1928
1929 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1930 # initializes specific chip with 128kB of flash and 64kB of RAM
1931 setup_my_chip MY_CHIP_WITH_128K_FLASH_64KB_RAM 131072 65536
1932 @}
1933 @end example
1934
1935 The easiest way to convert ``linear'' config files to @code{init_targets} version is to
1936 enclose every line of ``code'' (i.e. not @code{source} commands, procedures, etc.) in this procedure.
1937
1938 For an example of this scheme see LPC2000 target config files.
1939
1940 The @code{init_boards} procedure is a similar concept concerning board config files
1941 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.)
1942
1943 @anchor{theinittargeteventsprocedure}
1944 @subsection The init_target_events procedure
1945 @cindex init_target_events procedure
1946
1947 A special procedure called @code{init_target_events} is run just after
1948 @code{init_targets} (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets
1949 procedure}.) and before @code{init_board}
1950 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.) It is used
1951 to set up default target events for the targets that do not have those
1952 events already assigned.
1953
1954 @subsection ARM Core Specific Hacks
1955
1956 If the chip has a DCC, enable it. If the chip is an ARM9 with some
1957 special high speed download features - enable it.
1958
1959 If present, the MMU, the MPU and the CACHE should be disabled.
1960
1961 Some ARM cores are equipped with trace support, which permits
1962 examination of the instruction and data bus activity. Trace
1963 activity is controlled through an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM)
1964 on one of the core's scan chains. The ETM emits voluminous data
1965 through a ``trace port''. (@xref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.)
1966 If you are using an external trace port,
1967 configure it in your board config file.
1968 If you are using an on-chip ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB),
1969 configure it in your target config file.
1970
1971 @example
1972 etm config $_TARGETNAME 16 normal full etb
1973 etb config $_TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.etb
1974 @end example
1975
1976 @subsection Internal Flash Configuration
1977
1978 This applies @b{ONLY TO MICROCONTROLLERS} that have flash built in.
1979
1980 @b{Never ever} in the ``target configuration file'' define any type of
1981 flash that is external to the chip. (For example a BOOT flash on
1982 Chip Select 0.) Such flash information goes in a board file - not
1983 the TARGET (chip) file.
1984
1985 Examples:
1986 @itemize @bullet
1987 @item at91sam7x256 - has 256K flash YES enable it.
1988 @item str912 - has flash internal YES enable it.
1989 @item imx27 - uses boot flash on CS0 - it goes in the board file.
1990 @item pxa270 - again - CS0 flash - it goes in the board file.
1991 @end itemize
1992
1993 @anchor{translatingconfigurationfiles}
1994 @section Translating Configuration Files
1995 @cindex translation
1996 If you have a configuration file for another hardware debugger
1997 or toolset (Abatron, BDI2000, BDI3000, CCS,
1998 Lauterbach, SEGGER, Macraigor, etc.), translating
1999 it into OpenOCD syntax is often quite straightforward. The most tricky
2000 part of creating a configuration script is oftentimes the reset init
2001 sequence where e.g. PLLs, DRAM and the like is set up.
2002
2003 One trick that you can use when translating is to write small
2004 Tcl procedures to translate the syntax into OpenOCD syntax. This
2005 can avoid manual translation errors and make it easier to
2006 convert other scripts later on.
2007
2008 Example of transforming quirky arguments to a simple search and
2009 replace job:
2010
2011 @example
2012 # Lauterbach syntax(?)
2013 #
2014 # Data.Set c15:0x042f %long 0x40000015
2015 #
2016 # OpenOCD syntax when using procedure below.
2017 #
2018 # setc15 0x01 0x00050078
2019
2020 proc setc15 @{regs value@} @{
2021 global TARGETNAME
2022
2023 echo [format "set p15 0x%04x, 0x%08x" $regs $value]
2024
2025 arm mcr 15 [expr ($regs>>12)&0x7] \
2026 [expr ($regs>>0)&0xf] [expr ($regs>>4)&0xf] \
2027 [expr ($regs>>8)&0x7] $value
2028 @}
2029 @end example
2030
2031
2032
2033 @node Server Configuration
2034 @chapter Server Configuration
2035 @cindex initialization
2036 The commands here are commonly found in the openocd.cfg file and are
2037 used to specify what TCP/IP ports are used, and how GDB should be
2038 supported.
2039
2040 @anchor{configurationstage}
2041 @section Configuration Stage
2042 @cindex configuration stage
2043 @cindex config command
2044
2045 When the OpenOCD server process starts up, it enters a
2046 @emph{configuration stage} which is the only time that
2047 certain commands, @emph{configuration commands}, may be issued.
2048 Normally, configuration commands are only available
2049 inside startup scripts.
2050
2051 In this manual, the definition of a configuration command is
2052 presented as a @emph{Config Command}, not as a @emph{Command}
2053 which may be issued interactively.
2054 The runtime @command{help} command also highlights configuration
2055 commands, and those which may be issued at any time.
2056
2057 Those configuration commands include declaration of TAPs,
2058 flash banks,
2059 the interface used for JTAG communication,
2060 and other basic setup.
2061 The server must leave the configuration stage before it
2062 may access or activate TAPs.
2063 After it leaves this stage, configuration commands may no
2064 longer be issued.
2065
2066 @anchor{enteringtherunstage}
2067 @section Entering the Run Stage
2068
2069 The first thing OpenOCD does after leaving the configuration
2070 stage is to verify that it can talk to the scan chain
2071 (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2072 It will warn if it doesn't find TAPs it expects to find,
2073 or finds TAPs that aren't supposed to be there.
2074 You should see no errors at this point.
2075 If you see errors, resolve them by correcting the
2076 commands you used to configure the server.
2077 Common errors include using an initial JTAG speed that's too
2078 fast, and not providing the right IDCODE values for the TAPs
2079 on the scan chain.
2080
2081 Once OpenOCD has entered the run stage, a number of commands
2082 become available.
2083 A number of these relate to the debug targets you may have declared.
2084 For example, the @command{mww} command will not be available until
2085 a target has been successfully instantiated.
2086 If you want to use those commands, you may need to force
2087 entry to the run stage.
2088
2089 @deffn {Config Command} init
2090 This command terminates the configuration stage and
2091 enters the run stage. This helps when you need to have
2092 the startup scripts manage tasks such as resetting the target,
2093 programming flash, etc. To reset the CPU upon startup, add "init" and
2094 "reset" at the end of the config script or at the end of the OpenOCD
2095 command line using the @option{-c} command line switch.
2096
2097 If this command does not appear in any startup/configuration file
2098 OpenOCD executes the command for you after processing all
2099 configuration files and/or command line options.
2100
2101 @b{NOTE:} This command normally occurs at or near the end of your
2102 openocd.cfg file to force OpenOCD to ``initialize'' and make the
2103 targets ready. For example: If your openocd.cfg file needs to
2104 read/write memory on your target, @command{init} must occur before
2105 the memory read/write commands. This includes @command{nand probe}.
2106 @end deffn
2107
2108 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} jtag_init
2109 This is invoked at server startup to verify that it can talk
2110 to the scan chain (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2111
2112 The default implementation first tries @command{jtag arp_init},
2113 which uses only a lightweight JTAG reset before examining the
2114 scan chain.
2115 If that fails, it tries again, using a harder reset
2116 from the overridable procedure @command{init_reset}.
2117
2118 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
2119 they return.
2120 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
2121 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
2122 @end deffn
2123
2124 @anchor{tcpipports}
2125 @section TCP/IP Ports
2126 @cindex TCP port
2127 @cindex server
2128 @cindex port
2129 @cindex security
2130 The OpenOCD server accepts remote commands in several syntaxes.
2131 Each syntax uses a different TCP/IP port, which you may specify
2132 only during configuration (before those ports are opened).
2133
2134 For reasons including security, you may wish to prevent remote
2135 access using one or more of these ports.
2136 In such cases, just specify the relevant port number as "disabled".
2137 If you disable all access through TCP/IP, you will need to
2138 use the command line @option{-pipe} option.
2139
2140 @anchor{gdb_port}
2141 @deffn {Command} gdb_port [number]
2142 @cindex GDB server
2143 Normally gdb listens to a TCP/IP port, but GDB can also
2144 communicate via pipes(stdin/out or named pipes). The name
2145 "gdb_port" stuck because it covers probably more than 90% of
2146 the normal use cases.
2147
2148 No arguments reports GDB port. "pipe" means listen to stdin
2149 output to stdout, an integer is base port number, "disabled"
2150 disables the gdb server.
2151
2152 When using "pipe", also use log_output to redirect the log
2153 output to a file so as not to flood the stdin/out pipes.
2154
2155 The -p/--pipe option is deprecated and a warning is printed
2156 as it is equivalent to passing in -c "gdb_port pipe; log_output openocd.log".
2157
2158 Any other string is interpreted as named pipe to listen to.
2159 Output pipe is the same name as input pipe, but with 'o' appended,
2160 e.g. /var/gdb, /var/gdbo.
2161
2162 The GDB port for the first target will be the base port, the
2163 second target will listen on gdb_port + 1, and so on.
2164 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2165 the port @var{number} defaults to 3333.
2166 When @var{number} is not a numeric value, incrementing it to compute
2167 the next port number does not work. In this case, specify the proper
2168 @var{number} for each target by using the option @code{-gdb-port} of the
2169 commands @command{target create} or @command{$target_name configure}.
2170 @xref{gdbportoverride,,option -gdb-port}.
2171
2172 Note: when using "gdb_port pipe", increasing the default remote timeout in
2173 gdb (with 'set remotetimeout') is recommended. An insufficient timeout may
2174 cause initialization to fail with "Unknown remote qXfer reply: OK".
2175 @end deffn
2176
2177 @deffn {Command} tcl_port [number]
2178 Specify or query the port used for a simplified RPC
2179 connection that can be used by clients to issue TCL commands and get the
2180 output from the Tcl engine.
2181 Intended as a machine interface.
2182 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2183 the port @var{number} defaults to 6666.
2184 When specified as "disabled", this service is not activated.
2185 @end deffn
2186
2187 @deffn {Command} telnet_port [number]
2188 Specify or query the
2189 port on which to listen for incoming telnet connections.
2190 This port is intended for interaction with one human through TCL commands.
2191 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2192 the port @var{number} defaults to 4444.
2193 When specified as "disabled", this service is not activated.
2194 @end deffn
2195
2196 @anchor{gdbconfiguration}
2197 @section GDB Configuration
2198 @cindex GDB
2199 @cindex GDB configuration
2200 You can reconfigure some GDB behaviors if needed.
2201 The ones listed here are static and global.
2202 @xref{targetconfiguration,,Target Configuration}, about configuring individual targets.
2203 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}, about configuring target-specific event handling.
2204
2205 @anchor{gdbbreakpointoverride}
2206 @deffn {Command} gdb_breakpoint_override [@option{hard}|@option{soft}|@option{disable}]
2207 Force breakpoint type for gdb @command{break} commands.
2208 This option supports GDB GUIs which don't
2209 distinguish hard versus soft breakpoints, if the default OpenOCD and
2210 GDB behaviour is not sufficient. GDB normally uses hardware
2211 breakpoints if the memory map has been set up for flash regions.
2212 @end deffn
2213
2214 @anchor{gdbflashprogram}
2215 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_flash_program (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2216 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to program the flash memory when a
2217 vFlash packet is received.
2218 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2219 @end deffn
2220
2221 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_memory_map (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2222 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the memory configuration to GDB when
2223 requested. GDB will then know when to set hardware breakpoints, and program flash
2224 using the GDB load command. @command{gdb_flash_program enable} must also be enabled
2225 for flash programming to work.
2226 Default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2227 @xref{gdbflashprogram,,gdb_flash_program}.
2228 @end deffn
2229
2230 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_report_data_abort (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2231 Specifies whether data aborts cause an error to be reported
2232 by GDB memory read packets.
2233 The default behaviour is @option{disable};
2234 use @option{enable} see these errors reported.
2235 @end deffn
2236
2237 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_report_register_access_error (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2238 Specifies whether register accesses requested by GDB register read/write
2239 packets report errors or not.
2240 The default behaviour is @option{disable};
2241 use @option{enable} see these errors reported.
2242 @end deffn
2243
2244 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_target_description (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2245 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the target descriptions to gdb via qXfer:features:read packet.
2246 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2247 @end deffn
2248
2249 @deffn {Command} gdb_save_tdesc
2250 Saves the target description file to the local file system.
2251
2252 The file name is @i{target_name}.xml.
2253 @end deffn
2254
2255 @anchor{eventpolling}
2256 @section Event Polling
2257
2258 Hardware debuggers are parts of asynchronous systems,
2259 where significant events can happen at any time.
2260 The OpenOCD server needs to detect some of these events,
2261 so it can report them to through TCL command line
2262 or to GDB.
2263
2264 Examples of such events include:
2265
2266 @itemize
2267 @item One of the targets can stop running ... maybe it triggers
2268 a code breakpoint or data watchpoint, or halts itself.
2269 @item Messages may be sent over ``debug message'' channels ... many
2270 targets support such messages sent over JTAG,
2271 for receipt by the person debugging or tools.
2272 @item Loss of power ... some adapters can detect these events.
2273 @item Resets not issued through JTAG ... such reset sources
2274 can include button presses or other system hardware, sometimes
2275 including the target itself (perhaps through a watchdog).
2276 @item Debug instrumentation sometimes supports event triggering
2277 such as ``trace buffer full'' (so it can quickly be emptied)
2278 or other signals (to correlate with code behavior).
2279 @end itemize
2280
2281 None of those events are signaled through standard JTAG signals.
2282 However, most conventions for JTAG connectors include voltage
2283 level and system reset (SRST) signal detection.
2284 Some connectors also include instrumentation signals, which
2285 can imply events when those signals are inputs.
2286
2287 In general, OpenOCD needs to periodically check for those events,
2288 either by looking at the status of signals on the JTAG connector
2289 or by sending synchronous ``tell me your status'' JTAG requests
2290 to the various active targets.
2291 There is a command to manage and monitor that polling,
2292 which is normally done in the background.
2293
2294 @deffn Command poll [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2295 Poll the current target for its current state.
2296 (Also, @pxref{targetcurstate,,target curstate}.)
2297 If that target is in debug mode, architecture
2298 specific information about the current state is printed.
2299 An optional parameter
2300 allows background polling to be enabled and disabled.
2301
2302 You could use this from the TCL command shell, or
2303 from GDB using @command{monitor poll} command.
2304 Leave background polling enabled while you're using GDB.
2305 @example
2306 > poll
2307 background polling: on
2308 target state: halted
2309 target halted in ARM state due to debug-request, \
2310 current mode: Supervisor
2311 cpsr: 0x800000d3 pc: 0x11081bfc
2312 MMU: disabled, D-Cache: disabled, I-Cache: enabled
2313 >
2314 @end example
2315 @end deffn
2316
2317 @node Debug Adapter Configuration
2318 @chapter Debug Adapter Configuration
2319 @cindex config file, interface
2320 @cindex interface config file
2321
2322 Correctly installing OpenOCD includes making your operating system give
2323 OpenOCD access to debug adapters. Once that has been done, Tcl commands
2324 are used to select which one is used, and to configure how it is used.
2325
2326 @quotation Note
2327 Because OpenOCD started out with a focus purely on JTAG, you may find
2328 places where it wrongly presumes JTAG is the only transport protocol
2329 in use. Be aware that recent versions of OpenOCD are removing that
2330 limitation. JTAG remains more functional than most other transports.
2331 Other transports do not support boundary scan operations, or may be
2332 specific to a given chip vendor. Some might be usable only for
2333 programming flash memory, instead of also for debugging.
2334 @end quotation
2335
2336 Debug Adapters/Interfaces/Dongles are normally configured
2337 through commands in an interface configuration
2338 file which is sourced by your @file{openocd.cfg} file, or
2339 through a command line @option{-f interface/....cfg} option.
2340
2341 @example
2342 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
2343 @end example
2344
2345 These commands tell
2346 OpenOCD what type of JTAG adapter you have, and how to talk to it.
2347 A few cases are so simple that you only need to say what driver to use:
2348
2349 @example
2350 # jlink interface
2351 adapter driver jlink
2352 @end example
2353
2354 Most adapters need a bit more configuration than that.
2355
2356
2357 @section Adapter Configuration
2358
2359 The @command{adapter driver} command tells OpenOCD what type of debug adapter you are
2360 using. Depending on the type of adapter, you may need to use one or
2361 more additional commands to further identify or configure the adapter.
2362
2363 @deffn {Config Command} {adapter driver} name
2364 Use the adapter driver @var{name} to connect to the
2365 target.
2366 @end deffn
2367
2368 @deffn Command {adapter list}
2369 List the debug adapter drivers that have been built into
2370 the running copy of OpenOCD.
2371 @end deffn
2372 @deffn Command {adapter transports} transport_name+
2373 Specifies the transports supported by this debug adapter.
2374 The adapter driver builds-in similar knowledge; use this only
2375 when external configuration (such as jumpering) changes what
2376 the hardware can support.
2377 @end deffn
2378
2379
2380
2381 @deffn Command {adapter name}
2382 Returns the name of the debug adapter driver being used.
2383 @end deffn
2384
2385 @anchor{adapter_usb_location}
2386 @deffn Command {adapter usb location} [<bus>-<port>[.<port>]...]
2387 Displays or specifies the physical USB port of the adapter to use. The path
2388 roots at @var{bus} and walks down the physical ports, with each
2389 @var{port} option specifying a deeper level in the bus topology, the last
2390 @var{port} denoting where the target adapter is actually plugged.
2391 The USB bus topology can be queried with the command @emph{lsusb -t} or @emph{dmesg}.
2392
2393 This command is only available if your libusb1 is at least version 1.0.16.
2394 @end deffn
2395
2396 @section Interface Drivers
2397
2398 Each of the interface drivers listed here must be explicitly
2399 enabled when OpenOCD is configured, in order to be made
2400 available at run time.
2401
2402 @deffn {Interface Driver} {amt_jtagaccel}
2403 Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
2404 connected to a PC's EPP mode parallel port.
2405 This defines some driver-specific commands:
2406
2407 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} number
2408 Specifies either the address of the I/O port (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or
2409 the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2410 @end deffn
2411
2412 @deffn {Config Command} rtck [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
2413 Displays status of RTCK option.
2414 Optionally sets that option first.
2415 @end deffn
2416 @end deffn
2417
2418 @deffn {Interface Driver} {arm-jtag-ew}
2419 Olimex ARM-JTAG-EW USB adapter
2420 This has one driver-specific command:
2421
2422 @deffn Command {armjtagew_info}
2423 Logs some status
2424 @end deffn
2425 @end deffn
2426
2427 @deffn {Interface Driver} {at91rm9200}
2428 Supports bitbanged JTAG from the local system,
2429 presuming that system is an Atmel AT91rm9200
2430 and a specific set of GPIOs is used.
2431 @c command: at91rm9200_device NAME
2432 @c chooses among list of bit configs ... only one option
2433 @end deffn
2434
2435 @deffn {Interface Driver} {cmsis-dap}
2436 ARM CMSIS-DAP compliant based adapter.
2437
2438 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2439 The vendor ID and product ID of the CMSIS-DAP device. If not specified
2440 the driver will attempt to auto detect the CMSIS-DAP device.
2441 Currently, up to eight [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2442 @example
2443 cmsis_dap_vid_pid 0xc251 0xf001 0x0d28 0x0204
2444 @end example
2445 @end deffn
2446
2447 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_serial} [serial]
2448 Specifies the @var{serial} of the CMSIS-DAP device to use.
2449 If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2450 @end deffn
2451
2452 @deffn {Command} {cmsis-dap info}
2453 Display various device information, like hardware version, firmware version, current bus status.
2454 @end deffn
2455 @end deffn
2456
2457 @deffn {Interface Driver} {dummy}
2458 A dummy software-only driver for debugging.
2459 @end deffn
2460
2461 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ep93xx}
2462 Cirrus Logic EP93xx based single-board computer bit-banging (in development)
2463 @end deffn
2464
2465 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ftdi}
2466 This driver is for adapters using the MPSSE (Multi-Protocol Synchronous Serial
2467 Engine) mode built into many FTDI chips, such as the FT2232, FT4232 and FT232H.
2468
2469 The driver is using libusb-1.0 in asynchronous mode to talk to the FTDI device,
2470 bypassing intermediate libraries like libftdi or D2XX.
2471
2472 Support for new FTDI based adapters can be added completely through
2473 configuration files, without the need to patch and rebuild OpenOCD.
2474
2475 The driver uses a signal abstraction to enable Tcl configuration files to
2476 define outputs for one or several FTDI GPIO. These outputs can then be
2477 controlled using the @command{ftdi_set_signal} command. Special signal names
2478 are reserved for nTRST, nSRST and LED (for blink) so that they, if defined,
2479 will be used for their customary purpose. Inputs can be read using the
2480 @command{ftdi_get_signal} command.
2481
2482 To support SWD, a signal named SWD_EN must be defined. It is set to 1 when the
2483 SWD protocol is selected. When set, the adapter should route the SWDIO pin to
2484 the data input. An SWDIO_OE signal, if defined, will be set to 1 or 0 as
2485 required by the protocol, to tell the adapter to drive the data output onto
2486 the SWDIO pin or keep the SWDIO pin Hi-Z, respectively.
2487
2488 Depending on the type of buffer attached to the FTDI GPIO, the outputs have to
2489 be controlled differently. In order to support tristateable signals such as
2490 nSRST, both a data GPIO and an output-enable GPIO can be specified for each
2491 signal. The following output buffer configurations are supported:
2492
2493 @itemize @minus
2494 @item Push-pull with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line
2495 @item Open drain with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2496 @item Tristate with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line and another
2497 FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2498 @item Unbuffered, using the FTDI GPIO as a tristate output directly by
2499 switching data and direction as necessary
2500 @end itemize
2501
2502 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2503 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2504
2505 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2506 The vendor ID and product ID of the adapter. Up to eight
2507 [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2508 @example
2509 ftdi_vid_pid 0x0403 0xcff8 0x15ba 0x0003
2510 @end example
2511 @end deffn
2512
2513 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_device_desc} description
2514 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2515 of the adapter. If not specified, the device description is ignored
2516 during device selection.
2517 @end deffn
2518
2519 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_serial} serial-number
2520 Specifies the @var{serial-number} of the adapter to use,
2521 in case the vendor provides unique IDs and more than one adapter
2522 is connected to the host.
2523 If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2524 (Note that USB serial numbers can be arbitrary Unicode strings,
2525 and are not restricted to containing only decimal digits.)
2526 @end deffn
2527
2528 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_location} <bus>-<port>[.<port>]...
2529 @emph{DEPRECATED -- avoid using this.
2530 Use the command @ref{adapter_usb_location,,adapter usb location} instead.}
2531
2532 Specifies the physical USB port of the adapter to use. The path
2533 roots at @var{bus} and walks down the physical ports, with each
2534 @var{port} option specifying a deeper level in the bus topology, the last
2535 @var{port} denoting where the target adapter is actually plugged.
2536 The USB bus topology can be queried with the command @emph{lsusb -t}.
2537
2538 This command is only available if your libusb1 is at least version 1.0.16.
2539 @end deffn
2540
2541 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_channel} channel
2542 Selects the channel of the FTDI device to use for MPSSE operations. Most
2543 adapters use the default, channel 0, but there are exceptions.
2544 @end deffn
2545
2546 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_layout_init} data direction
2547 Specifies the initial values of the FTDI GPIO data and direction registers.
2548 Each value is a 16-bit number corresponding to the concatenation of the high
2549 and low FTDI GPIO registers. The values should be selected based on the
2550 schematics of the adapter, such that all signals are set to safe levels with
2551 minimal impact on the target system. Avoid floating inputs, conflicting outputs
2552 and initially asserted reset signals.
2553 @end deffn
2554
2555 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_layout_signal} name [@option{-data}|@option{-ndata} data_mask] [@option{-input}|@option{-ninput} input_mask] [@option{-oe}|@option{-noe} oe_mask] [@option{-alias}|@option{-nalias} name]
2556 Creates a signal with the specified @var{name}, controlled by one or more FTDI
2557 GPIO pins via a range of possible buffer connections. The masks are FTDI GPIO
2558 register bitmasks to tell the driver the connection and type of the output
2559 buffer driving the respective signal. @var{data_mask} is the bitmask for the
2560 pin(s) connected to the data input of the output buffer. @option{-ndata} is
2561 used with inverting data inputs and @option{-data} with non-inverting inputs.
2562 The @option{-oe} (or @option{-noe}) option tells where the output-enable (or
2563 not-output-enable) input to the output buffer is connected. The options
2564 @option{-input} and @option{-ninput} specify the bitmask for pins to be read
2565 with the method @command{ftdi_get_signal}.
2566
2567 Both @var{data_mask} and @var{oe_mask} need not be specified. For example, a
2568 simple open-collector transistor driver would be specified with @option{-oe}
2569 only. In that case the signal can only be set to drive low or to Hi-Z and the
2570 driver will complain if the signal is set to drive high. Which means that if
2571 it's a reset signal, @command{reset_config} must be specified as
2572 @option{srst_open_drain}, not @option{srst_push_pull}.
2573
2574 A special case is provided when @option{-data} and @option{-oe} is set to the
2575 same bitmask. Then the FTDI pin is considered being connected straight to the
2576 target without any buffer. The FTDI pin is then switched between output and
2577 input as necessary to provide the full set of low, high and Hi-Z
2578 characteristics. In all other cases, the pins specified in a signal definition
2579 are always driven by the FTDI.
2580
2581 If @option{-alias} or @option{-nalias} is used, the signal is created
2582 identical (or with data inverted) to an already specified signal
2583 @var{name}.
2584 @end deffn
2585
2586 @deffn {Command} {ftdi_set_signal} name @option{0}|@option{1}|@option{z}
2587 Set a previously defined signal to the specified level.
2588 @itemize @minus
2589 @item @option{0}, drive low
2590 @item @option{1}, drive high
2591 @item @option{z}, set to high-impedance
2592 @end itemize
2593 @end deffn
2594
2595 @deffn {Command} {ftdi_get_signal} name
2596 Get the value of a previously defined signal.
2597 @end deffn
2598
2599 @deffn {Command} {ftdi_tdo_sample_edge} @option{rising}|@option{falling}
2600 Configure TCK edge at which the adapter samples the value of the TDO signal
2601
2602 Due to signal propagation delays, sampling TDO on rising TCK can become quite
2603 peculiar at high JTAG clock speeds. However, FTDI chips offer a possibility to sample
2604 TDO on falling edge of TCK. With some board/adapter configurations, this may increase
2605 stability at higher JTAG clocks.
2606 @itemize @minus
2607 @item @option{rising}, sample TDO on rising edge of TCK - this is the default
2608 @item @option{falling}, sample TDO on falling edge of TCK
2609 @end itemize
2610 @end deffn
2611
2612 For example adapter definitions, see the configuration files shipped in the
2613 @file{interface/ftdi} directory.
2614
2615 @end deffn
2616
2617 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ft232r}
2618 This driver is implementing synchronous bitbang mode of an FTDI FT232R,
2619 FT230X, FT231X and similar USB UART bridge ICs by reusing RS232 signals as GPIO.
2620 It currently doesn't support using CBUS pins as GPIO.
2621
2622 List of connections (default physical pin numbers for FT232R in 28-pin SSOP package):
2623 @itemize @minus
2624 @item RXD(5) - TDI
2625 @item TXD(1) - TCK
2626 @item RTS(3) - TDO
2627 @item CTS(11) - TMS
2628 @item DTR(2) - TRST
2629 @item DCD(10) - SRST
2630 @end itemize
2631
2632 User can change default pinout by supplying configuration
2633 commands with GPIO numbers or RS232 signal names.
2634 GPIO numbers correspond to bit numbers in FTDI GPIO register.
2635 They differ from physical pin numbers.
2636 For details see actual FTDI chip datasheets.
2637 Every JTAG line must be configured to unique GPIO number
2638 different than any other JTAG line, even those lines
2639 that are sometimes not used like TRST or SRST.
2640
2641 FT232R
2642 @itemize @minus
2643 @item bit 7 - RI
2644 @item bit 6 - DCD
2645 @item bit 5 - DSR
2646 @item bit 4 - DTR
2647 @item bit 3 - CTS
2648 @item bit 2 - RTS
2649 @item bit 1 - RXD
2650 @item bit 0 - TXD
2651 @end itemize
2652
2653 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2654 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2655
2656 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_vid_pid} @var{vid} @var{pid}
2657 The vendor ID and product ID of the adapter. If not specified, default
2658 0x0403:0x6001 is used.
2659 @end deffn
2660
2661 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_serial_desc} @var{serial}
2662 Specifies the @var{serial} of the adapter to use, in case the
2663 vendor provides unique IDs and more than one adapter is connected to
2664 the host. If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2665 @end deffn
2666
2667 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_jtag_nums} @var{tck} @var{tms} @var{tdi} @var{tdo}
2668 Set four JTAG GPIO numbers at once.
2669 If not specified, default 0 3 1 2 or TXD CTS RXD RTS is used.
2670 @end deffn
2671
2672 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_tck_num} @var{tck}
2673 Set TCK GPIO number. If not specified, default 0 or TXD is used.
2674 @end deffn
2675
2676 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_tms_num} @var{tms}
2677 Set TMS GPIO number. If not specified, default 3 or CTS is used.
2678 @end deffn
2679
2680 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_tdi_num} @var{tdi}
2681 Set TDI GPIO number. If not specified, default 1 or RXD is used.
2682 @end deffn
2683
2684 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_tdo_num} @var{tdo}
2685 Set TDO GPIO number. If not specified, default 2 or RTS is used.
2686 @end deffn
2687
2688 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_trst_num} @var{trst}
2689 Set TRST GPIO number. If not specified, default 4 or DTR is used.
2690 @end deffn
2691
2692 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_srst_num} @var{srst}
2693 Set SRST GPIO number. If not specified, default 6 or DCD is used.
2694 @end deffn
2695
2696 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_restore_serial} @var{word}
2697 Restore serial port after JTAG. This USB bitmode control word
2698 (16-bit) will be sent before quit. Lower byte should
2699 set GPIO direction register to a "sane" state:
2700 0x15 for TXD RTS DTR as outputs (1), others as inputs (0). Higher
2701 byte is usually 0 to disable bitbang mode.
2702 When kernel driver reattaches, serial port should continue to work.
2703 Value 0xFFFF disables sending control word and serial port,
2704 then kernel driver will not reattach.
2705 If not specified, default 0xFFFF is used.
2706 @end deffn
2707
2708 @end deffn
2709
2710 @deffn {Interface Driver} {remote_bitbang}
2711 Drive JTAG from a remote process. This sets up a UNIX or TCP socket connection
2712 with a remote process and sends ASCII encoded bitbang requests to that process
2713 instead of directly driving JTAG.
2714
2715 The remote_bitbang driver is useful for debugging software running on
2716 processors which are being simulated.
2717
2718 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang_port} number
2719 Specifies the TCP port of the remote process to connect to or 0 to use UNIX
2720 sockets instead of TCP.
2721 @end deffn
2722
2723 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang_host} hostname
2724 Specifies the hostname of the remote process to connect to using TCP, or the
2725 name of the UNIX socket to use if remote_bitbang_port is 0.
2726 @end deffn
2727
2728 For example, to connect remotely via TCP to the host foobar you might have
2729 something like:
2730
2731 @example
2732 adapter driver remote_bitbang
2733 remote_bitbang_port 3335
2734 remote_bitbang_host foobar
2735 @end example
2736
2737 To connect to another process running locally via UNIX sockets with socket
2738 named mysocket:
2739
2740 @example
2741 adapter driver remote_bitbang
2742 remote_bitbang_port 0
2743 remote_bitbang_host mysocket
2744 @end example
2745 @end deffn
2746
2747 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usb_blaster}
2748 USB JTAG/USB-Blaster compatibles over one of the userspace libraries
2749 for FTDI chips. These interfaces have several commands, used to
2750 configure the driver before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2751
2752 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster_device_desc} description
2753 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2754 of the FTDI FT245 device. If not
2755 specified, the FTDI default value is used. This setting is only valid
2756 if compiled with FTD2XX support.
2757 @end deffn
2758
2759 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster_vid_pid} vid pid
2760 The vendor ID and product ID of the FTDI FT245 device. If not specified,
2761 default values are used.
2762 Currently, only one @var{vid}, @var{pid} pair may be given, e.g. for
2763 Altera USB-Blaster (default):
2764 @example
2765 usb_blaster_vid_pid 0x09FB 0x6001
2766 @end example
2767 The following VID/PID is for Kolja Waschk's USB JTAG:
2768 @example
2769 usb_blaster_vid_pid 0x16C0 0x06AD
2770 @end example
2771 @end deffn
2772
2773 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster_pin} (@option{pin6}|@option{pin8}) (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{s}|@option{t})
2774 Sets the state or function of the unused GPIO pins on USB-Blasters
2775 (pins 6 and 8 on the female JTAG header). These pins can be used as
2776 SRST and/or TRST provided the appropriate connections are made on the
2777 target board.
2778
2779 For example, to use pin 6 as SRST:
2780 @example
2781 usb_blaster_pin pin6 s
2782 reset_config srst_only
2783 @end example
2784 @end deffn
2785
2786 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster_lowlevel_driver} (@option{ftdi}|@option{ublast2})
2787 Chooses the low level access method for the adapter. If not specified,
2788 @option{ftdi} is selected unless it wasn't enabled during the
2789 configure stage. USB-Blaster II needs @option{ublast2}.
2790 @end deffn
2791
2792 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster_firmware} @var{path}
2793 This command specifies @var{path} to access USB-Blaster II firmware
2794 image. To be used with USB-Blaster II only.
2795 @end deffn
2796
2797 @end deffn
2798
2799 @deffn {Interface Driver} {gw16012}
2800 Gateworks GW16012 JTAG programmer.
2801 This has one driver-specific command:
2802
2803 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} [port_number]
2804 Display either the address of the I/O port
2805 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2806 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
2807 This is a write-once setting.
2808 @end deffn
2809 @end deffn
2810
2811 @deffn {Interface Driver} {jlink}
2812 SEGGER J-Link family of USB adapters. It currently supports JTAG and SWD
2813 transports.
2814
2815 @quotation Compatibility Note
2816 SEGGER released many firmware versions for the many hardware versions they
2817 produced. OpenOCD was extensively tested and intended to run on all of them,
2818 but some combinations were reported as incompatible. As a general
2819 recommendation, it is advisable to use the latest firmware version
2820 available for each hardware version. However the current V8 is a moving
2821 target, and SEGGER firmware versions released after the OpenOCD was
2822 released may not be compatible. In such cases it is recommended to
2823 revert to the last known functional version. For 0.5.0, this is from
2824 "Feb 8 2012 14:30:39", packed with 4.42c. For 0.6.0, the last known
2825 version is from "May 3 2012 18:36:22", packed with 4.46f.
2826 @end quotation
2827
2828 @deffn {Command} {jlink hwstatus}
2829 Display various hardware related information, for example target voltage and pin
2830 states.
2831 @end deffn
2832 @deffn {Command} {jlink freemem}
2833 Display free device internal memory.
2834 @end deffn
2835 @deffn {Command} {jlink jtag} [@option{2}|@option{3}]
2836 Set the JTAG command version to be used. Without argument, show the actual JTAG
2837 command version.
2838 @end deffn
2839 @deffn {Command} {jlink config}
2840 Display the device configuration.
2841 @end deffn
2842 @deffn {Command} {jlink config targetpower} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2843 Set the target power state on JTAG-pin 19. Without argument, show the target
2844 power state.
2845 @end deffn
2846 @deffn {Command} {jlink config mac} [@option{ff:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff}]
2847 Set the MAC address of the device. Without argument, show the MAC address.
2848 @end deffn
2849 @deffn {Command} {jlink config ip} [@option{A.B.C.D}(@option{/E}|@option{F.G.H.I})]
2850 Set the IP configuration of the device, where A.B.C.D is the IP address, E the
2851 bit of the subnet mask and F.G.H.I the subnet mask. Without arguments, show the
2852 IP configuration.
2853 @end deffn
2854 @deffn {Command} {jlink config usb} [@option{0} to @option{3}]
2855 Set the USB address of the device. This will also change the USB Product ID
2856 (PID) of the device. Without argument, show the USB address.
2857 @end deffn
2858 @deffn {Command} {jlink config reset}
2859 Reset the current configuration.
2860 @end deffn
2861 @deffn {Command} {jlink config write}
2862 Write the current configuration to the internal persistent storage.
2863 @end deffn
2864 @deffn {Command} {jlink emucom write <channel> <data>}
2865 Write data to an EMUCOM channel. The data needs to be encoded as hexadecimal
2866 pairs.
2867
2868 The following example shows how to write the three bytes 0xaa, 0x0b and 0x23 to
2869 the EMUCOM channel 0x10:
2870 @example
2871 > jlink emucom write 0x10 aa0b23
2872 @end example
2873 @end deffn
2874 @deffn {Command} {jlink emucom read <channel> <length>}
2875 Read data from an EMUCOM channel. The read data is encoded as hexadecimal
2876 pairs.
2877
2878 The following example shows how to read 4 bytes from the EMUCOM channel 0x0:
2879 @example
2880 > jlink emucom read 0x0 4
2881 77a90000
2882 @end example
2883 @end deffn
2884 @deffn {Config} {jlink usb} <@option{0} to @option{3}>
2885 Set the USB address of the interface, in case more than one adapter is connected
2886 to the host. If not specified, USB addresses are not considered. Device
2887 selection via USB address is deprecated and the serial number should be used
2888 instead.
2889
2890 As a configuration command, it can be used only before 'init'.
2891 @end deffn
2892 @deffn {Config} {jlink serial} <serial number>
2893 Set the serial number of the interface, in case more than one adapter is
2894 connected to the host. If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2895
2896 As a configuration command, it can be used only before 'init'.
2897 @end deffn
2898 @end deffn
2899
2900 @deffn {Interface Driver} {kitprog}
2901 This driver is for Cypress Semiconductor's KitProg adapters. The KitProg is an
2902 SWD-only adapter that is designed to be used with Cypress's PSoC and PRoC device
2903 families, but it is possible to use it with some other devices. If you are using
2904 this adapter with a PSoC or a PRoC, you may need to add
2905 @command{kitprog_init_acquire_psoc} or @command{kitprog acquire_psoc} to your
2906 configuration script.
2907
2908 Note that this driver is for the proprietary KitProg protocol, not the CMSIS-DAP
2909 mode introduced in firmware 2.14. If the KitProg is in CMSIS-DAP mode, it cannot
2910 be used with this driver, and must either be used with the cmsis-dap driver or
2911 switched back to KitProg mode. See the Cypress KitProg User Guide for
2912 instructions on how to switch KitProg modes.
2913
2914 Known limitations:
2915 @itemize @bullet
2916 @item The frequency of SWCLK cannot be configured, and varies between 1.6 MHz
2917 and 2.7 MHz.
2918 @item For firmware versions below 2.14, "JTAG to SWD" sequences are replaced by
2919 "SWD line reset" in the driver. This is for two reasons. First, the KitProg does
2920 not support sending arbitrary SWD sequences, and only firmware 2.14 and later
2921 implement both "JTAG to SWD" and "SWD line reset" in firmware. Earlier firmware
2922 versions only implement "SWD line reset". Second, due to a firmware quirk, an
2923 SWD sequence must be sent after every target reset in order to re-establish
2924 communications with the target.
2925 @item Due in part to the limitation above, KitProg devices with firmware below
2926 version 2.14 will need to use @command{kitprog_init_acquire_psoc} in order to
2927 communicate with PSoC 5LP devices. This is because, assuming debug is not
2928 disabled on the PSoC, the PSoC 5LP needs its JTAG interface switched to SWD
2929 mode before communication can begin, but prior to firmware 2.14, "JTAG to SWD"
2930 could only be sent with an acquisition sequence.
2931 @end itemize
2932
2933 @deffn {Config Command} {kitprog_init_acquire_psoc}
2934 Indicate that a PSoC acquisition sequence needs to be run during adapter init.
2935 Please be aware that the acquisition sequence hard-resets the target.
2936 @end deffn
2937
2938 @deffn {Config Command} {kitprog_serial} serial
2939 Select a KitProg device by its @var{serial}. If left unspecified, the first
2940 device detected by OpenOCD will be used.
2941 @end deffn
2942
2943 @deffn {Command} {kitprog acquire_psoc}
2944 Run a PSoC acquisition sequence immediately. Typically, this should not be used
2945 outside of the target-specific configuration scripts since it hard-resets the
2946 target as a side-effect.
2947 This is necessary for "reset halt" on some PSoC 4 series devices.
2948 @end deffn
2949
2950 @deffn {Command} {kitprog info}
2951 Display various adapter information, such as the hardware version, firmware
2952 version, and target voltage.
2953 @end deffn
2954 @end deffn
2955
2956 @deffn {Interface Driver} {parport}
2957 Supports PC parallel port bit-banging cables:
2958 Wigglers, PLD download cable, and more.
2959 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2960 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2961
2962 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_cable} name
2963 Set the layout of the parallel port cable used to connect to the target.
2964 This is a write-once setting.
2965 Currently valid cable @var{name} values include:
2966
2967 @itemize @minus
2968 @item @b{altium} Altium Universal JTAG cable.
2969 @item @b{arm-jtag} Same as original wiggler except SRST and
2970 TRST connections reversed and TRST is also inverted.
2971 @item @b{chameleon} The Amontec Chameleon's CPLD when operated
2972 in configuration mode. This is only used to
2973 program the Chameleon itself, not a connected target.
2974 @item @b{dlc5} The Xilinx Parallel cable III.
2975 @item @b{flashlink} The ST Parallel cable.
2976 @item @b{lattice} Lattice ispDOWNLOAD Cable
2977 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler} The Wiggler configuration that comes with
2978 some versions of
2979 Amontec's Chameleon Programmer. The new version available from
2980 the website uses the original Wiggler layout ('@var{wiggler}')
2981 @item @b{triton} The parallel port adapter found on the
2982 ``Karo Triton 1 Development Board''.
2983 This is also the layout used by the HollyGates design
2984 (see @uref{http://www.lartmaker.nl/projects/jtag/}).
2985 @item @b{wiggler} The original Wiggler layout, also supported by
2986 several clones, such as the Olimex ARM-JTAG
2987 @item @b{wiggler2} Same as original wiggler except an led is fitted on D5.
2988 @item @b{wiggler_ntrst_inverted} Same as original wiggler except TRST is inverted.
2989 @end itemize
2990 @end deffn
2991
2992 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} [port_number]
2993 Display either the address of the I/O port
2994 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2995 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
2996 This is a write-once setting.
2997
2998 When using PPDEV to access the parallel port, use the number of the parallel port:
2999 @option{parport_port 0} (the default). If @option{parport_port 0x378} is specified
3000 you may encounter a problem.
3001 @end deffn
3002
3003 @deffn Command {parport_toggling_time} [nanoseconds]
3004 Displays how many nanoseconds the hardware needs to toggle TCK;
3005 the parport driver uses this value to obey the
3006 @command{adapter speed} configuration.
3007 When the optional @var{nanoseconds} parameter is given,
3008 that setting is changed before displaying the current value.
3009
3010 The default setting should work reasonably well on commodity PC hardware.
3011 However, you may want to calibrate for your specific hardware.
3012 @quotation Tip
3013 To measure the toggling time with a logic analyzer or a digital storage
3014 oscilloscope, follow the procedure below:
3015 @example
3016 > parport_toggling_time 1000
3017 > adapter speed 500
3018 @end example
3019 This sets the maximum JTAG clock speed of the hardware, but
3020 the actual speed probably deviates from the requested 500 kHz.
3021 Now, measure the time between the two closest spaced TCK transitions.
3022 You can use @command{runtest 1000} or something similar to generate a
3023 large set of samples.
3024 Update the setting to match your measurement:
3025 @example
3026 > parport_toggling_time <measured nanoseconds>
3027 @end example
3028 Now the clock speed will be a better match for @command{adapter speed}
3029 command given in OpenOCD scripts and event handlers.
3030
3031 You can do something similar with many digital multimeters, but note
3032 that you'll probably need to run the clock continuously for several
3033 seconds before it decides what clock rate to show. Adjust the
3034 toggling time up or down until the measured clock rate is a good
3035 match with the rate you specified in the @command{adapter speed} command;
3036 be conservative.
3037 @end quotation
3038 @end deffn
3039
3040 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_write_on_exit} (@option{on}|@option{off})
3041 This will configure the parallel driver to write a known
3042 cable-specific value to the parallel interface on exiting OpenOCD.
3043 @end deffn
3044
3045 For example, the interface configuration file for a
3046 classic ``Wiggler'' cable on LPT2 might look something like this:
3047
3048 @example
3049 adapter driver parport
3050 parport_port 0x278
3051 parport_cable wiggler
3052 @end example
3053 @end deffn
3054
3055 @deffn {Interface Driver} {presto}
3056 ASIX PRESTO USB JTAG programmer.
3057 @deffn {Config Command} {presto_serial} serial_string
3058 Configures the USB serial number of the Presto device to use.
3059 @end deffn
3060 @end deffn
3061
3062 @deffn {Interface Driver} {rlink}
3063 Raisonance RLink USB adapter
3064 @end deffn
3065
3066 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usbprog}
3067 usbprog is a freely programmable USB adapter.
3068 @end deffn
3069
3070 @deffn {Interface Driver} {vsllink}
3071 vsllink is part of Versaloon which is a versatile USB programmer.
3072
3073 @quotation Note
3074 This defines quite a few driver-specific commands,
3075 which are not currently documented here.
3076 @end quotation
3077 @end deffn
3078
3079 @anchor{hla_interface}
3080 @deffn {Interface Driver} {hla}
3081 This is a driver that supports multiple High Level Adapters.
3082 This type of adapter does not expose some of the lower level api's
3083 that OpenOCD would normally use to access the target.
3084
3085 Currently supported adapters include the STMicroelectronics ST-LINK and TI ICDI.
3086 ST-LINK firmware version >= V2.J21.S4 recommended due to issues with earlier
3087 versions of firmware where serial number is reset after first use. Suggest
3088 using ST firmware update utility to upgrade ST-LINK firmware even if current
3089 version reported is V2.J21.S4.
3090
3091 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_device_desc} description
3092 Currently Not Supported.
3093 @end deffn
3094
3095 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_serial} serial
3096 Specifies the serial number of the adapter.
3097 @end deffn
3098
3099 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_layout} (@option{stlink}|@option{icdi})
3100 Specifies the adapter layout to use.
3101 @end deffn
3102
3103 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
3104 Pairs of vendor IDs and product IDs of the device.
3105 @end deffn
3106
3107 @deffn {Command} {hla_command} command
3108 Execute a custom adapter-specific command. The @var{command} string is
3109 passed as is to the underlying adapter layout handler.
3110 @end deffn
3111 @end deffn
3112
3113 @anchor{st_link_dap_interface}
3114 @deffn {Interface Driver} {st-link}
3115 This is a driver that supports STMicroelectronics adapters ST-LINK/V2
3116 (from firmware V2J24) and STLINK-V3, thanks to a new API that provides
3117 directly access the arm ADIv5 DAP.
3118
3119 The new API provide access to multiple AP on the same DAP, but the
3120 maximum number of the AP port is limited by the specific firmware version
3121 (e.g. firmware V2J29 has 3 as maximum AP number, while V2J32 has 8).
3122 An error is returned for any AP number above the maximum allowed value.
3123
3124 @emph{Note:} Either these same adapters and their older versions are
3125 also supported by @ref{hla_interface, the hla interface driver}.
3126
3127 @deffn {Config Command} {st-link serial} serial
3128 Specifies the serial number of the adapter.
3129 @end deffn
3130
3131 @deffn {Config Command} {st-link vid_pid} [vid pid]+
3132 Pairs of vendor IDs and product IDs of the device.
3133 @end deffn
3134 @end deffn
3135
3136 @deffn {Interface Driver} {opendous}
3137 opendous-jtag is a freely programmable USB adapter.
3138 @end deffn
3139
3140 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ulink}
3141 This is the Keil ULINK v1 JTAG debugger.
3142 @end deffn
3143
3144 @deffn {Interface Driver} {xlnx_pcie_xvc}
3145 This driver supports the Xilinx Virtual Cable (XVC) over PCI Express.
3146 It is commonly found in Xilinx based PCI Express designs. It allows debugging
3147 fabric based JTAG devices such as Cortex-M1/M3 microcontrollers. Access to this is
3148 exposed via extended capability registers in the PCI Express configuration space.
3149
3150 For more information see Xilinx PG245 (Section on From_PCIE_to_JTAG mode).
3151
3152 @deffn {Config Command} {xlnx_pcie_xvc_config} device
3153 Specifies the PCI Express device via parameter @var{device} to use.
3154
3155 The correct value for @var{device} can be obtained by looking at the output
3156 of lscpi -D (first column) for the corresponding device.
3157
3158 The string will be of the format "DDDD:BB:SS.F" such as "0000:65:00.1".
3159
3160 @end deffn
3161 @end deffn
3162
3163 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ZY1000}
3164 This is the Zylin ZY1000 JTAG debugger.
3165 @end deffn
3166
3167 @quotation Note
3168 This defines some driver-specific commands,
3169 which are not currently documented here.
3170 @end quotation
3171
3172 @deffn Command power [@option{on}|@option{off}]
3173 Turn power switch to target on/off.
3174 No arguments: print status.
3175 @end deffn
3176
3177 @deffn {Interface Driver} {bcm2835gpio}
3178 This SoC is present in Raspberry Pi which is a cheap single-board computer
3179 exposing some GPIOs on its expansion header.
3180
3181 The driver accesses memory-mapped GPIO peripheral registers directly
3182 for maximum performance, but the only possible race condition is for
3183 the pins' modes/muxing (which is highly unlikely), so it should be
3184 able to coexist nicely with both sysfs bitbanging and various
3185 peripherals' kernel drivers. The driver restores the previous
3186 configuration on exit.
3187
3188 See @file{interface/raspberrypi-native.cfg} for a sample config and
3189 pinout.
3190
3191 @end deffn
3192
3193 @deffn {Interface Driver} {imx_gpio}
3194 i.MX SoC is present in many community boards. Wandboard is an example
3195 of the one which is most popular.
3196
3197 This driver is mostly the same as bcm2835gpio.
3198
3199 See @file{interface/imx-native.cfg} for a sample config and
3200 pinout.
3201
3202 @end deffn
3203
3204
3205 @deffn {Interface Driver} {openjtag}
3206 OpenJTAG compatible USB adapter.
3207 This defines some driver-specific commands:
3208
3209 @deffn {Config Command} {openjtag_variant} variant
3210 Specifies the variant of the OpenJTAG adapter (see @uref{http://www.openjtag.org/}).
3211 Currently valid @var{variant} values include:
3212
3213 @itemize @minus
3214 @item @b{standard} Standard variant (default).
3215 @item @b{cy7c65215} Cypress CY7C65215 Dual Channel USB-Serial Bridge Controller
3216 (see @uref{http://www.cypress.com/?rID=82870}).
3217 @end itemize
3218 @end deffn
3219
3220 @deffn {Config Command} {openjtag_device_desc} string
3221 The USB device description string of the adapter.
3222 This value is only used with the standard variant.
3223 @end deffn
3224 @end deffn
3225
3226 @section Transport Configuration
3227 @cindex Transport
3228 As noted earlier, depending on the version of OpenOCD you use,
3229 and the debug adapter you are using,
3230 several transports may be available to
3231 communicate with debug targets (or perhaps to program flash memory).
3232 @deffn Command {transport list}
3233 displays the names of the transports supported by this
3234 version of OpenOCD.
3235 @end deffn
3236
3237 @deffn Command {transport select} @option{transport_name}
3238 Select which of the supported transports to use in this OpenOCD session.
3239
3240 When invoked with @option{transport_name}, attempts to select the named
3241 transport. The transport must be supported by the debug adapter
3242 hardware and by the version of OpenOCD you are using (including the
3243 adapter's driver).
3244
3245 If no transport has been selected and no @option{transport_name} is
3246 provided, @command{transport select} auto-selects the first transport
3247 supported by the debug adapter.
3248
3249 @command{transport select} always returns the name of the session's selected
3250 transport, if any.
3251 @end deffn
3252
3253 @subsection JTAG Transport
3254 @cindex JTAG
3255 JTAG is the original transport supported by OpenOCD, and most
3256 of the OpenOCD commands support it.
3257 JTAG transports expose a chain of one or more Test Access Points (TAPs),
3258 each of which must be explicitly declared.
3259 JTAG supports both debugging and boundary scan testing.
3260 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3261
3262 JTAG transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
3263 jtag}. Unless your adapter uses either @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
3264 driver} (in which case the command is @command{transport select hla_jtag})
3265 or @ref{st_link_dap_interface,the st-link interface driver} (in which case
3266 the command is @command{transport select dapdirect_jtag}).
3267
3268 @subsection SWD Transport
3269 @cindex SWD
3270 @cindex Serial Wire Debug
3271 SWD (Serial Wire Debug) is an ARM-specific transport which exposes one
3272 Debug Access Point (DAP, which must be explicitly declared.
3273 (SWD uses fewer signal wires than JTAG.)
3274 SWD is debug-oriented, and does not support boundary scan testing.
3275 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3276 (Some processors support both JTAG and SWD.)
3277
3278 SWD transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
3279 swd}. Unless your adapter uses either @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
3280 driver} (in which case the command is @command{transport select hla_swd})
3281 or @ref{st_link_dap_interface,the st-link interface driver} (in which case
3282 the command is @command{transport select dapdirect_swd}).
3283
3284 @deffn Command {swd newdap} ...
3285 Declares a single DAP which uses SWD transport.
3286 Parameters are currently the same as "jtag newtap" but this is
3287 expected to change.
3288 @end deffn
3289 @deffn Command {swd wcr trn prescale}
3290 Updates TRN (turnaround delay) and prescaling.fields of the
3291 Wire Control Register (WCR).
3292 No parameters: displays current settings.
3293 @end deffn
3294
3295 @subsection SPI Transport
3296 @cindex SPI
3297 @cindex Serial Peripheral Interface
3298 The Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) is a general purpose transport
3299 which uses four wire signaling. Some processors use it as part of a
3300 solution for flash programming.
3301
3302 @anchor{jtagspeed}
3303 @section JTAG Speed
3304 JTAG clock setup is part of system setup.
3305 It @emph{does not belong with interface setup} since any interface
3306 only knows a few of the constraints for the JTAG clock speed.
3307 Sometimes the JTAG speed is
3308 changed during the target initialization process: (1) slow at
3309 reset, (2) program the CPU clocks, (3) run fast.
3310 Both the "slow" and "fast" clock rates are functions of the
3311 oscillators used, the chip, the board design, and sometimes
3312 power management software that may be active.
3313
3314 The speed used during reset, and the scan chain verification which
3315 follows reset, can be adjusted using a @code{reset-start}
3316 target event handler.
3317 It can then be reconfigured to a faster speed by a
3318 @code{reset-init} target event handler after it reprograms those
3319 CPU clocks, or manually (if something else, such as a boot loader,
3320 sets up those clocks).
3321 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
3322 When the initial low JTAG speed is a chip characteristic, perhaps
3323 because of a required oscillator speed, provide such a handler
3324 in the target config file.
3325 When that speed is a function of a board-specific characteristic
3326 such as which speed oscillator is used, it belongs in the board
3327 config file instead.
3328 In both cases it's safest to also set the initial JTAG clock rate
3329 to that same slow speed, so that OpenOCD never starts up using a
3330 clock speed that's faster than the scan chain can support.
3331
3332 @example
3333 jtag_rclk 3000
3334 $_TARGET.cpu configure -event reset-start @{ jtag_rclk 3000 @}
3335 @end example
3336
3337 If your system supports adaptive clocking (RTCK), configuring
3338 JTAG to use that is probably the most robust approach.
3339 However, it introduces delays to synchronize clocks; so it
3340 may not be the fastest solution.
3341
3342 @b{NOTE:} Script writers should consider using @command{jtag_rclk}
3343 instead of @command{adapter speed}, but only for (ARM) cores and boards
3344 which support adaptive clocking.
3345
3346 @deffn {Command} adapter speed max_speed_kHz
3347 A non-zero speed is in KHZ. Hence: 3000 is 3mhz.
3348 JTAG interfaces usually support a limited number of
3349 speeds. The speed actually used won't be faster
3350 than the speed specified.
3351
3352 Chip data sheets generally include a top JTAG clock rate.
3353 The actual rate is often a function of a CPU core clock,
3354 and is normally less than that peak rate.
3355 For example, most ARM cores accept at most one sixth of the CPU clock.
3356
3357 Speed 0 (khz) selects RTCK method.
3358 @xref{faqrtck,,FAQ RTCK}.
3359 If your system uses RTCK, you won't need to change the
3360 JTAG clocking after setup.
3361 Not all interfaces, boards, or targets support ``rtck''.
3362 If the interface device can not
3363 support it, an error is returned when you try to use RTCK.
3364 @end deffn
3365
3366 @defun jtag_rclk fallback_speed_kHz
3367 @cindex adaptive clocking
3368 @cindex RTCK
3369 This Tcl proc (defined in @file{startup.tcl}) attempts to enable RTCK/RCLK.
3370 If that fails (maybe the interface, board, or target doesn't
3371 support it), falls back to the specified frequency.
3372 @example
3373 # Fall back to 3mhz if RTCK is not supported
3374 jtag_rclk 3000
3375 @end example
3376 @end defun
3377
3378 @node Reset Configuration
3379 @chapter Reset Configuration
3380 @cindex Reset Configuration
3381
3382 Every system configuration may require a different reset
3383 configuration. This can also be quite confusing.
3384 Resets also interact with @var{reset-init} event handlers,
3385 which do things like setting up clocks and DRAM, and
3386 JTAG clock rates. (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.)
3387 They can also interact with JTAG routers.
3388 Please see the various board files for examples.
3389
3390 @quotation Note
3391 To maintainers and integrators:
3392 Reset configuration touches several things at once.
3393 Normally the board configuration file
3394 should define it and assume that the JTAG adapter supports
3395 everything that's wired up to the board's JTAG connector.
3396
3397 However, the target configuration file could also make note
3398 of something the silicon vendor has done inside the chip,
3399 which will be true for most (or all) boards using that chip.
3400 And when the JTAG adapter doesn't support everything, the
3401 user configuration file will need to override parts of
3402 the reset configuration provided by other files.
3403 @end quotation
3404
3405 @section Types of Reset
3406
3407 There are many kinds of reset possible through JTAG, but
3408 they may not all work with a given board and adapter.
3409 That's part of why reset configuration can be error prone.
3410
3411 @itemize @bullet
3412 @item
3413 @emph{System Reset} ... the @emph{SRST} hardware signal
3414 resets all chips connected to the JTAG adapter, such as processors,
3415 power management chips, and I/O controllers. Normally resets triggered
3416 with this signal behave exactly like pressing a RESET button.
3417 @item
3418 @emph{JTAG TAP Reset} ... the @emph{TRST} hardware signal resets
3419 just the TAP controllers connected to the JTAG adapter.
3420 Such resets should not be visible to the rest of the system; resetting a
3421 device's TAP controller just puts that controller into a known state.
3422 @item
3423 @emph{Emulation Reset} ... many devices can be reset through JTAG
3424 commands. These resets are often distinguishable from system
3425 resets, either explicitly (a "reset reason" register says so)
3426 or implicitly (not all parts of the chip get reset).
3427 @item
3428 @emph{Other Resets} ... system-on-chip devices often support
3429 several other types of reset.
3430 You may need to arrange that a watchdog timer stops
3431 while debugging, preventing a watchdog reset.
3432 There may be individual module resets.
3433 @end itemize
3434
3435 In the best case, OpenOCD can hold SRST, then reset
3436 the TAPs via TRST and send commands through JTAG to halt the
3437 CPU at the reset vector before the 1st instruction is executed.
3438 Then when it finally releases the SRST signal, the system is
3439 halted under debugger control before any code has executed.
3440 This is the behavior required to support the @command{reset halt}
3441 and @command{reset init} commands; after @command{reset init} a
3442 board-specific script might do things like setting up DRAM.
3443 (@xref{resetcommand,,Reset Command}.)
3444
3445 @anchor{srstandtrstissues}
3446 @section SRST and TRST Issues
3447
3448 Because SRST and TRST are hardware signals, they can have a
3449 variety of system-specific constraints. Some of the most
3450 common issues are:
3451
3452 @itemize @bullet
3453
3454 @item @emph{Signal not available} ... Some boards don't wire
3455 SRST or TRST to the JTAG connector. Some JTAG adapters don't
3456 support such signals even if they are wired up.
3457 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{signals} options to say
3458 when either of those signals is not connected.
3459 When SRST is not available, your code might not be able to rely
3460 on controllers having been fully reset during code startup.
3461 Missing TRST is not a problem, since JTAG-level resets can
3462 be triggered using with TMS signaling.
3463
3464 @item @emph{Signals shorted} ... Sometimes a chip, board, or
3465 adapter will connect SRST to TRST, instead of keeping them separate.
3466 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{combination} options to say
3467 when those signals aren't properly independent.
3468
3469 @item @emph{Timing} ... Reset circuitry like a resistor/capacitor
3470 delay circuit, reset supervisor, or on-chip features can extend
3471 the effect of a JTAG adapter's reset for some time after the adapter
3472 stops issuing the reset. For example, there may be chip or board
3473 requirements that all reset pulses last for at least a
3474 certain amount of time; and reset buttons commonly have
3475 hardware debouncing.
3476 Use the @command{adapter srst delay} and @command{jtag_ntrst_delay}
3477 commands to say when extra delays are needed.
3478
3479 @item @emph{Drive type} ... Reset lines often have a pullup
3480 resistor, letting the JTAG interface treat them as open-drain
3481 signals. But that's not a requirement, so the adapter may need
3482 to use push/pull output drivers.
3483 Also, with weak pullups it may be advisable to drive
3484 signals to both levels (push/pull) to minimize rise times.
3485 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{trst_type} and
3486 @var{srst_type} parameters to say how to drive reset signals.
3487
3488 @item @emph{Special initialization} ... Targets sometimes need
3489 special JTAG initialization sequences to handle chip-specific
3490 issues (not limited to errata).
3491 For example, certain JTAG commands might need to be issued while
3492 the system as a whole is in a reset state (SRST active)
3493 but the JTAG scan chain is usable (TRST inactive).
3494 Many systems treat combined assertion of SRST and TRST as a
3495 trigger for a harder reset than SRST alone.
3496 Such custom reset handling is discussed later in this chapter.
3497 @end itemize
3498
3499 There can also be other issues.
3500 Some devices don't fully conform to the JTAG specifications.
3501 Trivial system-specific differences are common, such as
3502 SRST and TRST using slightly different names.
3503 There are also vendors who distribute key JTAG documentation for
3504 their chips only to developers who have signed a Non-Disclosure
3505 Agreement (NDA).
3506
3507 Sometimes there are chip-specific extensions like a requirement to use
3508 the normally-optional TRST signal (precluding use of JTAG adapters which
3509 don't pass TRST through), or needing extra steps to complete a TAP reset.
3510
3511 In short, SRST and especially TRST handling may be very finicky,
3512 needing to cope with both architecture and board specific constraints.
3513
3514 @section Commands for Handling Resets
3515
3516 @deffn {Command} adapter srst pulse_width milliseconds
3517 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3518 after asserting nSRST (active-low system reset) before
3519 allowing it to be deasserted.
3520 @end deffn
3521
3522 @deffn {Command} adapter srst delay milliseconds
3523 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3524 nSRST (active-low system reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3525 When a board has a reset button connected to SRST line it will
3526 probably have hardware debouncing, implying you should use this.
3527 @end deffn
3528
3529 @deffn {Command} jtag_ntrst_assert_width milliseconds
3530 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3531 after asserting nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before
3532 allowing it to be deasserted.
3533 @end deffn
3534
3535 @deffn {Command} jtag_ntrst_delay milliseconds
3536 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3537 nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3538 @end deffn
3539
3540 @anchor{reset_config}
3541 @deffn {Command} reset_config mode_flag ...
3542 This command displays or modifies the reset configuration
3543 of your combination of JTAG board and target in target
3544 configuration scripts.
3545
3546 Information earlier in this section describes the kind of problems
3547 the command is intended to address (@pxref{srstandtrstissues,,SRST and TRST Issues}).
3548 As a rule this command belongs only in board config files,
3549 describing issues like @emph{board doesn't connect TRST};
3550 or in user config files, addressing limitations derived
3551 from a particular combination of interface and board.
3552 (An unlikely example would be using a TRST-only adapter
3553 with a board that only wires up SRST.)
3554
3555 The @var{mode_flag} options can be specified in any order, but only one
3556 of each type -- @var{signals}, @var{combination}, @var{gates},
3557 @var{trst_type}, @var{srst_type} and @var{connect_type}
3558 -- may be specified at a time.
3559 If you don't provide a new value for a given type, its previous
3560 value (perhaps the default) is unchanged.
3561 For example, this means that you don't need to say anything at all about
3562 TRST just to declare that if the JTAG adapter should want to drive SRST,
3563 it must explicitly be driven high (@option{srst_push_pull}).
3564
3565 @itemize
3566 @item
3567 @var{signals} can specify which of the reset signals are connected.
3568 For example, If the JTAG interface provides SRST, but the board doesn't
3569 connect that signal properly, then OpenOCD can't use it.
3570 Possible values are @option{none} (the default), @option{trst_only},
3571 @option{srst_only} and @option{trst_and_srst}.
3572
3573 @quotation Tip
3574 If your board provides SRST and/or TRST through the JTAG connector,
3575 you must declare that so those signals can be used.
3576 @end quotation
3577
3578 @item
3579 The @var{combination} is an optional value specifying broken reset
3580 signal implementations.
3581 The default behaviour if no option given is @option{separate},
3582 indicating everything behaves normally.
3583 @option{srst_pulls_trst} states that the
3584 test logic is reset together with the reset of the system (e.g. NXP
3585 LPC2000, "broken" board layout), @option{trst_pulls_srst} says that
3586 the system is reset together with the test logic (only hypothetical, I
3587 haven't seen hardware with such a bug, and can be worked around).
3588 @option{combined} implies both @option{srst_pulls_trst} and
3589 @option{trst_pulls_srst}.
3590
3591 @item
3592 The @var{gates} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3593 JTAG may be unavailable during reset.
3594 @option{srst_gates_jtag} (default)
3595 indicates that asserting SRST gates the
3596 JTAG clock. This means that no communication can happen on JTAG
3597 while SRST is asserted.
3598 Its converse is @option{srst_nogate}, indicating that JTAG commands
3599 can safely be issued while SRST is active.
3600
3601 @item
3602 The @var{connect_type} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3603 SRST is asserted while connecting to the target. @option{srst_nogate}
3604 is required to use this option.
3605 @option{connect_deassert_srst} (default)
3606 indicates that SRST will not be asserted while connecting to the target.
3607 Its converse is @option{connect_assert_srst}, indicating that SRST will
3608 be asserted before any target connection.
3609 Only some targets support this feature, STM32 and STR9 are examples.
3610 This feature is useful if you are unable to connect to your target due
3611 to incorrect options byte config or illegal program execution.
3612 @end itemize
3613
3614 The optional @var{trst_type} and @var{srst_type} parameters allow the
3615 driver mode of each reset line to be specified. These values only affect
3616 JTAG interfaces with support for different driver modes, like the Amontec
3617 JTAGkey and JTAG Accelerator. Also, they are necessarily ignored if the
3618 relevant signal (TRST or SRST) is not connected.
3619
3620 @itemize
3621 @item
3622 Possible @var{trst_type} driver modes for the test reset signal (TRST)
3623 are the default @option{trst_push_pull}, and @option{trst_open_drain}.
3624 Most boards connect this signal to a pulldown, so the JTAG TAPs
3625 never leave reset unless they are hooked up to a JTAG adapter.
3626
3627 @item
3628 Possible @var{srst_type} driver modes for the system reset signal (SRST)
3629 are the default @option{srst_open_drain}, and @option{srst_push_pull}.
3630 Most boards connect this signal to a pullup, and allow the
3631 signal to be pulled low by various events including system
3632 power-up and pressing a reset button.
3633 @end itemize
3634 @end deffn
3635
3636 @section Custom Reset Handling
3637 @cindex events
3638
3639 OpenOCD has several ways to help support the various reset
3640 mechanisms provided by chip and board vendors.
3641 The commands shown in the previous section give standard parameters.
3642 There are also @emph{event handlers} associated with TAPs or Targets.
3643 Those handlers are Tcl procedures you can provide, which are invoked
3644 at particular points in the reset sequence.
3645
3646 @emph{When SRST is not an option} you must set
3647 up a @code{reset-assert} event handler for your target.
3648 For example, some JTAG adapters don't include the SRST signal;
3649 and some boards have multiple targets, and you won't always
3650 want to reset everything at once.
3651
3652 After configuring those mechanisms, you might still
3653 find your board doesn't start up or reset correctly.
3654 For example, maybe it needs a slightly different sequence
3655 of SRST and/or TRST manipulations, because of quirks that
3656 the @command{reset_config} mechanism doesn't address;
3657 or asserting both might trigger a stronger reset, which
3658 needs special attention.
3659
3660 Experiment with lower level operations, such as
3661 @command{adapter assert}, @command{adapter deassert}
3662 and the @command{jtag arp_*} operations shown here,
3663 to find a sequence of operations that works.
3664 @xref{JTAG Commands}.
3665 When you find a working sequence, it can be used to override
3666 @command{jtag_init}, which fires during OpenOCD startup
3667 (@pxref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage});
3668 or @command{init_reset}, which fires during reset processing.
3669
3670 You might also want to provide some project-specific reset
3671 schemes. For example, on a multi-target board the standard
3672 @command{reset} command would reset all targets, but you
3673 may need the ability to reset only one target at time and
3674 thus want to avoid using the board-wide SRST signal.
3675
3676 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} init_reset mode
3677 This is invoked near the beginning of the @command{reset} command,
3678 usually to provide as much of a cold (power-up) reset as practical.
3679 By default it is also invoked from @command{jtag_init} if
3680 the scan chain does not respond to pure JTAG operations.
3681 The @var{mode} parameter is the parameter given to the
3682 low level reset command (@option{halt},
3683 @option{init}, or @option{run}), @option{setup},
3684 or potentially some other value.
3685
3686 The default implementation just invokes @command{jtag arp_init-reset}.
3687 Replacements will normally build on low level JTAG
3688 operations such as @command{adapter assert} and @command{adapter deassert}.
3689 Operations here must not address individual TAPs
3690 (or their associated targets)
3691 until the JTAG scan chain has first been verified to work.
3692
3693 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
3694 they return.
3695 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
3696 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
3697 @end deffn
3698
3699 @deffn Command {jtag arp_init}
3700 This validates the scan chain using just the four
3701 standard JTAG signals (TMS, TCK, TDI, TDO).
3702 It starts by issuing a JTAG-only reset.
3703 Then it performs checks to verify that the scan chain configuration
3704 matches the TAPs it can observe.
3705 Those checks include checking IDCODE values for each active TAP,
3706 and verifying the length of their instruction registers using
3707 TAP @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} values.
3708 If these tests all pass, TAP @code{setup} events are
3709 issued to all TAPs with handlers for that event.
3710 @end deffn
3711
3712 @deffn Command {jtag arp_init-reset}
3713 This uses TRST and SRST to try resetting
3714 everything on the JTAG scan chain
3715 (and anything else connected to SRST).
3716 It then invokes the logic of @command{jtag arp_init}.
3717 @end deffn
3718
3719
3720 @node TAP Declaration
3721 @chapter TAP Declaration
3722 @cindex TAP declaration
3723 @cindex TAP configuration
3724
3725 @emph{Test Access Ports} (TAPs) are the core of JTAG.
3726 TAPs serve many roles, including:
3727
3728 @itemize @bullet
3729 @item @b{Debug Target} A CPU TAP can be used as a GDB debug target.
3730 @item @b{Flash Programming} Some chips program the flash directly via JTAG.
3731 Others do it indirectly, making a CPU do it.
3732 @item @b{Program Download} Using the same CPU support GDB uses,
3733 you can initialize a DRAM controller, download code to DRAM, and then
3734 start running that code.
3735 @item @b{Boundary Scan} Most chips support boundary scan, which
3736 helps test for board assembly problems like solder bridges
3737 and missing connections.
3738 @end itemize
3739
3740 OpenOCD must know about the active TAPs on your board(s).
3741 Setting up the TAPs is the core task of your configuration files.
3742 Once those TAPs are set up, you can pass their names to code
3743 which sets up CPUs and exports them as GDB targets,
3744 probes flash memory, performs low-level JTAG operations, and more.
3745
3746 @section Scan Chains
3747 @cindex scan chain
3748
3749 TAPs are part of a hardware @dfn{scan chain},
3750 which is a daisy chain of TAPs.
3751 They also need to be added to
3752 OpenOCD's software mirror of that hardware list,
3753 giving each member a name and associating other data with it.
3754 Simple scan chains, with a single TAP, are common in
3755 systems with a single microcontroller or microprocessor.
3756 More complex chips may have several TAPs internally.
3757 Very complex scan chains might have a dozen or more TAPs:
3758 several in one chip, more in the next, and connecting
3759 to other boards with their own chips and TAPs.
3760
3761 You can display the list with the @command{scan_chain} command.
3762 (Don't confuse this with the list displayed by the @command{targets}
3763 command, presented in the next chapter.
3764 That only displays TAPs for CPUs which are configured as
3765 debugging targets.)
3766 Here's what the scan chain might look like for a chip more than one TAP:
3767
3768 @verbatim
3769 TapName Enabled IdCode Expected IrLen IrCap IrMask
3770 -- ------------------ ------- ---------- ---------- ----- ----- ------
3771 0 omap5912.dsp Y 0x03df1d81 0x03df1d81 38 0x01 0x03
3772 1 omap5912.arm Y 0x0692602f 0x0692602f 4 0x01 0x0f
3773 2 omap5912.unknown Y 0x00000000 0x00000000 8 0x01 0x03
3774 @end verbatim
3775
3776 OpenOCD can detect some of that information, but not all
3777 of it. @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
3778 Unfortunately, those TAPs can't always be autoconfigured,
3779 because not all devices provide good support for that.
3780 JTAG doesn't require supporting IDCODE instructions, and
3781 chips with JTAG routers may not link TAPs into the chain
3782 until they are told to do so.
3783
3784 The configuration mechanism currently supported by OpenOCD
3785 requires explicit configuration of all TAP devices using
3786 @command{jtag newtap} commands, as detailed later in this chapter.
3787 A command like this would declare one tap and name it @code{chip1.cpu}:
3788
3789 @example
3790 jtag newtap chip1 cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id 0x3ba00477
3791 @end example
3792
3793 Each target configuration file lists the TAPs provided
3794 by a given chip.
3795 Board configuration files combine all the targets on a board,
3796 and so forth.
3797 Note that @emph{the order in which TAPs are declared is very important.}
3798 That declaration order must match the order in the JTAG scan chain,
3799 both inside a single chip and between them.
3800 @xref{faqtaporder,,FAQ TAP Order}.
3801
3802 For example, the STMicroelectronics STR912 chip has
3803 three separate TAPs@footnote{See the ST
3804 document titled: @emph{STR91xFAxxx, Section 3.15 Jtag Interface, Page:
3805 28/102, Figure 3: JTAG chaining inside the STR91xFA}.
3806 @url{http://eu.st.com/stonline/products/literature/ds/13495.pdf}}.
3807 To configure those taps, @file{target/str912.cfg}
3808 includes commands something like this:
3809
3810 @example
3811 jtag newtap str912 flash ... params ...
3812 jtag newtap str912 cpu ... params ...
3813 jtag newtap str912 bs ... params ...
3814 @end example
3815
3816 Actual config files typically use a variable such as @code{$_CHIPNAME}
3817 instead of literals like @option{str912}, to support more than one chip
3818 of each type. @xref{Config File Guidelines}.
3819
3820 @deffn Command {jtag names}
3821 Returns the names of all current TAPs in the scan chain.
3822 Use @command{jtag cget} or @command{jtag tapisenabled}
3823 to examine attributes and state of each TAP.
3824 @example
3825 foreach t [jtag names] @{
3826 puts [format "TAP: %s\n" $t]
3827 @}
3828 @end example
3829 @end deffn
3830
3831 @deffn Command {scan_chain}
3832 Displays the TAPs in the scan chain configuration,
3833 and their status.
3834 The set of TAPs listed by this command is fixed by
3835 exiting the OpenOCD configuration stage,
3836 but systems with a JTAG router can
3837 enable or disable TAPs dynamically.
3838 @end deffn
3839
3840 @c FIXME! "jtag cget" should be able to return all TAP
3841 @c attributes, like "$target_name cget" does for targets.
3842
3843 @c Probably want "jtag eventlist", and a "tap-reset" event
3844 @c (on entry to RESET state).
3845
3846 @section TAP Names
3847 @cindex dotted name
3848
3849 When TAP objects are declared with @command{jtag newtap},
3850 a @dfn{dotted.name} is created for the TAP, combining the
3851 name of a module (usually a chip) and a label for the TAP.
3852 For example: @code{xilinx.tap}, @code{str912.flash},
3853 @code{omap3530.jrc}, @code{dm6446.dsp}, or @code{stm32.cpu}.
3854 Many other commands use that dotted.name to manipulate or
3855 refer to the TAP. For example, CPU configuration uses the
3856 name, as does declaration of NAND or NOR flash banks.
3857
3858 The components of a dotted name should follow ``C'' symbol
3859 name rules: start with an alphabetic character, then numbers
3860 and underscores are OK; while others (including dots!) are not.
3861
3862 @section TAP Declaration Commands
3863
3864 @c shouldn't this be(come) a {Config Command}?
3865 @deffn Command {jtag newtap} chipname tapname configparams...
3866 Declares a new TAP with the dotted name @var{chipname}.@var{tapname},
3867 and configured according to the various @var{configparams}.
3868
3869 The @var{chipname} is a symbolic name for the chip.
3870 Conventionally target config files use @code{$_CHIPNAME},
3871 defaulting to the model name given by the chip vendor but
3872 overridable.
3873
3874 @cindex TAP naming convention
3875 The @var{tapname} reflects the role of that TAP,
3876 and should follow this convention:
3877
3878 @itemize @bullet
3879 @item @code{bs} -- For boundary scan if this is a separate TAP;
3880 @item @code{cpu} -- The main CPU of the chip, alternatively
3881 @code{arm} and @code{dsp} on chips with both ARM and DSP CPUs,
3882 @code{arm1} and @code{arm2} on chips with two ARMs, and so forth;
3883 @item @code{etb} -- For an embedded trace buffer (example: an ARM ETB11);
3884 @item @code{flash} -- If the chip has a flash TAP, like the str912;
3885 @item @code{jrc} -- For JTAG route controller (example: the ICEPick modules
3886 on many Texas Instruments chips, like the OMAP3530 on Beagleboards);
3887 @item @code{tap} -- Should be used only for FPGA- or CPLD-like devices
3888 with a single TAP;
3889 @item @code{unknownN} -- If you have no idea what the TAP is for (N is a number);
3890 @item @emph{when in doubt} -- Use the chip maker's name in their data sheet.
3891 For example, the Freescale i.MX31 has a SDMA (Smart DMA) with
3892 a JTAG TAP; that TAP should be named @code{sdma}.
3893 @end itemize
3894
3895 Every TAP requires at least the following @var{configparams}:
3896
3897 @itemize @bullet
3898 @item @code{-irlen} @var{NUMBER}
3899 @*The length in bits of the
3900 instruction register, such as 4 or 5 bits.
3901 @end itemize
3902
3903 A TAP may also provide optional @var{configparams}:
3904
3905 @itemize @bullet
3906 @item @code{-disable} (or @code{-enable})
3907 @*Use the @code{-disable} parameter to flag a TAP which is not
3908 linked into the scan chain after a reset using either TRST
3909 or the JTAG state machine's @sc{reset} state.
3910 You may use @code{-enable} to highlight the default state
3911 (the TAP is linked in).
3912 @xref{enablinganddisablingtaps,,Enabling and Disabling TAPs}.
3913 @item @code{-expected-id} @var{NUMBER}
3914 @*A non-zero @var{number} represents a 32-bit IDCODE
3915 which you expect to find when the scan chain is examined.
3916 These codes are not required by all JTAG devices.
3917 @emph{Repeat the option} as many times as required if more than one
3918 ID code could appear (for example, multiple versions).
3919 Specify @var{number} as zero to suppress warnings about IDCODE
3920 values that were found but not included in the list.
3921
3922 Provide this value if at all possible, since it lets OpenOCD
3923 tell when the scan chain it sees isn't right. These values
3924 are provided in vendors' chip documentation, usually a technical
3925 reference manual. Sometimes you may need to probe the JTAG
3926 hardware to find these values.
3927 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
3928 @item @code{-ignore-version}
3929 @*Specify this to ignore the JTAG version field in the @code{-expected-id}
3930 option. When vendors put out multiple versions of a chip, or use the same
3931 JTAG-level ID for several largely-compatible chips, it may be more practical
3932 to ignore the version field than to update config files to handle all of
3933 the various chip IDs. The version field is defined as bit 28-31 of the IDCODE.
3934 @item @code{-ircapture} @var{NUMBER}
3935 @*The bit pattern loaded by the TAP into the JTAG shift register
3936 on entry to the @sc{ircapture} state, such as 0x01.
3937 JTAG requires the two LSBs of this value to be 01.
3938 By default, @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} are set
3939 up to verify that two-bit value. You may provide
3940 additional bits if you know them, or indicate that
3941 a TAP doesn't conform to the JTAG specification.
3942 @item @code{-irmask} @var{NUMBER}
3943 @*A mask used with @code{-ircapture}
3944 to verify that instruction scans work correctly.
3945 Such scans are not used by OpenOCD except to verify that
3946 there seems to be no problems with JTAG scan chain operations.
3947 @item @code{-ignore-syspwrupack}
3948 @*Specify this to ignore the CSYSPWRUPACK bit in the ARM DAP DP CTRL/STAT
3949 register during initial examination and when checking the sticky error bit.
3950 This bit is normally checked after setting the CSYSPWRUPREQ bit, but some
3951 devices do not set the ack bit until sometime later.
3952 @end itemize
3953 @end deffn
3954
3955 @section Other TAP commands
3956
3957 @deffn Command {jtag cget} dotted.name @option{-idcode}
3958 Get the value of the IDCODE found in hardware.
3959 @end deffn
3960
3961 @deffn Command {jtag cget} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name
3962 @deffnx Command {jtag configure} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name handler
3963 At this writing this TAP attribute
3964 mechanism is limited and used mostly for event handling.
3965 (It is not a direct analogue of the @code{cget}/@code{configure}
3966 mechanism for debugger targets.)
3967 See the next section for information about the available events.
3968
3969 The @code{configure} subcommand assigns an event handler,
3970 a TCL string which is evaluated when the event is triggered.
3971 The @code{cget} subcommand returns that handler.
3972 @end deffn
3973
3974 @section TAP Events
3975 @cindex events
3976 @cindex TAP events
3977
3978 OpenOCD includes two event mechanisms.
3979 The one presented here applies to all JTAG TAPs.
3980 The other applies to debugger targets,
3981 which are associated with certain TAPs.
3982
3983 The TAP events currently defined are:
3984
3985 @itemize @bullet
3986 @item @b{post-reset}
3987 @* The TAP has just completed a JTAG reset.
3988 The tap may still be in the JTAG @sc{reset} state.
3989 Handlers for these events might perform initialization sequences
3990 such as issuing TCK cycles, TMS sequences to ensure
3991 exit from the ARM SWD mode, and more.
3992
3993 Because the scan chain has not yet been verified, handlers for these events
3994 @emph{should not issue commands which scan the JTAG IR or DR registers}
3995 of any particular target.
3996 @b{NOTE:} As this is written (September 2009), nothing prevents such access.
3997 @item @b{setup}
3998 @* The scan chain has been reset and verified.
3999 This handler may enable TAPs as needed.
4000 @item @b{tap-disable}
4001 @* The TAP needs to be disabled. This handler should
4002 implement @command{jtag tapdisable}
4003 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
4004 @item @b{tap-enable}
4005 @* The TAP needs to be enabled. This handler should
4006 implement @command{jtag tapenable}
4007 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
4008 @end itemize
4009
4010 If you need some action after each JTAG reset which isn't actually
4011 specific to any TAP (since you can't yet trust the scan chain's
4012 contents to be accurate), you might:
4013
4014 @example
4015 jtag configure CHIP.jrc -event post-reset @{
4016 echo "JTAG Reset done"
4017 ... non-scan jtag operations to be done after reset
4018 @}
4019 @end example
4020
4021
4022 @anchor{enablinganddisablingtaps}
4023 @section Enabling and Disabling TAPs
4024 @cindex JTAG Route Controller
4025 @cindex jrc
4026
4027 In some systems, a @dfn{JTAG Route Controller} (JRC)
4028 is used to enable and/or disable specific JTAG TAPs.
4029 Many ARM-based chips from Texas Instruments include
4030 an ``ICEPick'' module, which is a JRC.
4031 Such chips include DaVinci and OMAP3 processors.
4032
4033 A given TAP may not be visible until the JRC has been
4034 told to link it into the scan chain; and if the JRC
4035 has been told to unlink that TAP, it will no longer
4036 be visible.
4037 Such routers address problems that JTAG ``bypass mode''
4038 ignores, such as:
4039
4040 @itemize
4041 @item The scan chain can only go as fast as its slowest TAP.
4042 @item Having many TAPs slows instruction scans, since all
4043 TAPs receive new instructions.
4044 @item TAPs in the scan chain must be powered up, which wastes
4045 power and prevents debugging some power management mechanisms.
4046 @end itemize
4047
4048 The IEEE 1149.1 JTAG standard has no concept of a ``disabled'' tap,
4049 as implied by the existence of JTAG routers.
4050 However, the upcoming IEEE 1149.7 framework (layered on top of JTAG)
4051 does include a kind of JTAG router functionality.
4052
4053 @c (a) currently the event handlers don't seem to be able to
4054 @c fail in a way that could lead to no-change-of-state.
4055
4056 In OpenOCD, tap enabling/disabling is invoked by the Tcl commands
4057 shown below, and is implemented using TAP event handlers.
4058 So for example, when defining a TAP for a CPU connected to
4059 a JTAG router, your @file{target.cfg} file
4060 should define TAP event handlers using
4061 code that looks something like this:
4062
4063 @example
4064 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-enable @{
4065 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
4066 @}
4067 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-disable @{
4068 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
4069 @}
4070 @end example
4071
4072 Then you might want that CPU's TAP enabled almost all the time:
4073
4074 @example
4075 jtag configure $CHIP.jrc -event setup "jtag tapenable $CHIP.cpu"
4076 @end example
4077
4078 Note how that particular setup event handler declaration
4079 uses quotes to evaluate @code{$CHIP} when the event is configured.
4080 Using brackets @{ @} would cause it to be evaluated later,
4081 at runtime, when it might have a different value.
4082
4083 @deffn Command {jtag tapdisable} dotted.name
4084 If necessary, disables the tap
4085 by sending it a @option{tap-disable} event.
4086 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4087 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4088 and "0" if it is disabled.
4089 @end deffn
4090
4091 @deffn Command {jtag tapenable} dotted.name
4092 If necessary, enables the tap
4093 by sending it a @option{tap-enable} event.
4094 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4095 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4096 and "0" if it is disabled.
4097 @end deffn
4098
4099 @deffn Command {jtag tapisenabled} dotted.name
4100 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4101 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4102 and "0" if it is disabled.
4103
4104 @quotation Note
4105 Humans will find the @command{scan_chain} command more helpful
4106 for querying the state of the JTAG taps.
4107 @end quotation
4108 @end deffn
4109
4110 @anchor{autoprobing}
4111 @section Autoprobing
4112 @cindex autoprobe
4113 @cindex JTAG autoprobe
4114
4115 TAP configuration is the first thing that needs to be done
4116 after interface and reset configuration. Sometimes it's
4117 hard finding out what TAPs exist, or how they are identified.
4118 Vendor documentation is not always easy to find and use.
4119
4120 To help you get past such problems, OpenOCD has a limited
4121 @emph{autoprobing} ability to look at the scan chain, doing
4122 a @dfn{blind interrogation} and then reporting the TAPs it finds.
4123 To use this mechanism, start the OpenOCD server with only data
4124 that configures your JTAG interface, and arranges to come up
4125 with a slow clock (many devices don't support fast JTAG clocks
4126 right when they come out of reset).
4127
4128 For example, your @file{openocd.cfg} file might have:
4129
4130 @example
4131 source [find interface/olimex-arm-usb-tiny-h.cfg]
4132 reset_config trst_and_srst
4133 jtag_rclk 8
4134 @end example
4135
4136 When you start the server without any TAPs configured, it will
4137 attempt to autoconfigure the TAPs. There are two parts to this:
4138
4139 @enumerate
4140 @item @emph{TAP discovery} ...
4141 After a JTAG reset (sometimes a system reset may be needed too),
4142 each TAP's data registers will hold the contents of either the
4143 IDCODE or BYPASS register.
4144 If JTAG communication is working, OpenOCD will see each TAP,
4145 and report what @option{-expected-id} to use with it.
4146 @item @emph{IR Length discovery} ...
4147 Unfortunately JTAG does not provide a reliable way to find out
4148 the value of the @option{-irlen} parameter to use with a TAP
4149 that is discovered.
4150 If OpenOCD can discover the length of a TAP's instruction
4151 register, it will report it.
4152 Otherwise you may need to consult vendor documentation, such
4153 as chip data sheets or BSDL files.
4154 @end enumerate
4155
4156 In many cases your board will have a simple scan chain with just
4157 a single device. Here's what OpenOCD reported with one board
4158 that's a bit more complex:
4159
4160 @example
4161 clock speed 8 kHz
4162 There are no enabled taps. AUTO PROBING MIGHT NOT WORK!!
4163 AUTO auto0.tap - use "jtag newtap auto0 tap -expected-id 0x2b900f0f ..."
4164 AUTO auto1.tap - use "jtag newtap auto1 tap -expected-id 0x07926001 ..."
4165 AUTO auto2.tap - use "jtag newtap auto2 tap -expected-id 0x0b73b02f ..."
4166 AUTO auto0.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
4167 AUTO auto1.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
4168 AUTO auto2.tap - use "... -irlen 6"
4169 no gdb ports allocated as no target has been specified
4170 @end example
4171
4172 Given that information, you should be able to either find some existing
4173 config files to use, or create your own. If you create your own, you
4174 would configure from the bottom up: first a @file{target.cfg} file
4175 with these TAPs, any targets associated with them, and any on-chip
4176 resources; then a @file{board.cfg} with off-chip resources, clocking,
4177 and so forth.
4178
4179 @anchor{dapdeclaration}
4180 @section DAP declaration (ARMv6-M, ARMv7 and ARMv8 targets)
4181 @cindex DAP declaration
4182
4183 Since OpenOCD version 0.11.0, the Debug Access Port (DAP) is
4184 no longer implicitly created together with the target. It must be
4185 explicitly declared using the @command{dap create} command. For all ARMv6-M, ARMv7
4186 and ARMv8 targets, the option "@option{-dap} @var{dap_name}" has to be used
4187 instead of "@option{-chain-position} @var{dotted.name}" when the target is created.
4188
4189 The @command{dap} command group supports the following sub-commands:
4190
4191 @deffn Command {dap create} dap_name @option{-chain-position} dotted.name configparams...
4192 Declare a DAP instance named @var{dap_name} linked to the JTAG tap
4193 @var{dotted.name}. This also creates a new command (@command{dap_name})
4194 which is used for various purposes including additional configuration.
4195 There can only be one DAP for each JTAG tap in the system.
4196
4197 A DAP may also provide optional @var{configparams}:
4198
4199 @itemize @bullet
4200 @item @code{-ignore-syspwrupack}
4201 @*Specify this to ignore the CSYSPWRUPACK bit in the ARM DAP DP CTRL/STAT
4202 register during initial examination and when checking the sticky error bit.
4203 This bit is normally checked after setting the CSYSPWRUPREQ bit, but some
4204 devices do not set the ack bit until sometime later.
4205 @end itemize
4206 @end deffn
4207
4208 @deffn Command {dap names}
4209 This command returns a list of all registered DAP objects. It it useful mainly
4210 for TCL scripting.
4211 @end deffn
4212
4213 @deffn Command {dap info} [num]
4214 Displays the ROM table for MEM-AP @var{num},
4215 defaulting to the currently selected AP of the currently selected target.
4216 @end deffn
4217
4218 @deffn Command {dap init}
4219 Initialize all registered DAPs. This command is used internally
4220 during initialization. It can be issued at any time after the
4221 initialization, too.
4222 @end deffn
4223
4224 The following commands exist as subcommands of DAP instances:
4225
4226 @deffn Command {$dap_name info} [num]
4227 Displays the ROM table for MEM-AP @var{num},
4228 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4229 @end deffn
4230
4231 @deffn Command {$dap_name apid} [num]
4232 Displays ID register from AP @var{num}, defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4233 @end deffn
4234
4235 @anchor{DAP subcommand apreg}
4236 @deffn Command {$dap_name apreg} ap_num reg [value]
4237 Displays content of a register @var{reg} from AP @var{ap_num}
4238 or set a new value @var{value}.
4239 @var{reg} is byte address of a word register, 0, 4, 8 ... 0xfc.
4240 @end deffn
4241
4242 @deffn Command {$dap_name apsel} [num]
4243 Select AP @var{num}, defaulting to 0.
4244 @end deffn
4245
4246 @deffn Command {$dap_name dpreg} reg [value]
4247 Displays the content of DP register at address @var{reg}, or set it to a new
4248 value @var{value}.
4249
4250 In case of SWD, @var{reg} is a value in packed format
4251 @math{dpbanksel << 4 | addr} and assumes values 0, 4, 8 ... 0xfc.
4252 In case of JTAG it only assumes values 0, 4, 8 and 0xc.
4253
4254 @emph{Note:} Consider using @command{poll off} to avoid any disturbing
4255 background activity by OpenOCD while you are operating at such low-level.
4256 @end deffn
4257
4258 @deffn Command {$dap_name baseaddr} [num]
4259 Displays debug base address from MEM-AP @var{num},
4260 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4261 @end deffn
4262
4263 @deffn Command {$dap_name memaccess} [value]
4264 Displays the number of extra tck cycles in the JTAG idle to use for MEM-AP
4265 memory bus access [0-255], giving additional time to respond to reads.
4266 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
4267 @end deffn
4268
4269 @deffn Command {$dap_name apcsw} [value [mask]]
4270 Displays or changes CSW bit pattern for MEM-AP transfers.
4271
4272 At the begin of each memory access the CSW pattern is extended (bitwise or-ed)
4273 by @dfn{Size} and @dfn{AddrInc} bit-fields according to transfer requirements
4274 and the result is written to the real CSW register. All bits except dynamically
4275 updated fields @dfn{Size} and @dfn{AddrInc} can be changed by changing
4276 the CSW pattern. Refer to ARM ADI v5 manual chapter 7.6.4 and appendix A
4277 for details.
4278
4279 Use @var{value} only syntax if you want to set the new CSW pattern as a whole.
4280 The example sets HPROT1 bit (required by Cortex-M) and clears the rest of
4281 the pattern:
4282 @example
4283 kx.dap apcsw 0x2000000
4284 @end example
4285
4286 If @var{mask} is also used, the CSW pattern is changed only on bit positions
4287 where the mask bit is 1. The following example sets HPROT3 (cacheable)
4288 and leaves the rest of the pattern intact. It configures memory access through
4289 DCache on Cortex-M7.
4290 @example
4291 set CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE [expr 1 << 27]
4292 samv.dap apcsw $CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE $CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE
4293 @end example
4294
4295 Another example clears SPROT bit and leaves the rest of pattern intact:
4296 @example
4297 set CSW_SPROT [expr 1 << 30]
4298 samv.dap apcsw 0 $CSW_SPROT
4299 @end example
4300
4301 @emph{Note:} If you want to check the real value of CSW, not CSW pattern, use
4302 @code{xxx.dap apreg 0}. @xref{DAP subcommand apreg,,}.
4303
4304 @emph{Warning:} Some of the CSW bits are vital for working memory transfer.
4305 If you set a wrong CSW pattern and MEM-AP stopped working, use the following
4306 example with a proper dap name:
4307 @example
4308 xxx.dap apcsw default
4309 @end example
4310 @end deffn
4311
4312 @deffn Command {$dap_name ti_be_32_quirks} [@option{enable}]
4313 Set/get quirks mode for TI TMS450/TMS570 processors
4314 Disabled by default
4315 @end deffn
4316
4317
4318 @node CPU Configuration
4319 @chapter CPU Configuration
4320 @cindex GDB target
4321
4322 This chapter discusses how to set up GDB debug targets for CPUs.
4323 You can also access these targets without GDB
4324 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands},
4325 and @ref{targetstatehandling,,Target State handling}) and
4326 through various kinds of NAND and NOR flash commands.
4327 If you have multiple CPUs you can have multiple such targets.
4328
4329 We'll start by looking at how to examine the targets you have,
4330 then look at how to add one more target and how to configure it.
4331
4332 @section Target List
4333 @cindex target, current
4334 @cindex target, list
4335
4336 All targets that have been set up are part of a list,
4337 where each member has a name.
4338 That name should normally be the same as the TAP name.
4339 You can display the list with the @command{targets}
4340 (plural!) command.
4341 This display often has only one CPU; here's what it might
4342 look like with more than one:
4343 @verbatim
4344 TargetName Type Endian TapName State
4345 -- ------------------ ---------- ------ ------------------ ------------
4346 0* at91rm9200.cpu arm920t little at91rm9200.cpu running
4347 1 MyTarget cortex_m little mychip.foo tap-disabled
4348 @end verbatim
4349
4350 One member of that list is the @dfn{current target}, which
4351 is implicitly referenced by many commands.
4352 It's the one marked with a @code{*} near the target name.
4353 In particular, memory addresses often refer to the address
4354 space seen by that current target.
4355 Commands like @command{mdw} (memory display words)
4356 and @command{flash erase_address} (erase NOR flash blocks)
4357 are examples; and there are many more.
4358
4359 Several commands let you examine the list of targets:
4360
4361 @deffn Command {target current}
4362 Returns the name of the current target.
4363 @end deffn
4364
4365 @deffn Command {target names}
4366 Lists the names of all current targets in the list.
4367 @example
4368 foreach t [target names] @{
4369 puts [format "Target: %s\n" $t]
4370 @}
4371 @end example
4372 @end deffn
4373
4374 @c yep, "target list" would have been better.
4375 @c plus maybe "target setdefault".
4376
4377 @deffn Command targets [name]
4378 @emph{Note: the name of this command is plural. Other target
4379 command names are singular.}
4380
4381 With no parameter, this command displays a table of all known
4382 targets in a user friendly form.
4383
4384 With a parameter, this command sets the current target to
4385 the given target with the given @var{name}; this is
4386 only relevant on boards which have more than one target.
4387 @end deffn
4388
4389 @section Target CPU Types
4390 @cindex target type
4391 @cindex CPU type
4392
4393 Each target has a @dfn{CPU type}, as shown in the output of
4394 the @command{targets} command. You need to specify that type
4395 when calling @command{target create}.
4396 The CPU type indicates more than just the instruction set.
4397 It also indicates how that instruction set is implemented,
4398 what kind of debug support it integrates,
4399 whether it has an MMU (and if so, what kind),
4400 what core-specific commands may be available
4401 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands}),
4402 and more.
4403
4404 It's easy to see what target types are supported,
4405 since there's a command to list them.
4406
4407 @anchor{targettypes}
4408 @deffn Command {target types}
4409 Lists all supported target types.
4410 At this writing, the supported CPU types are:
4411
4412 @itemize @bullet
4413 @item @code{aarch64} -- this is an ARMv8-A core with an MMU
4414 @item @code{arm11} -- this is a generation of ARMv6 cores
4415 @item @code{arm720t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU
4416 @item @code{arm7tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core
4417 @item @code{arm920t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU
4418 @item @code{arm926ejs} -- this is an ARMv5 core with an MMU
4419 @item @code{arm966e} -- this is an ARMv5 core
4420 @item @code{arm9tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core
4421 @item @code{avr} -- implements Atmel's 8-bit AVR instruction set.
4422 (Support for this is preliminary and incomplete.)
4423 @item @code{cortex_a} -- this is an ARMv7-A core with an MMU
4424 @item @code{cortex_m} -- this is an ARMv7-M core, supporting only the
4425 compact Thumb2 instruction set. Supports also ARMv6-M and ARMv8-M cores
4426 @item @code{dragonite} -- resembles arm966e
4427 @item @code{dsp563xx} -- implements Freescale's 24-bit DSP.
4428 (Support for this is still incomplete.)
4429 @item @code{esirisc} -- this is an EnSilica eSi-RISC core.
4430 The current implementation supports eSi-32xx cores.
4431 @item @code{fa526} -- resembles arm920 (w/o Thumb)
4432 @item @code{feroceon} -- resembles arm926
4433 @item @code{ls1_sap} -- this is the SAP on NXP LS102x CPUs,
4434 allowing access to physical memory addresses independently of CPU cores.
4435 @item @code{mem_ap} -- this is an ARM debug infrastructure Access Port without a CPU, through which bus read and write cycles can be generated; it may be useful for working with non-CPU hardware behind an AP or during development of support for new CPUs.
4436 @item @code{mips_m4k} -- a MIPS core
4437 @item @code{or1k} -- this is an OpenRISC 1000 core.
4438 The current implementation supports three JTAG TAP cores:
4439 @itemize @minus
4440 @item @code{OpenCores TAP} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}jtag})
4441 @item @code{Altera Virtual JTAG TAP} (See: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_virtualjtag.pdf})
4442 @item @code{Xilinx BSCAN_* virtual JTAG interface} (See: @url{http://www.xilinx.com/support/documentation/sw_manuals/xilinx14_2/spartan6_hdl.pdf})
4443 @end itemize
4444 And two debug interfaces cores:
4445 @itemize @minus
4446 @item @code{Advanced debug interface} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}adv_debug_sys})
4447 @item @code{SoC Debug Interface} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}dbg_interface})
4448 @end itemize
4449 @item @code{xscale} -- this is actually an architecture,
4450 not a CPU type. It is based on the ARMv5 architecture.
4451 @end itemize
4452 @end deffn
4453
4454 To avoid being confused by the variety of ARM based cores, remember
4455 this key point: @emph{ARM is a technology licencing company}.
4456 (See: @url{http://www.arm.com}.)
4457 The CPU name used by OpenOCD will reflect the CPU design that was
4458 licensed, not a vendor brand which incorporates that design.
4459 Name prefixes like arm7, arm9, arm11, and cortex
4460 reflect design generations;
4461 while names like ARMv4, ARMv5, ARMv6, ARMv7 and ARMv8
4462 reflect an architecture version implemented by a CPU design.
4463
4464 @anchor{targetconfiguration}
4465 @section Target Configuration
4466
4467 Before creating a ``target'', you must have added its TAP to the scan chain.
4468 When you've added that TAP, you will have a @code{dotted.name}
4469 which is used to set up the CPU support.
4470 The chip-specific configuration file will normally configure its CPU(s)
4471 right after it adds all of the chip's TAPs to the scan chain.
4472
4473 Although you can set up a target in one step, it's often clearer if you
4474 use shorter commands and do it in two steps: create it, then configure
4475 optional parts.
4476 All operations on the target after it's created will use a new
4477 command, created as part of target creation.
4478
4479 The two main things to configure after target creation are
4480 a work area, which usually has target-specific defaults even
4481 if the board setup code overrides them later;
4482 and event handlers (@pxref{targetevents,,Target Events}), which tend
4483 to be much more board-specific.
4484 The key steps you use might look something like this
4485
4486 @example
4487 dap create mychip.dap -chain-position mychip.cpu
4488 target create MyTarget cortex_m -dap mychip.dap
4489 MyTarget configure -work-area-phys 0x08000 -work-area-size 8096
4490 MyTarget configure -event reset-deassert-pre @{ jtag_rclk 5 @}
4491 MyTarget configure -event reset-init @{ myboard_reinit @}
4492 @end example
4493
4494 You should specify a working area if you can; typically it uses some
4495 on-chip SRAM.
4496 Such a working area can speed up many things, including bulk
4497 writes to target memory;
4498 flash operations like checking to see if memory needs to be erased;
4499 GDB memory checksumming;
4500 and more.
4501
4502 @quotation Warning
4503 On more complex chips, the work area can become
4504 inaccessible when application code
4505 (such as an operating system)
4506 enables or disables the MMU.
4507 For example, the particular MMU context used to access the virtual
4508 address will probably matter ... and that context might not have
4509 easy access to other addresses needed.
4510 At this writing, OpenOCD doesn't have much MMU intelligence.
4511 @end quotation
4512
4513 It's often very useful to define a @code{reset-init} event handler.
4514 For systems that are normally used with a boot loader,
4515 common tasks include updating clocks and initializing memory
4516 controllers.
4517 That may be needed to let you write the boot loader into flash,
4518 in order to ``de-brick'' your board; or to load programs into
4519 external DDR memory without having run the boot loader.
4520
4521 @deffn Command {target create} target_name type configparams...
4522 This command creates a GDB debug target that refers to a specific JTAG tap.
4523 It enters that target into a list, and creates a new
4524 command (@command{@var{target_name}}) which is used for various
4525 purposes including additional configuration.
4526
4527 @itemize @bullet
4528 @item @var{target_name} ... is the name of the debug target.
4529 By convention this should be the same as the @emph{dotted.name}
4530 of the TAP associated with this target, which must be specified here
4531 using the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} configparam.
4532
4533 This name is also used to create the target object command,
4534 referred to here as @command{$target_name},
4535 and in other places the target needs to be identified.
4536 @item @var{type} ... specifies the target type. @xref{targettypes,,target types}.
4537 @item @var{configparams} ... all parameters accepted by
4538 @command{$target_name configure} are permitted.
4539 If the target is big-endian, set it here with @code{-endian big}.
4540
4541 You @emph{must} set the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} or
4542 @code{-dap @var{dap_name}} here.
4543 @end itemize
4544 @end deffn
4545
4546 @deffn Command {$target_name configure} configparams...
4547 The options accepted by this command may also be
4548 specified as parameters to @command{target create}.
4549 Their values can later be queried one at a time by
4550 using the @command{$target_name cget} command.
4551
4552 @emph{Warning:} changing some of these after setup is dangerous.
4553 For example, moving a target from one TAP to another;
4554 and changing its endianness.
4555
4556 @itemize @bullet
4557
4558 @item @code{-chain-position} @var{dotted.name} -- names the TAP
4559 used to access this target.
4560
4561 @item @code{-dap} @var{dap_name} -- names the DAP used to access
4562 this target. @xref{dapdeclaration,,DAP declaration}, on how to
4563 create and manage DAP instances.
4564
4565 @item @code{-endian} (@option{big}|@option{little}) -- specifies
4566 whether the CPU uses big or little endian conventions
4567
4568 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} @var{event_body} --
4569 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
4570 Note that this updates a list of named event handlers.
4571 Calling this twice with two different event names assigns
4572 two different handlers, but calling it twice with the
4573 same event name assigns only one handler.
4574
4575 Current target is temporarily overridden to the event issuing target
4576 before handler code starts and switched back after handler is done.
4577
4578 @item @code{-work-area-backup} (@option{0}|@option{1}) -- says
4579 whether the work area gets backed up; by default,
4580 @emph{it is not backed up.}
4581 When possible, use a working_area that doesn't need to be backed up,
4582 since performing a backup slows down operations.
4583 For example, the beginning of an SRAM block is likely to
4584 be used by most build systems, but the end is often unused.
4585
4586 @item @code{-work-area-size} @var{size} -- specify work are size,
4587 in bytes. The same size applies regardless of whether its physical
4588 or virtual address is being used.
4589
4590 @item @code{-work-area-phys} @var{address} -- set the work area
4591 base @var{address} to be used when no MMU is active.
4592
4593 @item @code{-work-area-virt} @var{address} -- set the work area
4594 base @var{address} to be used when an MMU is active.
4595 @emph{Do not specify a value for this except on targets with an MMU.}
4596 The value should normally correspond to a static mapping for the
4597 @code{-work-area-phys} address, set up by the current operating system.
4598
4599 @anchor{rtostype}
4600 @item @code{-rtos} @var{rtos_type} -- enable rtos support for target,
4601 @var{rtos_type} can be one of @option{auto}, @option{eCos},
4602 @option{ThreadX}, @option{FreeRTOS}, @option{linux}, @option{ChibiOS},
4603 @option{embKernel}, @option{mqx}, @option{uCOS-III}, @option{nuttx}
4604 @xref{gdbrtossupport,,RTOS Support}.
4605
4606 @item @code{-defer-examine} -- skip target examination at initial JTAG chain
4607 scan and after a reset. A manual call to arp_examine is required to
4608 access the target for debugging.
4609
4610 @item @code{-ap-num} @var{ap_number} -- set DAP access port for target,
4611 @var{ap_number} is the numeric index of the DAP AP the target is connected to.
4612 Use this option with systems where multiple, independent cores are connected
4613 to separate access ports of the same DAP.
4614
4615 @item @code{-cti} @var{cti_name} -- set Cross-Trigger Interface (CTI) connected
4616 to the target. Currently, only the @code{aarch64} target makes use of this option,
4617 where it is a mandatory configuration for the target run control.
4618 @xref{armcrosstrigger,,ARM Cross-Trigger Interface},
4619 for instruction on how to declare and control a CTI instance.
4620
4621 @anchor{gdbportoverride}
4622 @item @code{-gdb-port} @var{number} -- see command @command{gdb_port} for the
4623 possible values of the parameter @var{number}, which are not only numeric values.
4624 Use this option to override, for this target only, the global parameter set with
4625 command @command{gdb_port}.
4626 @xref{gdb_port,,command gdb_port}.
4627 @end itemize
4628 @end deffn
4629
4630 @section Other $target_name Commands
4631 @cindex object command
4632
4633 The Tcl/Tk language has the concept of object commands,
4634 and OpenOCD adopts that same model for targets.
4635
4636 A good Tk example is a on screen button.
4637 Once a button is created a button
4638 has a name (a path in Tk terms) and that name is useable as a first
4639 class command. For example in Tk, one can create a button and later
4640 configure it like this:
4641
4642 @example
4643 # Create
4644 button .foobar -background red -command @{ foo @}
4645 # Modify
4646 .foobar configure -foreground blue
4647 # Query
4648 set x [.foobar cget -background]
4649 # Report
4650 puts [format "The button is %s" $x]
4651 @end example
4652
4653 In OpenOCD's terms, the ``target'' is an object just like a Tcl/Tk
4654 button, and its object commands are invoked the same way.
4655
4656 @example
4657 str912.cpu mww 0x1234 0x42
4658 omap3530.cpu mww 0x5555 123
4659 @end example
4660
4661 The commands supported by OpenOCD target objects are:
4662
4663 @deffn Command {$target_name arp_examine} @option{allow-defer}
4664 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_halt}
4665 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_poll}
4666 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_reset}
4667 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_waitstate}
4668 Internal OpenOCD scripts (most notably @file{startup.tcl})
4669 use these to deal with specific reset cases.
4670 They are not otherwise documented here.
4671 @end deffn
4672
4673 @deffn Command {$target_name array2mem} arrayname width address count
4674 @deffnx Command {$target_name mem2array} arrayname width address count
4675 These provide an efficient script-oriented interface to memory.
4676 The @code{array2mem} primitive writes bytes, halfwords, or words;
4677 while @code{mem2array} reads them.
4678 In both cases, the TCL side uses an array, and
4679 the target side uses raw memory.
4680
4681 The efficiency comes from enabling the use of
4682 bulk JTAG data transfer operations.
4683 The script orientation comes from working with data
4684 values that are packaged for use by TCL scripts;
4685 @command{mdw} type primitives only print data they retrieve,
4686 and neither store nor return those values.
4687
4688 @itemize
4689 @item @var{arrayname} ... is the name of an array variable
4690 @item @var{width} ... is 8/16/32 - indicating the memory access size
4691 @item @var{address} ... is the target memory address
4692 @item @var{count} ... is the number of elements to process
4693 @end itemize
4694 @end deffn
4695
4696 @deffn Command {$target_name cget} queryparm
4697 Each configuration parameter accepted by
4698 @command{$target_name configure}
4699 can be individually queried, to return its current value.
4700 The @var{queryparm} is a parameter name
4701 accepted by that command, such as @code{-work-area-phys}.
4702 There are a few special cases:
4703
4704 @itemize @bullet
4705 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} -- returns the handler for the
4706 event named @var{event_name}.
4707 This is a special case because setting a handler requires
4708 two parameters.
4709 @item @code{-type} -- returns the target type.
4710 This is a special case because this is set using
4711 @command{target create} and can't be changed
4712 using @command{$target_name configure}.
4713 @end itemize
4714
4715 For example, if you wanted to summarize information about
4716 all the targets you might use something like this:
4717
4718 @example
4719 foreach name [target names] @{
4720 set y [$name cget -endian]
4721 set z [$name cget -type]
4722 puts [format "Chip %d is %s, Endian: %s, type: %s" \
4723 $x $name $y $z]
4724 @}
4725 @end example
4726 @end deffn
4727
4728 @anchor{targetcurstate}
4729 @deffn Command {$target_name curstate}
4730 Displays the current target state:
4731 @code{debug-running},
4732 @code{halted},
4733 @code{reset},
4734 @code{running}, or @code{unknown}.
4735 (Also, @pxref{eventpolling,,Event Polling}.)
4736 @end deffn
4737
4738 @deffn Command {$target_name eventlist}
4739 Displays a table listing all event handlers
4740 currently associated with this target.
4741 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
4742 @end deffn
4743
4744 @deffn Command {$target_name invoke-event} event_name
4745 Invokes the handler for the event named @var{event_name}.
4746 (This is primarily intended for use by OpenOCD framework
4747 code, for example by the reset code in @file{startup.tcl}.)
4748 @end deffn
4749
4750 @deffn Command {$target_name mdd} [phys] addr [count]
4751 @deffnx Command {$target_name mdw} [phys] addr [count]
4752 @deffnx Command {$target_name mdh} [phys] addr [count]
4753 @deffnx Command {$target_name mdb} [phys] addr [count]
4754 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
4755 64-bit doublewords (@command{mdd}),
4756 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
4757 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
4758 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
4759 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
4760 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
4761 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
4762 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
4763 (If you want to manipulate the data instead of displaying it,
4764 see the @code{mem2array} primitives.)
4765 @end deffn
4766
4767 @deffn Command {$target_name mwd} [phys] addr doubleword [count]
4768 @deffnx Command {$target_name mww} [phys] addr word [count]
4769 @deffnx Command {$target_name mwh} [phys] addr halfword [count]
4770 @deffnx Command {$target_name mwb} [phys] addr byte [count]
4771 Writes the specified @var{doubleword} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
4772 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) value,
4773 at the specified address @var{addr}.
4774 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
4775 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
4776 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
4777 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
4778 If @var{count} is specified, fills that many units of consecutive address.
4779 @end deffn
4780
4781 @anchor{targetevents}
4782 @section Target Events
4783 @cindex target events
4784 @cindex events
4785 At various times, certain things can happen, or you want them to happen.
4786 For example:
4787 @itemize @bullet
4788 @item What should happen when GDB connects? Should your target reset?
4789 @item When GDB tries to flash the target, do you need to enable the flash via a special command?
4790 @item Is using SRST appropriate (and possible) on your system?
4791 Or instead of that, do you need to issue JTAG commands to trigger reset?
4792 SRST usually resets everything on the scan chain, which can be inappropriate.
4793 @item During reset, do you need to write to certain memory locations
4794 to set up system clocks or
4795 to reconfigure the SDRAM?
4796 How about configuring the watchdog timer, or other peripherals,
4797 to stop running while you hold the core stopped for debugging?
4798 @end itemize
4799
4800 All of the above items can be addressed by target event handlers.
4801 These are set up by @command{$target_name configure -event} or
4802 @command{target create ... -event}.
4803
4804 The programmer's model matches the @code{-command} option used in Tcl/Tk
4805 buttons and events. The two examples below act the same, but one creates
4806 and invokes a small procedure while the other inlines it.
4807
4808 @example
4809 proc my_init_proc @{ @} @{
4810 echo "Disabling watchdog..."
4811 mww 0xfffffd44 0x00008000
4812 @}
4813 mychip.cpu configure -event reset-init my_init_proc
4814 mychip.cpu configure -event reset-init @{
4815 echo "Disabling watchdog..."
4816 mww 0xfffffd44 0x00008000
4817 @}
4818 @end example
4819
4820 The following target events are defined:
4821
4822 @itemize @bullet
4823 @item @b{debug-halted}
4824 @* The target has halted for debug reasons (i.e.: breakpoint)
4825 @item @b{debug-resumed}
4826 @* The target has resumed (i.e.: GDB said run)
4827 @item @b{early-halted}
4828 @* Occurs early in the halt process
4829 @item @b{examine-start}
4830 @* Before target examine is called.
4831 @item @b{examine-end}
4832 @* After target examine is called with no errors.
4833 @item @b{examine-fail}
4834 @* After target examine fails.
4835 @item @b{gdb-attach}
4836 @* When GDB connects. Issued before any GDB communication with the target
4837 starts. GDB expects the target is halted during attachment.
4838 @xref{gdbmeminspect,,GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector}, how to
4839 connect GDB to running target.
4840 The event can be also used to set up the target so it is possible to probe flash.
4841 Probing flash is necessary during GDB connect if you want to use
4842 @pxref{programmingusinggdb,,programming using GDB}.
4843 Another use of the flash memory map is for GDB to automatically choose
4844 hardware or software breakpoints depending on whether the breakpoint
4845 is in RAM or read only memory.
4846 Default is @code{halt}
4847 @item @b{gdb-detach}
4848 @* When GDB disconnects
4849 @item @b{gdb-end}
4850 @* When the target has halted and GDB is not doing anything (see early halt)
4851 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-start}
4852 @* Before the GDB flash process tries to erase the flash (default is
4853 @code{reset init})
4854 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-end}
4855 @* After the GDB flash process has finished erasing the flash
4856 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-start}
4857 @* Before GDB writes to the flash
4858 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-end}
4859 @* After GDB writes to the flash (default is @code{reset halt})
4860 @item @b{gdb-start}
4861 @* Before the target steps, GDB is trying to start/resume the target
4862 @item @b{halted}
4863 @* The target has halted
4864 @item @b{reset-assert-pre}
4865 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4866 after @command{reset-start} was triggered
4867 but before either SRST alone is asserted on the scan chain,
4868 or @code{reset-assert} is triggered.
4869 @item @b{reset-assert}
4870 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4871 after @command{reset-assert-pre} was triggered.
4872 When such a handler is present, cores which support this event will use
4873 it instead of asserting SRST.
4874 This support is essential for debugging with JTAG interfaces which
4875 don't include an SRST line (JTAG doesn't require SRST), and for
4876 selective reset on scan chains that have multiple targets.
4877 @item @b{reset-assert-post}
4878 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4879 after @code{reset-assert} has been triggered.
4880 or the target asserted SRST on the entire scan chain.
4881 @item @b{reset-deassert-pre}
4882 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4883 after @code{reset-assert-post} has been triggered.
4884 @item @b{reset-deassert-post}
4885 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4886 after @code{reset-deassert-pre} has been triggered
4887 and (if the target is using it) after SRST has been
4888 released on the scan chain.
4889 @item @b{reset-end}
4890 @* Issued as the final step in @command{reset} processing.
4891 @item @b{reset-init}
4892 @* Used by @b{reset init} command for board-specific initialization.
4893 This event fires after @emph{reset-deassert-post}.
4894
4895 This is where you would configure PLLs and clocking, set up DRAM so
4896 you can download programs that don't fit in on-chip SRAM, set up pin
4897 multiplexing, and so on.
4898 (You may be able to switch to a fast JTAG clock rate here, after
4899 the target clocks are fully set up.)
4900 @item @b{reset-start}
4901 @* Issued as the first step in @command{reset} processing
4902 before @command{reset-assert-pre} is called.
4903
4904 This is the most robust place to use @command{jtag_rclk}
4905 or @command{adapter speed} to switch to a low JTAG clock rate,
4906 when reset disables PLLs needed to use a fast clock.
4907 @item @b{resume-start}
4908 @* Before any target is resumed
4909 @item @b{resume-end}
4910 @* After all targets have resumed
4911 @item @b{resumed}
4912 @* Target has resumed
4913 @item @b{trace-config}
4914 @* After target hardware trace configuration was changed
4915 @end itemize
4916
4917 @node Flash Commands
4918 @chapter Flash Commands
4919
4920 OpenOCD has different commands for NOR and NAND flash;
4921 the ``flash'' command works with NOR flash, while
4922 the ``nand'' command works with NAND flash.
4923 This partially reflects different hardware technologies:
4924 NOR flash usually supports direct CPU instruction and data bus access,
4925 while data from a NAND flash must be copied to memory before it can be
4926 used. (SPI flash must also be copied to memory before use.)
4927 However, the documentation also uses ``flash'' as a generic term;
4928 for example, ``Put flash configuration in board-specific files''.
4929
4930 Flash Steps:
4931 @enumerate
4932 @item Configure via the command @command{flash bank}
4933 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
4934 passing parameters as needed by the driver.
4935 @item Operate on the flash via @command{flash subcommand}
4936 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
4937 via a script in some automated way. Common tasks include writing a
4938 boot loader, operating system, or other data.
4939 @item GDB Flashing
4940 @* Flashing via GDB requires the flash be configured via ``flash
4941 bank'', and the GDB flash features be enabled.
4942 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
4943 @end enumerate
4944
4945 Many CPUs have the ability to ``boot'' from the first flash bank.
4946 This means that misprogramming that bank can ``brick'' a system,
4947 so that it can't boot.
4948 JTAG tools, like OpenOCD, are often then used to ``de-brick'' the
4949 board by (re)installing working boot firmware.
4950
4951 @anchor{norconfiguration}
4952 @section Flash Configuration Commands
4953 @cindex flash configuration
4954
4955 @deffn {Config Command} {flash bank} name driver base size chip_width bus_width target [driver_options]
4956 Configures a flash bank which provides persistent storage
4957 for addresses from @math{base} to @math{base + size - 1}.
4958 These banks will often be visible to GDB through the target's memory map.
4959 In some cases, configuring a flash bank will activate extra commands;
4960 see the driver-specific documentation.
4961
4962 @itemize @bullet
4963 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the flash bank
4964 in other flash commands. A number is also available.
4965 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the controller driver
4966 associated with the flash bank being declared.
4967 This is usually @code{cfi} for external flash, or else
4968 the name of a microcontroller with embedded flash memory.
4969 @xref{flashdriverlist,,Flash Driver List}.
4970 @item @var{base} ... Base address of the flash chip.
4971 @item @var{size} ... Size of the chip, in bytes.
4972 For some drivers, this value is detected from the hardware.
4973 @item @var{chip_width} ... Width of the flash chip, in bytes;
4974 ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
4975 @item @var{bus_width} ... Width of the data bus used to access the
4976 chip, in bytes; ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
4977 @item @var{target} ... Names the target used to issue
4978 commands to the flash controller.
4979 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
4980 @item @var{driver_options} ... drivers may support, or require,
4981 additional parameters. See the driver-specific documentation
4982 for more information.
4983 @end itemize
4984 @quotation Note
4985 This command is not available after OpenOCD initialization has completed.
4986 Use it in board specific configuration files, not interactively.
4987 @end quotation
4988 @end deffn
4989
4990 @comment less confusing would be: "flash list" (like "nand list")
4991 @deffn Command {flash banks}
4992 Prints a one-line summary of each device that was
4993 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
4994 Note that this is the @emph{plural} form;
4995 the @emph{singular} form is a very different command.
4996 @end deffn
4997
4998 @deffn Command {flash list}
4999 Retrieves a list of associative arrays for each device that was
5000 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
5001 This returned list can be manipulated easily from within scripts.
5002 @end deffn
5003
5004 @deffn Command {flash probe} num
5005 Identify the flash, or validate the parameters of the configured flash. Operation
5006 depends on the flash type.
5007 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5008 Most flash commands will implicitly @emph{autoprobe} the bank;
5009 flash drivers can distinguish between probing and autoprobing,
5010 but most don't bother.
5011 @end deffn
5012
5013 @section Preparing a Target before Flash Programming
5014
5015 The target device should be in well defined state before the flash programming
5016 begins.
5017
5018 @emph{Always issue} @command{reset init} before @ref{flashprogrammingcommands,,Flash Programming Commands}.
5019 Do not issue another @command{reset} or @command{reset halt} or @command{resume}
5020 until the programming session is finished.
5021
5022 If you use @ref{programmingusinggdb,,Programming using GDB},
5023 the target is prepared automatically in the event gdb-flash-erase-start
5024
5025 The jimtcl script @command{program} calls @command{reset init} explicitly.
5026
5027 @section Erasing, Reading, Writing to Flash
5028 @cindex flash erasing
5029 @cindex flash reading
5030 @cindex flash writing
5031 @cindex flash programming
5032 @anchor{flashprogrammingcommands}
5033
5034 One feature distinguishing NOR flash from NAND or serial flash technologies
5035 is that for read access, it acts exactly like any other addressable memory.
5036 This means you can use normal memory read commands like @command{mdw} or
5037 @command{dump_image} with it, with no special @command{flash} subcommands.
5038 @xref{memoryaccess,,Memory access}, and @ref{imageaccess,,Image access}.
5039
5040 Write access works differently. Flash memory normally needs to be erased
5041 before it's written. Erasing a sector turns all of its bits to ones, and
5042 writing can turn ones into zeroes. This is why there are special commands
5043 for interactive erasing and writing, and why GDB needs to know which parts
5044 of the address space hold NOR flash memory.
5045
5046 @quotation Note
5047 Most of these erase and write commands leverage the fact that NOR flash
5048 chips consume target address space. They implicitly refer to the current
5049 JTAG target, and map from an address in that target's address space
5050 back to a flash bank.
5051 @comment In May 2009, those mappings may fail if any bank associated
5052 @comment with that target doesn't successfully autoprobe ... bug worth fixing?
5053 A few commands use abstract addressing based on bank and sector numbers,
5054 and don't depend on searching the current target and its address space.
5055 Avoid confusing the two command models.
5056 @end quotation
5057
5058 Some flash chips implement software protection against accidental writes,
5059 since such buggy writes could in some cases ``brick'' a system.
5060 For such systems, erasing and writing may require sector protection to be
5061 disabled first.
5062 Examples include CFI flash such as ``Intel Advanced Bootblock flash'',
5063 and AT91SAM7 on-chip flash.
5064 @xref{flashprotect,,flash protect}.
5065
5066 @deffn Command {flash erase_sector} num first last
5067 Erase sectors in bank @var{num}, starting at sector @var{first}
5068 up to and including @var{last}.
5069 Sector numbering starts at 0.
5070 Providing a @var{last} sector of @option{last}
5071 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
5072 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5073 @end deffn
5074
5075 @deffn Command {flash erase_address} [@option{pad}] [@option{unlock}] address length
5076 Erase sectors starting at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
5077 Unless @option{pad} is specified, @math{address} must begin a
5078 flash sector, and @math{address + length - 1} must end a sector.
5079 Specifying @option{pad} erases extra data at the beginning and/or
5080 end of the specified region, as needed to erase only full sectors.
5081 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address}, and
5082 the specified length must stay within that bank.
5083 As a special case, when @var{length} is zero and @var{address} is
5084 the start of the bank, the whole flash is erased.
5085 If @option{unlock} is specified, then the flash is unprotected
5086 before erase starts.
5087 @end deffn
5088
5089 @deffn Command {flash filld} address double-word length
5090 @deffnx Command {flash fillw} address word length
5091 @deffnx Command {flash fillh} address halfword length
5092 @deffnx Command {flash fillb} address byte length
5093 Fills flash memory with the specified @var{double-word} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
5094 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) pattern,
5095 starting at @var{address} and continuing
5096 for @var{length} units (word/halfword/byte).
5097 No erasure is done before writing; when needed, that must be done
5098 before issuing this command.
5099 Writes are done in blocks of up to 1024 bytes, and each write is
5100 verified by reading back the data and comparing it to what was written.
5101 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address} of
5102 each block, and the specified length must stay within that bank.
5103 @end deffn
5104 @comment no current checks for errors if fill blocks touch multiple banks!
5105
5106 @deffn Command {flash write_bank} num filename [offset]
5107 Write the binary @file{filename} to flash bank @var{num},
5108 starting at @var{offset} bytes from the beginning of the bank. If @var{offset}
5109 is omitted, start at the beginning of the flash bank.
5110 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5111 @end deffn
5112
5113 @deffn Command {flash read_bank} num filename [offset [length]]
5114 Read @var{length} bytes from the flash bank @var{num} starting at @var{offset}
5115 and write the contents to the binary @file{filename}. If @var{offset} is
5116 omitted, start at the beginning of the flash bank. If @var{length} is omitted,
5117 read the remaining bytes from the flash bank.
5118 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5119 @end deffn
5120
5121 @deffn Command {flash verify_bank} num filename [offset]
5122 Compare the contents of the binary file @var{filename} with the contents of the
5123 flash bank @var{num} starting at @var{offset}. If @var{offset} is omitted,
5124 start at the beginning of the flash bank. Fail if the contents do not match.
5125 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5126 @end deffn
5127
5128 @deffn Command {flash write_image} [erase] [unlock] filename [offset] [type]
5129 Write the image @file{filename} to the current target's flash bank(s).
5130 Only loadable sections from the image are written.
5131 A relocation @var{offset} may be specified, in which case it is added
5132 to the base address for each section in the image.
5133 The file [@var{type}] can be specified
5134 explicitly as @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
5135 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19).
5136 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
5137 The relevant flash sectors will be erased prior to programming
5138 if the @option{erase} parameter is given. If @option{unlock} is
5139 provided, then the flash banks are unlocked before erase and
5140 program. The flash bank to use is inferred from the address of
5141 each image section.
5142
5143 @quotation Warning
5144 Be careful using the @option{erase} flag when the flash is holding
5145 data you want to preserve.
5146 Portions of the flash outside those described in the image's
5147 sections might be erased with no notice.
5148 @itemize
5149 @item
5150 When a section of the image being written does not fill out all the
5151 sectors it uses, the unwritten parts of those sectors are necessarily
5152 also erased, because sectors can't be partially erased.
5153 @item
5154 Data stored in sector "holes" between image sections are also affected.
5155 For example, "@command{flash write_image erase ...}" of an image with
5156 one byte at the beginning of a flash bank and one byte at the end
5157 erases the entire bank -- not just the two sectors being written.
5158 @end itemize
5159 Also, when flash protection is important, you must re-apply it after
5160 it has been removed by the @option{unlock} flag.
5161 @end quotation
5162
5163 @end deffn
5164
5165 @section Other Flash commands
5166 @cindex flash protection
5167
5168 @deffn Command {flash erase_check} num
5169 Check erase state of sectors in flash bank @var{num},
5170 and display that status.
5171 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5172 @end deffn
5173
5174 @deffn Command {flash info} num [sectors]
5175 Print info about flash bank @var{num}, a list of protection blocks
5176 and their status. Use @option{sectors} to show a list of sectors instead.
5177
5178 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5179 This command will first query the hardware, it does not print cached
5180 and possibly stale information.
5181 @end deffn
5182
5183 @anchor{flashprotect}
5184 @deffn Command {flash protect} num first last (@option{on}|@option{off})
5185 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) protection of flash blocks
5186 in flash bank @var{num}, starting at protection block @var{first}
5187 and continuing up to and including @var{last}.
5188 Providing a @var{last} block of @option{last}
5189 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
5190 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5191 The protection block is usually identical to a flash sector.
5192 Some devices may utilize a protection block distinct from flash sector.
5193 See @command{flash info} for a list of protection blocks.
5194 @end deffn
5195
5196 @deffn Command {flash padded_value} num value
5197 Sets the default value used for padding any image sections, This should
5198 normally match the flash bank erased value. If not specified by this
5199 command or the flash driver then it defaults to 0xff.
5200 @end deffn
5201
5202 @anchor{program}
5203 @deffn Command {program} filename [preverify] [verify] [reset] [exit] [offset]
5204 This is a helper script that simplifies using OpenOCD as a standalone
5205 programmer. The only required parameter is @option{filename}, the others are optional.
5206 @xref{Flash Programming}.
5207 @end deffn
5208
5209 @anchor{flashdriverlist}
5210 @section Flash Driver List
5211 As noted above, the @command{flash bank} command requires a driver name,
5212 and allows driver-specific options and behaviors.
5213 Some drivers also activate driver-specific commands.
5214
5215 @deffn {Flash Driver} virtual
5216 This is a special driver that maps a previously defined bank to another
5217 address. All bank settings will be copied from the master physical bank.
5218
5219 The @var{virtual} driver defines one mandatory parameters,
5220
5221 @itemize
5222 @item @var{master_bank} The bank that this virtual address refers to.
5223 @end itemize
5224
5225 So in the following example addresses 0xbfc00000 and 0x9fc00000 refer to
5226 the flash bank defined at address 0x1fc00000. Any command executed on
5227 the virtual banks is actually performed on the physical banks.
5228 @example
5229 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pic32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5230 flash bank vbank0 virtual 0xbfc00000 0 0 0 \
5231 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
5232 flash bank vbank1 virtual 0x9fc00000 0 0 0 \
5233 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
5234 @end example
5235 @end deffn
5236
5237 @subsection External Flash
5238
5239 @deffn {Flash Driver} cfi
5240 @cindex Common Flash Interface
5241 @cindex CFI
5242 The ``Common Flash Interface'' (CFI) is the main standard for
5243 external NOR flash chips, each of which connects to a
5244 specific external chip select on the CPU.
5245 Frequently the first such chip is used to boot the system.
5246 Your board's @code{reset-init} handler might need to
5247 configure additional chip selects using other commands (like: @command{mww} to
5248 configure a bus and its timings), or
5249 perhaps configure a GPIO pin that controls the ``write protect'' pin
5250 on the flash chip.
5251 The CFI driver can use a target-specific working area to significantly
5252 speed up operation.
5253
5254 The CFI driver can accept the following optional parameters, in any order:
5255
5256 @itemize
5257 @item @var{jedec_probe} ... is used to detect certain non-CFI flash ROMs,
5258 like AM29LV010 and similar types.
5259 @item @var{x16_as_x8} ... when a 16-bit flash is hooked up to an 8-bit bus.
5260 @item @var{bus_swap} ... when data bytes in a 16-bit flash needs to be swapped.
5261 @item @var{data_swap} ... when data bytes in a 16-bit flash needs to be
5262 swapped when writing data values (i.e. not CFI commands).
5263 @end itemize
5264
5265 To configure two adjacent banks of 16 MBytes each, both sixteen bits (two bytes)
5266 wide on a sixteen bit bus:
5267
5268 @example
5269 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
5270 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x01000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
5271 @end example
5272
5273 To configure one bank of 32 MBytes
5274 built from two sixteen bit (two byte) wide parts wired in parallel
5275 to create a thirty-two bit (four byte) bus with doubled throughput:
5276
5277 @example
5278 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x02000000 2 4 $_TARGETNAME
5279 @end example
5280
5281 @c "cfi part_id" disabled
5282 @end deffn
5283
5284 @deffn {Flash Driver} jtagspi
5285 @cindex Generic JTAG2SPI driver
5286 @cindex SPI
5287 @cindex jtagspi
5288 @cindex bscan_spi
5289 Several FPGAs and CPLDs can retrieve their configuration (bitstream) from a
5290 SPI flash connected to them. To access this flash from the host, the device
5291 is first programmed with a special proxy bitstream that
5292 exposes the SPI flash on the device's JTAG interface. The flash can then be
5293 accessed through JTAG.
5294
5295 Since signaling between JTAG and SPI is compatible, all that is required for
5296 a proxy bitstream is to connect TDI-MOSI, TDO-MISO, TCK-CLK and activate
5297 the flash chip select when the JTAG state machine is in SHIFT-DR. Such
5298 a bitstream for several Xilinx FPGAs can be found in
5299 @file{contrib/loaders/flash/fpga/xilinx_bscan_spi.py}. It requires
5300 @uref{https://github.com/m-labs/migen, migen} and a Xilinx toolchain to build.
5301
5302 This flash bank driver requires a target on a JTAG tap and will access that
5303 tap directly. Since no support from the target is needed, the target can be a
5304 "testee" dummy. Since the target does not expose the flash memory
5305 mapping, target commands that would otherwise be expected to access the flash
5306 will not work. These include all @command{*_image} and
5307 @command{$target_name m*} commands as well as @command{program}. Equivalent
5308 functionality is available through the @command{flash write_bank},
5309 @command{flash read_bank}, and @command{flash verify_bank} commands.
5310
5311 @itemize
5312 @item @var{ir} ... is loaded into the JTAG IR to map the flash as the JTAG DR.
5313 For the bitstreams generated from @file{xilinx_bscan_spi.py} this is the
5314 @var{USER1} instruction.
5315 @end itemize
5316
5317 @example
5318 target create $_TARGETNAME testee -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.fpga
5319 set _XILINX_USER1 0x02
5320 flash bank $_FLASHNAME spi 0x0 0 0 0 \
5321 $_TARGETNAME $_XILINX_USER1
5322 @end example
5323 @end deffn
5324
5325 @deffn {Flash Driver} xcf
5326 @cindex Xilinx Platform flash driver
5327 @cindex xcf
5328 Xilinx FPGAs can be configured from specialized flash ICs named Platform Flash.
5329 It is (almost) regular NOR flash with erase sectors, program pages, etc. The
5330 only difference is special registers controlling its FPGA specific behavior.
5331 They must be properly configured for successful FPGA loading using
5332 additional @var{xcf} driver command:
5333
5334 @deffn Command {xcf ccb} <bank_id>
5335 command accepts additional parameters:
5336 @itemize
5337 @item @var{external|internal} ... selects clock source.
5338 @item @var{serial|parallel} ... selects serial or parallel data bus mode.
5339 @item @var{slave|master} ... selects slave of master mode for flash device.
5340 @item @var{40|20} ... selects clock frequency in MHz for internal clock
5341 in master mode.
5342 @end itemize
5343 @example
5344 xcf ccb 0 external parallel slave 40
5345 @end example
5346 All of them must be specified even if clock frequency is pointless
5347 in slave mode. If only bank id specified than command prints current
5348 CCB register value. Note: there is no need to write this register
5349 every time you erase/program data sectors because it stores in
5350 dedicated sector.
5351 @end deffn
5352
5353 @deffn Command {xcf configure} <bank_id>
5354 Initiates FPGA loading procedure. Useful if your board has no "configure"
5355 button.
5356 @example
5357 xcf configure 0
5358 @end example
5359 @end deffn
5360
5361 Additional driver notes:
5362 @itemize
5363 @item Only single revision supported.
5364 @item Driver automatically detects need of bit reverse, but
5365 only "bin" (raw binary, do not confuse it with "bit") and "mcs"
5366 (Intel hex) file types supported.
5367 @item For additional info check xapp972.pdf and ug380.pdf.
5368 @end itemize
5369 @end deffn
5370
5371 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpcspifi
5372 @cindex NXP SPI Flash Interface
5373 @cindex SPIFI
5374 @cindex lpcspifi
5375 NXP's LPC43xx and LPC18xx families include a proprietary SPI
5376 Flash Interface (SPIFI) peripheral that can drive and provide
5377 memory mapped access to external SPI flash devices.
5378
5379 The lpcspifi driver initializes this interface and provides
5380 program and erase functionality for these serial flash devices.
5381 Use of this driver @b{requires} a working area of at least 1kB
5382 to be configured on the target device; more than this will
5383 significantly reduce flash programming times.
5384
5385 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter. All
5386 other parameters are ignored, and the flash size and layout
5387 are configured by the driver.
5388
5389 @example
5390 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpcspifi 0x14000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5391 @end example
5392
5393 @end deffn
5394
5395 @deffn {Flash Driver} stmsmi
5396 @cindex STMicroelectronics Serial Memory Interface
5397 @cindex SMI
5398 @cindex stmsmi
5399 Some devices from STMicroelectronics (e.g. STR75x MCU family,
5400 SPEAr MPU family) include a proprietary
5401 ``Serial Memory Interface'' (SMI) controller able to drive external
5402 SPI flash devices.
5403 Depending on specific device and board configuration, up to 4 external
5404 flash devices can be connected.
5405
5406 SMI makes the flash content directly accessible in the CPU address
5407 space; each external device is mapped in a memory bank.
5408 CPU can directly read data, execute code and boot from SMI banks.
5409 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
5410 the flash content.
5411
5412 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
5413 to identify the memory bank.
5414 All other parameters are ignored. Additional information, like
5415 flash size, are detected automatically.
5416
5417 @example
5418 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmsmi 0xf8000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5419 @end example
5420
5421 @end deffn
5422
5423 @deffn {Flash Driver} mrvlqspi
5424 This driver supports QSPI flash controller of Marvell's Wireless
5425 Microcontroller platform.
5426
5427 The flash size is autodetected based on the table of known JEDEC IDs
5428 hardcoded in the OpenOCD sources.
5429
5430 @example
5431 flash bank $_FLASHNAME mrvlqspi 0x0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0x46010000
5432 @end example
5433
5434 @end deffn
5435
5436 @deffn {Flash Driver} ath79
5437 @cindex Atheros ath79 SPI driver
5438 @cindex ath79
5439 Members of ATH79 SoC family from Atheros include a SPI interface with 3
5440 chip selects.
5441 On reset a SPI flash connected to the first chip select (CS0) is made
5442 directly read-accessible in the CPU address space (up to 16MBytes)
5443 and is usually used to store the bootloader and operating system.
5444 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
5445 the flash content while it is in memory-mapped mode (only the first
5446 4MBytes are accessible without additional configuration on reset).
5447
5448 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
5449 to identify the memory bank. The actual value for the base address
5450 is not otherwise used by the driver. However the mapping is passed
5451 to gdb. Thus for the memory mapped flash (chipselect CS0) the base
5452 address should be the actual memory mapped base address. For unmapped
5453 chipselects (CS1 and CS2) care should be taken to use a base address
5454 that does not overlap with real memory regions.
5455 Additional information, like flash size, are detected automatically.
5456 An optional additional parameter sets the chipselect for the bank,
5457 with the default CS0.
5458 CS1 and CS2 require additional GPIO setup before they can be used
5459 since the alternate function must be enabled on the GPIO pin
5460 CS1/CS2 is routed to on the given SoC.
5461
5462 @example
5463 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ath79 0xbf000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5464
5465 # When using multiple chipselects the base should be different for each,
5466 # otherwise the write_image command is not able to distinguish the
5467 # banks.
5468 flash bank flash0 ath79 0xbf000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs0
5469 flash bank flash1 ath79 0x10000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs1
5470 flash bank flash2 ath79 0x20000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs2
5471 @end example
5472
5473 @end deffn
5474
5475 @deffn {Flash Driver} fespi
5476 @cindex Freedom E SPI
5477 @cindex fespi
5478
5479 SiFive's Freedom E SPI controller, used in HiFive and other boards.
5480
5481 @example
5482 flash bank $_FLASHNAME fespi 0x20000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5483 @end example
5484 @end deffn
5485
5486 @subsection Internal Flash (Microcontrollers)
5487
5488 @deffn {Flash Driver} aduc702x
5489 The ADUC702x analog microcontrollers from Analog Devices
5490 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
5491 The aduc702x flash driver works with models ADUC7019 through ADUC7028.
5492 The setup command only requires the @var{target} argument
5493 since all devices in this family have the same memory layout.
5494
5495 @example
5496 flash bank $_FLASHNAME aduc702x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5497 @end example
5498 @end deffn
5499
5500 @deffn {Flash Driver} ambiqmicro
5501 @cindex ambiqmicro
5502 @cindex apollo
5503 All members of the Apollo microcontroller family from
5504 Ambiq Micro include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5505 The host connects over USB to an FTDI interface that communicates
5506 with the target using SWD.
5507
5508 The @var{ambiqmicro} driver reads the Chip Information Register detect
5509 the device class of the MCU.
5510 The Flash and SRAM sizes directly follow device class, and are used
5511 to set up the flash banks.
5512 If this fails, the driver will use default values set to the minimum
5513 sizes of an Apollo chip.
5514
5515 All Apollo chips have two flash banks of the same size.
5516 In all cases the first flash bank starts at location 0,
5517 and the second bank starts after the first.
5518
5519 @example
5520 # Flash bank 0
5521 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ambiqmicro 0 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5522 # Flash bank 1 - same size as bank0, starts after bank 0.
5523 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ambiqmicro 0x00040000 0x00040000 0 0 \
5524 $_TARGETNAME
5525 @end example
5526
5527 Flash is programmed using custom entry points into the bootloader.
5528 This is the only way to program the flash as no flash control registers
5529 are available to the user.
5530
5531 The @var{ambiqmicro} driver adds some additional commands:
5532
5533 @deffn Command {ambiqmicro mass_erase} <bank>
5534 Erase entire bank.
5535 @end deffn
5536 @deffn Command {ambiqmicro page_erase} <bank> <first> <last>
5537 Erase device pages.
5538 @end deffn
5539 @deffn Command {ambiqmicro program_otp} <bank> <offset> <count>
5540 Program OTP is a one time operation to create write protected flash.
5541 The user writes sectors to SRAM starting at 0x10000010.
5542 Program OTP will write these sectors from SRAM to flash, and write protect
5543 the flash.
5544 @end deffn
5545 @end deffn
5546
5547 @anchor{at91samd}
5548 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91samd
5549 @cindex at91samd
5550 All members of the ATSAM D2x, D1x, D0x, ATSAMR, ATSAML and ATSAMC microcontroller
5551 families from Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M0+ core.
5552
5553 Do not use for ATSAM D51 and E5x: use @xref{atsame5}.
5554
5555 The devices have one flash bank:
5556
5557 @example
5558 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91samd 0x00000000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5559 @end example
5560
5561 @deffn Command {at91samd chip-erase}
5562 Issues a complete Flash erase via the Device Service Unit (DSU). This can be
5563 used to erase a chip back to its factory state and does not require the
5564 processor to be halted.
5565 @end deffn
5566
5567 @deffn Command {at91samd set-security}
5568 Secures the Flash via the Set Security Bit (SSB) command. This prevents access
5569 to the Flash and can only be undone by using the chip-erase command which
5570 erases the Flash contents and turns off the security bit. Warning: at this
5571 time, openocd will not be able to communicate with a secured chip and it is
5572 therefore not possible to chip-erase it without using another tool.
5573
5574 @example
5575 at91samd set-security enable
5576 @end example
5577 @end deffn
5578
5579 @deffn Command {at91samd eeprom}
5580 Shows or sets the EEPROM emulation size configuration, stored in the User Row
5581 of the Flash. When setting, the EEPROM size must be specified in bytes and it
5582 must be one of the permitted sizes according to the datasheet. Settings are
5583 written immediately but only take effect on MCU reset. EEPROM emulation
5584 requires additional firmware support and the minimum EEPROM size may not be
5585 the same as the minimum that the hardware supports. Set the EEPROM size to 0
5586 in order to disable this feature.
5587
5588 @example
5589 at91samd eeprom
5590 at91samd eeprom 1024
5591 @end example
5592 @end deffn
5593
5594 @deffn Command {at91samd bootloader}
5595 Shows or sets the bootloader size configuration, stored in the User Row of the
5596 Flash. This is called the BOOTPROT region. When setting, the bootloader size
5597 must be specified in bytes and it must be one of the permitted sizes according
5598 to the datasheet. Settings are written immediately but only take effect on
5599 MCU reset. Setting the bootloader size to 0 disables bootloader protection.
5600
5601 @example
5602 at91samd bootloader
5603 at91samd bootloader 16384
5604 @end example
5605 @end deffn
5606
5607 @deffn Command {at91samd dsu_reset_deassert}
5608 This command releases internal reset held by DSU
5609 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
5610 Command is used internally in event event reset-deassert-post.
5611 @end deffn
5612
5613 @deffn Command {at91samd nvmuserrow}
5614 Writes or reads the entire 64 bit wide NVM user row register which is located at
5615 0x804000. This register includes various fuses lock-bits and factory calibration
5616 data. Reading the register is done by invoking this command without any
5617 arguments. Writing is possible by giving 1 or 2 hex values. The first argument
5618 is the register value to be written and the second one is an optional changemask.
5619 Every bit which value in changemask is 0 will stay unchanged. The lock- and
5620 reserved-bits are masked out and cannot be changed.
5621
5622 @example
5623 # Read user row
5624 >at91samd nvmuserrow
5625 NVMUSERROW: 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788
5626 # Write 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788 to user row
5627 >at91samd nvmuserrow 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788
5628 # Write 0x12300 to user row but leave other bits and low byte unchanged
5629 >at91samd nvmuserrow 0x12345 0xFFF00
5630 @end example
5631 @end deffn
5632
5633 @end deffn
5634
5635 @anchor{at91sam3}
5636 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam3
5637 @cindex at91sam3
5638 All members of the AT91SAM3 microcontroller family from
5639 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M3 core. The driver
5640 currently (6/22/09) recognizes the AT91SAM3U[1/2/4][C/E] chips. Note
5641 that the driver was orginaly developed and tested using the
5642 AT91SAM3U4E, using a SAM3U-EK eval board. Support for other chips in
5643 the family was cribbed from the data sheet. @emph{Note to future
5644 readers/updaters: Please remove this worrisome comment after other
5645 chips are confirmed.}
5646
5647 The AT91SAM3U4[E/C] (256K) chips have two flash banks; most other chips
5648 have one flash bank. In all cases the flash banks are at
5649 the following fixed locations:
5650
5651 @example
5652 # Flash bank 0 - all chips
5653 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00080000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5654 # Flash bank 1 - only 256K chips
5655 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00100000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5656 @end example
5657
5658 Internally, the AT91SAM3 flash memory is organized as follows.
5659 Unlike the AT91SAM7 chips, these are not used as parameters
5660 to the @command{flash bank} command:
5661
5662 @itemize
5663 @item @emph{N-Banks:} 256K chips have 2 banks, others have 1 bank.
5664 @item @emph{Bank Size:} 128K/64K Per flash bank
5665 @item @emph{Sectors:} 16 or 8 per bank
5666 @item @emph{SectorSize:} 8K Per Sector
5667 @item @emph{PageSize:} 256 bytes per page. Note that OpenOCD operates on 'sector' sizes, not page sizes.
5668 @end itemize
5669
5670 The AT91SAM3 driver adds some additional commands:
5671
5672 @deffn Command {at91sam3 gpnvm}
5673 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm clear} number
5674 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm set} number
5675 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm show} [@option{all}|number]
5676 With no parameters, @command{show} or @command{show all},
5677 shows the status of all GPNVM bits.
5678 With @command{show} @var{number}, displays that bit.
5679
5680 With @command{set} @var{number} or @command{clear} @var{number},
5681 modifies that GPNVM bit.
5682 @end deffn
5683
5684 @deffn Command {at91sam3 info}
5685 This command attempts to display information about the AT91SAM3
5686 chip. @emph{First} it read the @code{CHIPID_CIDR} [address 0x400e0740, see
5687 Section 28.2.1, page 505 of the AT91SAM3U 29/may/2009 datasheet,
5688 document id: doc6430A] and decodes the values. @emph{Second} it reads the
5689 various clock configuration registers and attempts to display how it
5690 believes the chip is configured. By default, the SLOWCLK is assumed to
5691 be 32768 Hz, see the command @command{at91sam3 slowclk}.
5692 @end deffn
5693
5694 @deffn Command {at91sam3 slowclk} [value]
5695 This command shows/sets the slow clock frequency used in the
5696 @command{at91sam3 info} command calculations above.
5697 @end deffn
5698 @end deffn
5699
5700 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam4
5701 @cindex at91sam4
5702 All members of the AT91SAM4 microcontroller family from
5703 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5704 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
5705 @end deffn
5706
5707 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam4l
5708 @cindex at91sam4l
5709 All members of the AT91SAM4L microcontroller family from
5710 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5711 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
5712
5713 The AT91SAM4L driver adds some additional commands:
5714 @deffn Command {at91sam4l smap_reset_deassert}
5715 This command releases internal reset held by SMAP
5716 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
5717 Command is used internally in event event reset-deassert-post.
5718 @end deffn
5719 @end deffn
5720
5721 @anchor{atsame5}
5722 @deffn {Flash Driver} atsame5
5723 @cindex atsame5
5724 All members of the SAM E54, E53, E51 and D51 microcontroller
5725 families from Microchip (former Atmel) include internal flash
5726 and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5727
5728 The devices have two ECC flash banks with a swapping feature.
5729 This driver handles both banks together as it were one.
5730 Bank swapping is not supported yet.
5731
5732 @example
5733 flash bank $_FLASHNAME atsame5 0x00000000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5734 @end example
5735
5736 @deffn Command {atsame5 bootloader}
5737 Shows or sets the bootloader size configuration, stored in the User Page of the
5738 Flash. This is called the BOOTPROT region. When setting, the bootloader size
5739 must be specified in bytes. The nearest bigger protection size is used.
5740 Settings are written immediately but only take effect on MCU reset.
5741 Setting the bootloader size to 0 disables bootloader protection.
5742
5743 @example
5744 atsame5 bootloader
5745 atsame5 bootloader 16384
5746 @end example
5747 @end deffn
5748
5749 @deffn Command {atsame5 chip-erase}
5750 Issues a complete Flash erase via the Device Service Unit (DSU). This can be
5751 used to erase a chip back to its factory state and does not require the
5752 processor to be halted.
5753 @end deffn
5754
5755 @deffn Command {atsame5 dsu_reset_deassert}
5756 This command releases internal reset held by DSU
5757 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
5758 Command is used internally in event event reset-deassert-post.
5759 @end deffn
5760
5761 @deffn Command {atsame5 userpage}
5762 Writes or reads the first 64 bits of NVM User Page which is located at
5763 0x804000. This field includes various fuses.
5764 Reading is done by invoking this command without any arguments.
5765 Writing is possible by giving 1 or 2 hex values. The first argument
5766 is the value to be written and the second one is an optional bit mask
5767 (a zero bit in the mask means the bit stays unchanged).
5768 The reserved fields are always masked out and cannot be changed.
5769
5770 @example
5771 # Read
5772 >atsame5 userpage
5773 USER PAGE: 0xAEECFF80FE9A9239
5774 # Write
5775 >atsame5 userpage 0xAEECFF80FE9A9239
5776 # Write 2 to SEESBLK and 4 to SEEPSZ fields but leave other bits unchanged
5777 # (setup SmartEEPROM of virtual size 8192 bytes)
5778 >atsame5 userpage 0x4200000000 0x7f00000000
5779 @end example
5780 @end deffn
5781
5782 @end deffn
5783
5784 @deffn {Flash Driver} atsamv
5785 @cindex atsamv
5786 All members of the ATSAMV7x, ATSAMS70, and ATSAME70 families from
5787 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M7 core.
5788 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
5789 @end deffn
5790
5791 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam7
5792 All members of the AT91SAM7 microcontroller family from Atmel include
5793 internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores. The driver automatically
5794 recognizes a number of these chips using the chip identification
5795 register, and autoconfigures itself.
5796
5797 @example
5798 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam7 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5799 @end example
5800
5801 For chips which are not recognized by the controller driver, you must
5802 provide additional parameters in the following order:
5803
5804 @itemize
5805 @item @var{chip_model} ... label used with @command{flash info}
5806 @item @var{banks}
5807 @item @var{sectors_per_bank}
5808 @item @var{pages_per_sector}
5809 @item @var{pages_size}
5810 @item @var{num_nvm_bits}
5811 @item @var{freq_khz} ... required if an external clock is provided,
5812 optional (but recommended) when the oscillator frequency is known
5813 @end itemize
5814
5815 It is recommended that you provide zeroes for all of those values
5816 except the clock frequency, so that everything except that frequency
5817 will be autoconfigured.
5818 Knowing the frequency helps ensure correct timings for flash access.
5819
5820 The flash controller handles erases automatically on a page (128/256 byte)
5821 basis, so explicit erase commands are not necessary for flash programming.
5822 However, there is an ``EraseAll`` command that can erase an entire flash
5823 plane (of up to 256KB), and it will be used automatically when you issue
5824 @command{flash erase_sector} or @command{flash erase_address} commands.
5825
5826 @deffn Command {at91sam7 gpnvm} bitnum (@option{set}|@option{clear})
5827 Set or clear a ``General Purpose Non-Volatile Memory'' (GPNVM)
5828 bit for the processor. Each processor has a number of such bits,
5829 used for controlling features such as brownout detection (so they
5830 are not truly general purpose).
5831 @quotation Note
5832 This assumes that the first flash bank (number 0) is associated with
5833 the appropriate at91sam7 target.
5834 @end quotation
5835 @end deffn
5836 @end deffn
5837
5838 @deffn {Flash Driver} avr
5839 The AVR 8-bit microcontrollers from Atmel integrate flash memory.
5840 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete.}
5841 @comment - defines mass_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
5842 @end deffn
5843
5844 @deffn {Flash Driver} bluenrg-x
5845 STMicroelectronics BlueNRG-1, BlueNRG-2 and BlueNRG-LP Bluetooth low energy wireless system-on-chip. They include ARM Cortex-M0/M0+ core and internal flash memory.
5846 The driver automatically recognizes these chips using
5847 the chip identification registers, and autoconfigures itself.
5848
5849 @example
5850 flash bank $_FLASHNAME bluenrg-x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5851 @end example
5852
5853 Note that when users ask to erase all the sectors of the flash, a mass erase command is used which is faster than erasing
5854 each single sector one by one.
5855
5856 @example
5857 flash erase_sector 0 0 last # It will perform a mass erase
5858 @end example
5859
5860 Triggering a mass erase is also useful when users want to disable readout protection.
5861 @end deffn
5862
5863 @deffn {Flash Driver} cc26xx
5864 All versions of the SimpleLink CC13xx and CC26xx microcontrollers from Texas
5865 Instruments include internal flash. The cc26xx flash driver supports both the
5866 CC13xx and CC26xx family of devices. The driver automatically recognizes the
5867 specific version's flash parameters and autoconfigures itself. The flash bank
5868 starts at address 0.
5869
5870 @example
5871 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cc26xx 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5872 @end example
5873 @end deffn
5874
5875 @deffn {Flash Driver} cc3220sf
5876 The CC3220SF version of the SimpleLink CC32xx microcontrollers from Texas
5877 Instruments includes 1MB of internal flash. The cc3220sf flash driver only
5878 supports the internal flash. The serial flash on SimpleLink boards is
5879 programmed via the bootloader over a UART connection. Security features of
5880 the CC3220SF may erase the internal flash during power on reset. Refer to
5881 documentation at @url{www.ti.com/cc3220sf} for details on security features
5882 and programming the serial flash.
5883
5884 @example
5885 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cc3220sf 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5886 @end example
5887 @end deffn
5888
5889 @deffn {Flash Driver} efm32
5890 All members of the EFM32 microcontroller family from Energy Micro include
5891 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores. The driver automatically recognizes
5892 a number of these chips using the chip identification register, and
5893 autoconfigures itself.
5894 @example
5895 flash bank $_FLASHNAME efm32 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5896 @end example
5897 A special feature of efm32 controllers is that it is possible to completely disable the
5898 debug interface by writing the correct values to the 'Debug Lock Word'. OpenOCD supports
5899 this via the following command:
5900 @example
5901 efm32 debuglock num
5902 @end example
5903 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5904 Note that in order for this command to take effect, the target needs to be reset.
5905 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Unprotecting flash pages is not
5906 supported.}
5907 @end deffn
5908
5909 @deffn {Flash Driver} esirisc
5910 Members of the eSi-RISC family may optionally include internal flash programmed
5911 via the eSi-TSMC Flash interface. Additional parameters are required to
5912 configure the driver: @option{cfg_address} is the base address of the
5913 configuration register interface, @option{clock_hz} is the expected clock
5914 frequency, and @option{wait_states} is the number of configured read wait states.
5915
5916 @example
5917 flash bank $_FLASHNAME esirisc base_address size_bytes 0 0 \
5918 $_TARGETNAME cfg_address clock_hz wait_states
5919 @end example
5920
5921 @deffn Command {esirisc flash mass_erase} bank_id
5922 Erase all pages in data memory for the bank identified by @option{bank_id}.
5923 @end deffn
5924
5925 @deffn Command {esirisc flash ref_erase} bank_id
5926 Erase the reference cell for the bank identified by @option{bank_id}. @emph{This
5927 is an uncommon operation.}
5928 @end deffn
5929 @end deffn
5930
5931 @deffn {Flash Driver} fm3
5932 All members of the FM3 microcontroller family from Fujitsu
5933 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
5934 The @var{fm3} driver uses the @var{target} parameter to select the
5935 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
5936 @code{mb9bfxx1.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx2.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx3.cpu},
5937 @code{mb9bfxx4.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx5.cpu} or @code{mb9bfxx6.cpu}.
5938
5939 @example
5940 flash bank $_FLASHNAME fm3 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5941 @end example
5942 @end deffn
5943
5944 @deffn {Flash Driver} fm4
5945 All members of the FM4 microcontroller family from Spansion (formerly Fujitsu)
5946 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M4 cores.
5947 The @var{fm4} driver uses a @var{family} parameter to select the
5948 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
5949 @code{MB9BFx64}, @code{MB9BFx65}, @code{MB9BFx66}, @code{MB9BFx67}, @code{MB9BFx68},
5950 @code{S6E2Cx8}, @code{S6E2Cx9}, @code{S6E2CxA} or @code{S6E2Dx},
5951 with @code{x} treated as wildcard and otherwise case (and any trailing
5952 characters) ignored.
5953
5954 @example
5955 flash bank $@{_FLASHNAME@}0 fm4 0x00000000 0 0 0 \
5956 $_TARGETNAME S6E2CCAJ0A
5957 flash bank $@{_FLASHNAME@}1 fm4 0x00100000 0 0 0 \
5958 $_TARGETNAME S6E2CCAJ0A
5959 @end example
5960 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Protection is not supported,
5961 nor is Chip Erase (only Sector Erase is implemented).}
5962 @end deffn
5963
5964 @deffn {Flash Driver} kinetis
5965 @cindex kinetis
5966 Kx, KLx, KVx and KE1x members of the Kinetis microcontroller family
5967 from NXP (former Freescale) include
5968 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0+ or M4 cores. The driver automatically
5969 recognizes flash size and a number of flash banks (1-4) using the chip
5970 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
5971 Use kinetis_ke driver for KE0x and KEAx devices.
5972
5973 The @var{kinetis} driver defines option:
5974 @itemize
5975 @item -sim-base @var{addr} ... base of System Integration Module where chip identification resides. Driver tries two known locations if option is omitted.
5976 @end itemize
5977
5978 @example
5979 flash bank $_FLASHNAME kinetis 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5980 @end example
5981
5982 @deffn Command {kinetis create_banks}
5983 Configuration command enables automatic creation of additional flash banks
5984 based on real flash layout of device. Banks are created during device probe.
5985 Use 'flash probe 0' to force probe.
5986 @end deffn
5987
5988 @deffn Command {kinetis fcf_source} [protection|write]
5989 Select what source is used when writing to a Flash Configuration Field.
5990 @option{protection} mode builds FCF content from protection bits previously
5991 set by 'flash protect' command.
5992 This mode is default. MCU is protected from unwanted locking by immediate
5993 writing FCF after erase of relevant sector.
5994 @option{write} mode enables direct write to FCF.
5995 Protection cannot be set by 'flash protect' command. FCF is written along
5996 with the rest of a flash image.
5997 @emph{BEWARE: Incorrect flash configuration may permanently lock the device!}
5998 @end deffn
5999
6000 @deffn Command {kinetis fopt} [num]
6001 Set value to write to FOPT byte of Flash Configuration Field.
6002 Used in kinetis 'fcf_source protection' mode only.
6003 @end deffn
6004
6005 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm check_security}
6006 Checks status of device security lock. Used internally in examine-end
6007 and examine-fail event.
6008 @end deffn
6009
6010 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm halt}
6011 Issues a halt via the MDM-AP. This command can be used to break a watchdog reset
6012 loop when connecting to an unsecured target.
6013 @end deffn
6014
6015 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm mass_erase}
6016 Issues a complete flash erase via the MDM-AP. This can be used to erase a chip
6017 back to its factory state, removing security. It does not require the processor
6018 to be halted, however the target will remain in a halted state after this
6019 command completes.
6020 @end deffn
6021
6022 @deffn Command {kinetis nvm_partition}
6023 For FlexNVM devices only (KxxDX and KxxFX).
6024 Command shows or sets data flash or EEPROM backup size in kilobytes,
6025 sets two EEPROM blocks sizes in bytes and enables/disables loading
6026 of EEPROM contents to FlexRAM during reset.
6027
6028 For details see device reference manual, Flash Memory Module,
6029 Program Partition command.
6030
6031 Setting is possible only once after mass_erase.
6032 Reset the device after partition setting.
6033
6034 Show partition size:
6035 @example
6036 kinetis nvm_partition info
6037 @end example
6038
6039 Set 32 KB data flash, rest of FlexNVM is EEPROM backup. EEPROM has two blocks
6040 of 512 and 1536 bytes and its contents is loaded to FlexRAM during reset:
6041 @example
6042 kinetis nvm_partition dataflash 32 512 1536 on
6043 @end example
6044
6045 Set 16 KB EEPROM backup, rest of FlexNVM is a data flash. EEPROM has two blocks
6046 of 1024 bytes and its contents is not loaded to FlexRAM during reset:
6047 @example
6048 kinetis nvm_partition eebkp 16 1024 1024 off
6049 @end example
6050 @end deffn
6051
6052 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm reset}
6053 Issues a reset via the MDM-AP. This causes the MCU to output a low pulse on the
6054 RESET pin, which can be used to reset other hardware on board.
6055 @end deffn
6056
6057 @deffn Command {kinetis disable_wdog}
6058 For Kx devices only (KLx has different COP watchdog, it is not supported).
6059 Command disables watchdog timer.
6060 @end deffn
6061 @end deffn
6062
6063 @deffn {Flash Driver} kinetis_ke
6064 @cindex kinetis_ke
6065 KE0x and KEAx members of the Kinetis microcontroller family from NXP include
6066 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0+. The driver automatically recognizes
6067 the KE0x sub-family using the chip identification register, and
6068 autoconfigures itself.
6069 Use kinetis (not kinetis_ke) driver for KE1x devices.
6070
6071 @example
6072 flash bank $_FLASHNAME kinetis_ke 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6073 @end example
6074
6075 @deffn Command {kinetis_ke mdm check_security}
6076 Checks status of device security lock. Used internally in examine-end event.
6077 @end deffn
6078
6079 @deffn Command {kinetis_ke mdm mass_erase}
6080 Issues a complete Flash erase via the MDM-AP.
6081 This can be used to erase a chip back to its factory state.
6082 Command removes security lock from a device (use of SRST highly recommended).
6083 It does not require the processor to be halted.
6084 @end deffn
6085
6086 @deffn Command {kinetis_ke disable_wdog}
6087 Command disables watchdog timer.
6088 @end deffn
6089 @end deffn
6090
6091 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc2000
6092 This is the driver to support internal flash of all members of the
6093 LPC11(x)00 and LPC1300 microcontroller families and most members of
6094 the LPC800, LPC1500, LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4000, LPC54100,
6095 LPC8Nxx and NHS31xx microcontroller families from NXP.
6096
6097 @quotation Note
6098 There are LPC2000 devices which are not supported by the @var{lpc2000}
6099 driver:
6100 The LPC2888 is supported by the @var{lpc288x} driver.
6101 The LPC29xx family is supported by the @var{lpc2900} driver.
6102 @end quotation
6103
6104 The @var{lpc2000} driver defines two mandatory and two optional parameters,
6105 which must appear in the following order:
6106
6107 @itemize
6108 @item @var{variant} ... required, may be
6109 @option{lpc2000_v1} (older LPC21xx and LPC22xx)
6110 @option{lpc2000_v2} (LPC213x, LPC214x, LPC210[123], LPC23xx and LPC24xx)
6111 @option{lpc1700} (LPC175x and LPC176x and LPC177x/8x)
6112 @option{lpc4300} - available also as @option{lpc1800} alias (LPC18x[2357] and
6113 LPC43x[2357])
6114 @option{lpc800} (LPC8xx)
6115 @option{lpc1100} (LPC11(x)xx and LPC13xx)
6116 @option{lpc1500} (LPC15xx)
6117 @option{lpc54100} (LPC541xx)
6118 @option{lpc4000} (LPC40xx)
6119 or @option{auto} - automatically detects flash variant and size for LPC11(x)00,
6120 LPC8xx, LPC13xx, LPC17xx, LPC40xx, LPC8Nxx and NHS31xx
6121 @item @var{clock_kHz} ... the frequency, in kiloHertz,
6122 at which the core is running
6123 @item @option{calc_checksum} ... optional (but you probably want to provide this!),
6124 telling the driver to calculate a valid checksum for the exception vector table.
6125 @quotation Note
6126 If you don't provide @option{calc_checksum} when you're writing the vector
6127 table, the boot ROM will almost certainly ignore your flash image.
6128 However, if you do provide it,
6129 with most tool chains @command{verify_image} will fail.
6130 @end quotation
6131 @item @option{iap_entry} ... optional telling the driver to use a different
6132 ROM IAP entry point.
6133 @end itemize
6134
6135 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6136
6137 @example
6138 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000 0x0 0x7d000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME \
6139 lpc2000_v2 14765 calc_checksum
6140 @end example
6141
6142 @deffn {Command} {lpc2000 part_id} bank
6143 Displays the four byte part identifier associated with
6144 the specified flash @var{bank}.
6145 @end deffn
6146 @end deffn
6147
6148 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc288x
6149 The LPC2888 microcontroller from NXP needs slightly different flash
6150 support from its lpc2000 siblings.
6151 The @var{lpc288x} driver defines one mandatory parameter,
6152 the programming clock rate in Hz.
6153 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6154
6155 @example
6156 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc288x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 12000000
6157 @end example
6158 @end deffn
6159
6160 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc2900
6161 This driver supports the LPC29xx ARM968E based microcontroller family
6162 from NXP.
6163
6164 The predefined parameters @var{base}, @var{size}, @var{chip_width} and
6165 @var{bus_width} of the @code{flash bank} command are ignored. Flash size and
6166 sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
6167 The driver has one additional mandatory parameter: The CPU clock rate
6168 (in kHz) at the time the flash operations will take place. Most of the time this
6169 will not be the crystal frequency, but a higher PLL frequency. The
6170 @code{reset-init} event handler in the board script is usually the place where
6171 you start the PLL.
6172
6173 The driver rejects flashless devices (currently the LPC2930).
6174
6175 The EEPROM in LPC2900 devices is not mapped directly into the address space.
6176 It must be handled much more like NAND flash memory, and will therefore be
6177 handled by a separate @code{lpc2900_eeprom} driver (not yet available).
6178
6179 Sector protection in terms of the LPC2900 is handled transparently. Every time a
6180 sector needs to be erased or programmed, it is automatically unprotected.
6181 What is shown as protection status in the @code{flash info} command, is
6182 actually the LPC2900 @emph{sector security}. This is a mechanism to prevent a
6183 sector from ever being erased or programmed again. As this is an irreversible
6184 mechanism, it is handled by a special command (@code{lpc2900 secure_sector}),
6185 and not by the standard @code{flash protect} command.
6186
6187 Example for a 125 MHz clock frequency:
6188 @example
6189 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2900 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 125000
6190 @end example
6191
6192 Some @code{lpc2900}-specific commands are defined. In the following command list,
6193 the @var{bank} parameter is the bank number as obtained by the
6194 @code{flash banks} command.
6195
6196 @deffn Command {lpc2900 signature} bank
6197 Calculates a 128-bit hash value, the @emph{signature}, from the whole flash
6198 content. This is a hardware feature of the flash block, hence the calculation is
6199 very fast. You may use this to verify the content of a programmed device against
6200 a known signature.
6201 Example:
6202 @example
6203 lpc2900 signature 0
6204 signature: 0x5f40cdc8:0xc64e592e:0x10490f89:0x32a0f317
6205 @end example
6206 @end deffn
6207
6208 @deffn Command {lpc2900 read_custom} bank filename
6209 Reads the 912 bytes of customer information from the flash index sector, and
6210 saves it to a file in binary format.
6211 Example:
6212 @example
6213 lpc2900 read_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin
6214 @end example
6215 @end deffn
6216
6217 The index sector of the flash is a @emph{write-only} sector. It cannot be
6218 erased! In order to guard against unintentional write access, all following
6219 commands need to be preceded by a successful call to the @code{password}
6220 command:
6221
6222 @deffn Command {lpc2900 password} bank password
6223 You need to use this command right before each of the following commands:
6224 @code{lpc2900 write_custom}, @code{lpc2900 secure_sector},
6225 @code{lpc2900 secure_jtag}.
6226
6227 The password string is fixed to "I_know_what_I_am_doing".
6228 Example:
6229 @example
6230 lpc2900 password 0 I_know_what_I_am_doing
6231 Potentially dangerous operation allowed in next command!
6232 @end example
6233 @end deffn
6234
6235 @deffn Command {lpc2900 write_custom} bank filename type
6236 Writes the content of the file into the customer info space of the flash index
6237 sector. The filetype can be specified with the @var{type} field. Possible values
6238 for @var{type} are: @var{bin} (binary), @var{ihex} (Intel hex format),
6239 @var{elf} (ELF binary) or @var{s19} (Motorola S-records). The file must
6240 contain a single section, and the contained data length must be exactly
6241 912 bytes.
6242 @quotation Attention
6243 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6244 @end quotation
6245 Example:
6246 @example
6247 lpc2900 write_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin bin
6248 @end example
6249 @end deffn
6250
6251 @deffn Command {lpc2900 secure_sector} bank first last
6252 Secures the sector range from @var{first} to @var{last} (including) against
6253 further program and erase operations. The sector security will be effective
6254 after the next power cycle.
6255 @quotation Attention
6256 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6257 @end quotation
6258 Secured sectors appear as @emph{protected} in the @code{flash info} command.
6259 Example:
6260 @example
6261 lpc2900 secure_sector 0 1 1
6262 flash info 0
6263 #0 : lpc2900 at 0x20000000, size 0x000c0000, (...)
6264 # 0: 0x00000000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
6265 # 1: 0x00002000 (0x2000 8kB) protected
6266 # 2: 0x00004000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
6267 @end example
6268 @end deffn
6269
6270 @deffn Command {lpc2900 secure_jtag} bank
6271 Irreversibly disable the JTAG port. The new JTAG security setting will be
6272 effective after the next power cycle.
6273 @quotation Attention
6274 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6275 @end quotation
6276 Examples:
6277 @example
6278 lpc2900 secure_jtag 0
6279 @end example
6280 @end deffn
6281 @end deffn
6282
6283 @deffn {Flash Driver} mdr
6284 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on Milandr Cortex-M
6285 based controllers. A known limitation is that the Info memory can't be
6286 read or verified as it's not memory mapped.
6287
6288 @example
6289 flash bank <name> mdr <base> <size> \
6290 0 0 <target#> @var{type} @var{page_count} @var{sec_count}
6291 @end example
6292
6293 @itemize @bullet
6294 @item @var{type} - 0 for main memory, 1 for info memory
6295 @item @var{page_count} - total number of pages
6296 @item @var{sec_count} - number of sector per page count
6297 @end itemize
6298
6299 Example usage:
6300 @example
6301 if @{ [info exists IMEMORY] && [string equal $IMEMORY true] @} @{
6302 flash bank $@{_CHIPNAME@}_info.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x01000 \
6303 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 1 1 4
6304 @} else @{
6305 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x20000 \
6306 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0 32 4
6307 @}
6308 @end example
6309 @end deffn
6310
6311 @deffn {Flash Driver} msp432
6312 All versions of the SimpleLink MSP432 microcontrollers from Texas
6313 Instruments include internal flash. The msp432 flash driver automatically
6314 recognizes the specific version's flash parameters and autoconfigures itself.
6315 Main program flash starts at address 0. The information flash region on
6316 MSP432P4 versions starts at address 0x200000.
6317
6318 @example
6319 flash bank $_FLASHNAME msp432 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6320 @end example
6321
6322 @deffn Command {msp432 mass_erase} bank_id [main|all]
6323 Performs a complete erase of flash. By default, @command{mass_erase} will erase
6324 only the main program flash.
6325
6326 On MSP432P4 versions, using @command{mass_erase all} will erase both the
6327 main program and information flash regions. To also erase the BSL in information
6328 flash, the user must first use the @command{bsl} command.
6329 @end deffn
6330
6331 @deffn Command {msp432 bsl} bank_id [unlock|lock]
6332 On MSP432P4 versions, @command{bsl} unlocks and locks the bootstrap loader (BSL)
6333 region in information flash so that flash commands can erase or write the BSL.
6334 Leave the BSL locked to prevent accidentally corrupting the bootstrap loader.
6335
6336 To erase and program the BSL:
6337 @example
6338 msp432 bsl unlock
6339 flash erase_address 0x202000 0x2000
6340 flash write_image bsl.bin 0x202000
6341 msp432 bsl lock
6342 @end example
6343 @end deffn
6344 @end deffn
6345
6346 @deffn {Flash Driver} niietcm4
6347 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on NIIET Cortex-M4
6348 based controllers. Flash size and sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
6349 Main flash memory is called "Bootflash" and has main region and info region.
6350 Info region is NOT memory mapped by default,
6351 but it can replace first part of main region if needed.
6352 Full erase, single and block writes are supported for both main and info regions.
6353 There is additional not memory mapped flash called "Userflash", which
6354 also have division into regions: main and info.
6355 Purpose of userflash - to store system and user settings.
6356 Driver has special commands to perform operations with this memory.
6357
6358 @example
6359 flash bank $_FLASHNAME niietcm4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6360 @end example
6361
6362 Some niietcm4-specific commands are defined:
6363
6364 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_read_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address
6365 Read byte from main or info userflash region.
6366 @end deffn
6367
6368 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_write_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address value
6369 Write byte to main or info userflash region.
6370 @end deffn
6371
6372 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_full_erase} bank
6373 Erase all userflash including info region.
6374 @end deffn
6375
6376 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_erase} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector
6377 Erase sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
6378 @end deffn
6379
6380 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_protect_check} bank ('main'|'info')
6381 Check sectors protect.
6382 @end deffn
6383
6384 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_protect} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector ('on'|'off')
6385 Protect sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
6386 @end deffn
6387
6388 @deffn Command {niietcm4 bflash_info_remap} bank ('on'|'off')
6389 Enable remapping bootflash info region to 0x00000000 (or 0x40000000 if external memory boot used).
6390 @end deffn
6391
6392 @deffn Command {niietcm4 extmem_cfg} bank ('gpioa'|'gpiob'|'gpioc'|'gpiod'|'gpioe'|'gpiof'|'gpiog'|'gpioh') pin_num ('func1'|'func3')
6393 Configure external memory interface for boot.
6394 @end deffn
6395
6396 @deffn Command {niietcm4 service_mode_erase} bank
6397 Perform emergency erase of all flash (bootflash and userflash).
6398 @end deffn
6399
6400 @deffn Command {niietcm4 driver_info} bank
6401 Show information about flash driver.
6402 @end deffn
6403
6404 @end deffn
6405
6406 @deffn {Flash Driver} nrf5
6407 All members of the nRF51 microcontroller families from Nordic Semiconductor
6408 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 core.
6409 Also, the nRF52832 microcontroller from Nordic Semiconductor, which include
6410 internal flash and use an ARM Cortex-M4F core.
6411
6412 @example
6413 flash bank $_FLASHNAME nrf5 0 0x00000000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6414 @end example
6415
6416 Some nrf5-specific commands are defined:
6417
6418 @deffn Command {nrf5 mass_erase}
6419 Erases the contents of the code memory and user information
6420 configuration registers as well. It must be noted that this command
6421 works only for chips that do not have factory pre-programmed region 0
6422 code.
6423 @end deffn
6424
6425 @deffn Command {nrf5 info}
6426 Decodes and shows informations from FICR and UICR registers.
6427 @end deffn
6428
6429 @end deffn
6430
6431 @deffn {Flash Driver} ocl
6432 This driver is an implementation of the ``on chip flash loader''
6433 protocol proposed by Pavel Chromy.
6434
6435 It is a minimalistic command-response protocol intended to be used
6436 over a DCC when communicating with an internal or external flash
6437 loader running from RAM. An example implementation for AT91SAM7x is
6438 available in @file{contrib/loaders/flash/at91sam7x/}.
6439
6440 @example
6441 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ocl 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6442 @end example
6443 @end deffn
6444
6445 @deffn {Flash Driver} pic32mx
6446 The PIC32MX microcontrollers are based on the MIPS 4K cores,
6447 and integrate flash memory.
6448
6449 @example
6450 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6451 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1d000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6452 @end example
6453
6454 @comment numerous *disabled* commands are defined:
6455 @comment - chip_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
6456 @comment - lock, unlock ... pointless given protect on/off (yes?)
6457 @comment - pgm_word ... shouldn't bank be deduced from address??
6458 Some pic32mx-specific commands are defined:
6459 @deffn Command {pic32mx pgm_word} address value bank
6460 Programs the specified 32-bit @var{value} at the given @var{address}
6461 in the specified chip @var{bank}.
6462 @end deffn
6463 @deffn Command {pic32mx unlock} bank
6464 Unlock and erase specified chip @var{bank}.
6465 This will remove any Code Protection.
6466 @end deffn
6467 @end deffn
6468
6469 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc4
6470 All members of the PSoC 41xx/42xx microcontroller family from Cypress
6471 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 cores.
6472 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6473 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6474
6475 Note: Erased internal flash reads as 00.
6476 System ROM of PSoC 4 does not implement erase of a flash sector.
6477
6478 @example
6479 flash bank $_FLASHNAME psoc4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6480 @end example
6481
6482 psoc4-specific commands
6483 @deffn Command {psoc4 flash_autoerase} num (on|off)
6484 Enables or disables autoerase mode for a flash bank.
6485
6486 If flash_autoerase is off, use mass_erase before flash programming.
6487 Flash erase command fails if region to erase is not whole flash memory.
6488
6489 If flash_autoerase is on, a sector is both erased and programmed in one
6490 system ROM call. Flash erase command is ignored.
6491 This mode is suitable for gdb load.
6492
6493 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6494 @end deffn
6495
6496 @deffn Command {psoc4 mass_erase} num
6497 Erases the contents of the flash memory, protection and security lock.
6498
6499 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6500 @end deffn
6501 @end deffn
6502
6503 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc5lp
6504 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
6505 include internal program flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6506 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself,
6507 apart from the base address.
6508
6509 @example
6510 flash bank $_FLASHNAME psoc5lp 0x00000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6511 @end example
6512
6513 @b{Note:} PSoC 5LP chips can be configured to have ECC enabled or disabled.
6514 @quotation Attention
6515 If flash operations are performed in ECC-disabled mode, they will also affect
6516 the ECC flash region. Erasing a 16k flash sector in the 0x00000000 area will
6517 then also erase the corresponding 2k data bytes in the 0x48000000 area.
6518 Writing to the ECC data bytes in ECC-disabled mode is not implemented.
6519 @end quotation
6520
6521 Commands defined in the @var{psoc5lp} driver:
6522
6523 @deffn Command {psoc5lp mass_erase}
6524 Erases all flash data and ECC/configuration bytes, all flash protection rows,
6525 and all row latches in all flash arrays on the device.
6526 @end deffn
6527 @end deffn
6528
6529 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc5lp_eeprom
6530 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
6531 include internal EEPROM and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6532 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself,
6533 apart from the base address.
6534
6535 @example
6536 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.eeprom psoc5lp_eeprom 0x40008000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6537 @end example
6538 @end deffn
6539
6540 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc5lp_nvl
6541 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
6542 include internal Nonvolatile Latches and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6543 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself.
6544
6545 @example
6546 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.nvl psoc5lp_nvl 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6547 @end example
6548
6549 PSoC 5LP chips have multiple NV Latches:
6550
6551 @itemize
6552 @item Device Configuration NV Latch - 4 bytes
6553 @item Write Once (WO) NV Latch - 4 bytes
6554 @end itemize
6555
6556 @b{Note:} This driver only implements the Device Configuration NVL.
6557
6558 The @var{psoc5lp} driver reads the ECC mode from Device Configuration NVL.
6559 @quotation Attention
6560 Switching ECC mode via write to Device Configuration NVL will require a reset
6561 after successful write.
6562 @end quotation
6563 @end deffn
6564
6565 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc6
6566 Supports PSoC6 (CY8C6xxx) family of Cypress microcontrollers.
6567 PSoC6 is a dual-core device with CM0+ and CM4 cores. Both cores share
6568 the same Flash/RAM/MMIO address space.
6569
6570 Flash in PSoC6 is split into three regions:
6571 @itemize @bullet
6572 @item Main Flash - this is the main storage for user application.
6573 Total size varies among devices, sector size: 256 kBytes, row size:
6574 512 bytes. Supports erase operation on individual rows.
6575 @item Work Flash - intended to be used as storage for user data
6576 (e.g. EEPROM emulation). Total size: 32 KBytes, sector size: 32 KBytes,
6577 row size: 512 bytes.
6578 @item Supervisory Flash - special region which contains device-specific
6579 service data. This region does not support erase operation. Only few rows can
6580 be programmed by the user, most of the rows are read only. Programming
6581 operation will erase row automatically.
6582 @end itemize
6583
6584 All three flash regions are supported by the driver. Flash geometry is detected
6585 automatically by parsing data in SPCIF_GEOMETRY register.
6586
6587 PSoC6 is equipped with NOR Flash so erased Flash reads as 0x00.
6588
6589 @example
6590 flash bank main_flash_cm0 psoc6 0x10000000 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6591 flash bank work_flash_cm0 psoc6 0x14000000 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6592 flash bank super_flash_user_cm0 psoc6 0x16000800 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6593 flash bank super_flash_nar_cm0 psoc6 0x16001A00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6594 flash bank super_flash_key_cm0 psoc6 0x16005A00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6595 flash bank super_flash_toc2_cm0 psoc6 0x16007C00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6596
6597 flash bank main_flash_cm4 psoc6 0x10000000 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6598 flash bank work_flash_cm4 psoc6 0x14000000 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6599 flash bank super_flash_user_cm4 psoc6 0x16000800 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6600 flash bank super_flash_nar_cm4 psoc6 0x16001A00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6601 flash bank super_flash_key_cm4 psoc6 0x16005A00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6602 flash bank super_flash_toc2_cm4 psoc6 0x16007C00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6603 @end example
6604
6605 psoc6-specific commands
6606 @deffn Command {psoc6 reset_halt}
6607 Command can be used to simulate broken Vector Catch from gdbinit or tcl scripts.
6608 When invoked for CM0+ target, it will set break point at application entry point
6609 and issue SYSRESETREQ. This will reset both cores and all peripherals. CM0+ will
6610 reset CM4 during boot anyway so this is safe. On CM4 target, VECTRESET is used
6611 instead of SYSRESETREQ to avoid unwanted reset of CM0+;
6612 @end deffn
6613
6614 @deffn Command {psoc6 mass_erase} num
6615 Erases the contents given flash bank. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown
6616 by @command{flash banks}.
6617 Note: only Main and Work flash regions support Erase operation.
6618 @end deffn
6619 @end deffn
6620
6621 @deffn {Flash Driver} sim3x
6622 All members of the SiM3 microcontroller family from Silicon Laboratories
6623 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores. It supports both JTAG
6624 and SWD interface.
6625 The @var{sim3x} driver tries to probe the device to auto detect the MCU.
6626 If this fails, it will use the @var{size} parameter as the size of flash bank.
6627
6628 @example
6629 flash bank $_FLASHNAME sim3x 0 $_CPUROMSIZE 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6630 @end example
6631
6632 There are 2 commands defined in the @var{sim3x} driver:
6633
6634 @deffn Command {sim3x mass_erase}
6635 Erases the complete flash. This is used to unlock the flash.
6636 And this command is only possible when using the SWD interface.
6637 @end deffn
6638
6639 @deffn Command {sim3x lock}
6640 Lock the flash. To unlock use the @command{sim3x mass_erase} command.
6641 @end deffn
6642 @end deffn
6643
6644 @deffn {Flash Driver} stellaris
6645 All members of the Stellaris LM3Sxxx, LM4x and Tiva C microcontroller
6646 families from Texas Instruments include internal flash. The driver
6647 automatically recognizes a number of these chips using the chip
6648 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6649
6650 @example
6651 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stellaris 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6652 @end example
6653
6654 @deffn Command {stellaris recover}
6655 Performs the @emph{Recovering a "Locked" Device} procedure to restore
6656 the flash and its associated nonvolatile registers to their factory
6657 default values (erased). This is the only way to remove flash
6658 protection or re-enable debugging if that capability has been
6659 disabled.
6660
6661 Note that the final "power cycle the chip" step in this procedure
6662 must be performed by hand, since OpenOCD can't do it.
6663 @quotation Warning
6664 if more than one Stellaris chip is connected, the procedure is
6665 applied to all of them.
6666 @end quotation
6667 @end deffn
6668 @end deffn
6669
6670 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32f1x
6671 All members of the STM32F0, STM32F1 and STM32F3 microcontroller families
6672 from STMicroelectronics include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0/M3/M4 cores.
6673 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6674 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6675
6676 @example
6677 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6678 @end example
6679
6680 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
6681 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
6682 the flash driver.
6683
6684 @example
6685 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6686 @end example
6687
6688 If you have a target with dual flash banks then define the second bank
6689 as per the following example.
6690 @example
6691 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0x08080000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6692 @end example
6693
6694 Some stm32f1x-specific commands are defined:
6695
6696 @deffn Command {stm32f1x lock} num
6697 Locks the entire stm32 device against reading.
6698 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6699 @end deffn
6700
6701 @deffn Command {stm32f1x unlock} num
6702 Unlocks the entire stm32 device for reading. This command will cause
6703 a mass erase of the entire stm32 device if previously locked.
6704 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6705 @end deffn
6706
6707 @deffn Command {stm32f1x mass_erase} num
6708 Mass erases the entire stm32 device.
6709 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6710 @end deffn
6711
6712 @deffn Command {stm32f1x options_read} num
6713 Reads and displays active stm32 option bytes loaded during POR
6714 or upon executing the @command{stm32f1x options_load} command.
6715 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6716 @end deffn
6717
6718 @deffn Command {stm32f1x options_write} num (@option{SWWDG}|@option{HWWDG}) (@option{RSTSTNDBY}|@option{NORSTSTNDBY}) (@option{RSTSTOP}|@option{NORSTSTOP}) (@option{USEROPT} user_data)
6719 Writes the stm32 option byte with the specified values.
6720 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6721 The @var{user_data} parameter is content of higher 16 bits of the option byte register (Data0 and Data1 as one 16bit number).
6722 @end deffn
6723
6724 @deffn Command {stm32f1x options_load} num
6725 Generates a special kind of reset to re-load the stm32 option bytes written
6726 by the @command{stm32f1x options_write} or @command{flash protect} commands
6727 without having to power cycle the target. Not applicable to stm32f1x devices.
6728 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6729 @end deffn
6730 @end deffn
6731
6732 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32f2x
6733 All members of the STM32F2, STM32F4 and STM32F7 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
6734 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3/M4/M7 cores.
6735 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6736 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6737
6738 @example
6739 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6740 @end example
6741
6742 If you use OTP (One-Time Programmable) memory define it as a second bank
6743 as per the following example.
6744 @example
6745 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0x1FFF7800 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6746 @end example
6747
6748 @deffn Command {stm32f2x otp } num (@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{show})
6749 Enables or disables OTP write commands for bank @var{num}.
6750 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6751 @end deffn
6752
6753 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
6754 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
6755 the flash driver.
6756
6757 @example
6758 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6759 @end example
6760
6761 Some stm32f2x-specific commands are defined:
6762
6763 @deffn Command {stm32f2x lock} num
6764 Locks the entire stm32 device.
6765 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6766 @end deffn
6767
6768 @deffn Command {stm32f2x unlock} num
6769 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
6770 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6771 @end deffn
6772
6773 @deffn Command {stm32f2x mass_erase} num
6774 Mass erases the entire stm32f2x device.
6775 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6776 @end deffn
6777
6778 @deffn Command {stm32f2x options_read} num
6779 Reads and displays user options and (where implemented) boot_addr0, boot_addr1, optcr2.
6780 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6781 @end deffn
6782
6783 @deffn Command {stm32f2x options_write} num user_options boot_addr0 boot_addr1
6784 Writes user options and (where implemented) boot_addr0 and boot_addr1 in raw format.
6785 Warning: The meaning of the various bits depends on the device, always check datasheet!
6786 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{user_options} a
6787 12 bit value, consisting of bits 31-28 and 7-0 of FLASH_OPTCR, @var{boot_addr0} and
6788 @var{boot_addr1} two halfwords (of FLASH_OPTCR1).
6789 @end deffn
6790
6791 @deffn Command {stm32f2x optcr2_write} num optcr2
6792 Writes FLASH_OPTCR2 options. Warning: Clearing PCROPi bits requires a full mass erase!
6793 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{optcr2} a 32-bit word.
6794 @end deffn
6795 @end deffn
6796
6797 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32h7x
6798 All members of the STM32H7 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
6799 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M7 core.
6800 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6801 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6802
6803 @example
6804 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32h7x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6805 @end example
6806
6807 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
6808 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
6809 the flash driver.
6810
6811 @example
6812 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32h7x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6813 @end example
6814
6815 Some stm32h7x-specific commands are defined:
6816
6817 @deffn Command {stm32h7x lock} num
6818 Locks the entire stm32 device.
6819 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6820 @end deffn
6821
6822 @deffn Command {stm32h7x unlock} num
6823 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
6824 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6825 @end deffn
6826
6827 @deffn Command {stm32h7x mass_erase} num
6828 Mass erases the entire stm32h7x device.
6829 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6830 @end deffn
6831
6832 @deffn Command {stm32h7x option_read} num reg_offset
6833 Reads an option byte register from the stm32h7x device.
6834 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
6835 is the register offset of the option byte to read from the used bank registers' base.
6836 For example: in STM32H74x/H75x the bank 1 registers' base is 0x52002000 and 0x52002100 for bank 2.
6837
6838 Example usage:
6839 @example
6840 # read OPTSR_CUR
6841 stm32h7x option_read 0 0x1c
6842 # read WPSN_CUR1R
6843 stm32h7x option_read 0 0x38
6844 # read WPSN_CUR2R
6845 stm32h7x option_read 1 0x38
6846 @end example
6847 @end deffn
6848
6849 @deffn Command {stm32h7x option_write} num reg_offset value [reg_mask]
6850 Writes an option byte register of the stm32h7x device.
6851 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
6852 is the register offset of the option byte to write from the used bank register base,
6853 and @var{reg_mask} is the mask to apply when writing the register (only bits with a '1'
6854 will be touched).
6855
6856 Example usage:
6857 @example
6858 # swap bank 1 and bank 2 in dual bank devices, by setting SWAP_BANK_OPT bit in OPTSR_PRG
6859 stm32h7x option_write 0 0x20 0x8000000 0x8000000
6860 @end example
6861 @end deffn
6862 @end deffn
6863
6864 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32lx
6865 All members of the STM32L0 and STM32L1 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
6866 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 and Cortex-M0+ cores.
6867 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6868 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6869
6870 @example
6871 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6872 @end example
6873
6874 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
6875 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
6876 the flash driver. If you use 0 as the bank base address, it tells the
6877 driver to autodetect the bank location assuming you're configuring the
6878 second bank.
6879
6880 @example
6881 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0x08000000 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6882 @end example
6883
6884 Some stm32lx-specific commands are defined:
6885
6886 @deffn Command {stm32lx lock} num
6887 Locks the entire stm32 device.
6888 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6889 @end deffn
6890
6891 @deffn Command {stm32lx unlock} num
6892 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
6893 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6894 @end deffn
6895
6896 @deffn Command {stm32lx mass_erase} num
6897 Mass erases the entire stm32lx device (all flash banks and EEPROM
6898 data). This is the only way to unlock a protected flash (unless RDP
6899 Level is 2 which can't be unlocked at all).
6900 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6901 @end deffn
6902 @end deffn
6903
6904 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32l4x
6905 All members of the STM32L4, STM32L4+, STM32WB, STM32WL and STM32G4
6906 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics include internal flash
6907 and use ARM Cortex-M4 cores.
6908 Additionally this driver supports STM32G0 family with ARM Cortex-M0+ core.
6909 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6910 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6911
6912 @example
6913 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6914 @end example
6915
6916 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
6917 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
6918 the flash driver. However, specifying a wrong value might lead to a completely
6919 wrong flash layout, so this feature must be used carefully.
6920
6921 @example
6922 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0x08000000 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6923 @end example
6924
6925 Some stm32l4x-specific commands are defined:
6926
6927 @deffn Command {stm32l4x lock} num
6928 Locks the entire stm32 device.
6929 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6930 @end deffn
6931
6932 @deffn Command {stm32l4x unlock} num
6933 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
6934 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6935 @end deffn
6936
6937 @deffn Command {stm32l4x mass_erase} num
6938 Mass erases the entire stm32l4x device.
6939 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6940 @end deffn
6941
6942 @deffn Command {stm32l4x option_read} num reg_offset
6943 Reads an option byte register from the stm32l4x device.
6944 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
6945 is the register offset of the Option byte to read.
6946
6947 For example to read the FLASH_OPTR register:
6948 @example
6949 stm32l4x option_read 0 0x20
6950 # Option Register (for STM32L4x): <0x40022020> = 0xffeff8aa
6951 # Option Register (for STM32WBx): <0x58004020> = ...
6952 # The correct flash base address will be used automatically
6953 @end example
6954
6955 The above example will read out the FLASH_OPTR register which contains the RDP
6956 option byte, Watchdog configuration, BOR level etc.
6957 @end deffn
6958
6959 @deffn Command {stm32l4x option_write} num reg_offset reg_mask
6960 Write an option byte register of the stm32l4x device.
6961 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
6962 is the register offset of the Option byte to write, and @var{reg_mask} is the mask
6963 to apply when writing the register (only bits with a '1' will be touched).
6964
6965 For example to write the WRP1AR option bytes:
6966 @example
6967 stm32l4x option_write 0 0x28 0x00FF0000 0x00FF00FF
6968 @end example
6969
6970 The above example will write the WRP1AR option register configuring the Write protection
6971 Area A for bank 1. The above example set WRP1AR_END=255, WRP1AR_START=0.
6972 This will effectively write protect all sectors in flash bank 1.
6973 @end deffn
6974
6975 @deffn Command {stm32l4x option_load} num
6976 Forces a re-load of the option byte registers. Will cause a system reset of the device.
6977 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6978 @end deffn
6979 @end deffn
6980
6981 @deffn {Flash Driver} str7x
6982 All members of the STR7 microcontroller family from STMicroelectronics
6983 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
6984 The @var{str7x} driver defines one mandatory parameter, @var{variant},
6985 which is either @code{STR71x}, @code{STR73x} or @code{STR75x}.
6986
6987 @example
6988 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str7x \
6989 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME STR71x
6990 @end example
6991
6992 @deffn Command {str7x disable_jtag} bank
6993 Activate the Debug/Readout protection mechanism
6994 for the specified flash bank.
6995 @end deffn
6996 @end deffn
6997
6998 @deffn {Flash Driver} str9x
6999 Most members of the STR9 microcontroller family from STMicroelectronics
7000 include internal flash and use ARM966E cores.
7001 The str9 needs the flash controller to be configured using
7002 the @command{str9x flash_config} command prior to Flash programming.
7003
7004 @example
7005 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str9x 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7006 str9x flash_config 0 4 2 0 0x80000
7007 @end example
7008
7009 @deffn Command {str9x flash_config} num bbsr nbbsr bbadr nbbadr
7010 Configures the str9 flash controller.
7011 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7012
7013 @itemize @bullet
7014 @item @var{bbsr} - Boot Bank Size register
7015 @item @var{nbbsr} - Non Boot Bank Size register
7016 @item @var{bbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
7017 @item @var{nbbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
7018 @end itemize
7019 @end deffn
7020
7021 @end deffn
7022
7023 @deffn {Flash Driver} str9xpec
7024 @cindex str9xpec
7025
7026 Only use this driver for locking/unlocking the device or configuring the option bytes.
7027 Use the standard str9 driver for programming.
7028 Before using the flash commands the turbo mode must be enabled using the
7029 @command{str9xpec enable_turbo} command.
7030
7031 Here is some background info to help
7032 you better understand how this driver works. OpenOCD has two flash drivers for
7033 the str9:
7034 @enumerate
7035 @item
7036 Standard driver @option{str9x} programmed via the str9 core. Normally used for
7037 flash programming as it is faster than the @option{str9xpec} driver.
7038 @item
7039 Direct programming @option{str9xpec} using the flash controller. This is an
7040 ISC compliant (IEEE 1532) tap connected in series with the str9 core. The str9
7041 core does not need to be running to program using this flash driver. Typical use
7042 for this driver is locking/unlocking the target and programming the option bytes.
7043 @end enumerate
7044
7045 Before we run any commands using the @option{str9xpec} driver we must first disable
7046 the str9 core. This example assumes the @option{str9xpec} driver has been
7047 configured for flash bank 0.
7048 @example
7049 # assert srst, we do not want core running
7050 # while accessing str9xpec flash driver
7051 adapter assert srst
7052 # turn off target polling
7053 poll off
7054 # disable str9 core
7055 str9xpec enable_turbo 0
7056 # read option bytes
7057 str9xpec options_read 0
7058 # re-enable str9 core
7059 str9xpec disable_turbo 0
7060 poll on
7061 reset halt
7062 @end example
7063 The above example will read the str9 option bytes.
7064 When performing a unlock remember that you will not be able to halt the str9 - it
7065 has been locked. Halting the core is not required for the @option{str9xpec} driver
7066 as mentioned above, just issue the commands above manually or from a telnet prompt.
7067
7068 Several str9xpec-specific commands are defined:
7069
7070 @deffn Command {str9xpec disable_turbo} num
7071 Restore the str9 into JTAG chain.
7072 @end deffn
7073
7074 @deffn Command {str9xpec enable_turbo} num
7075 Enable turbo mode, will simply remove the str9 from the chain and talk
7076 directly to the embedded flash controller.
7077 @end deffn
7078
7079 @deffn Command {str9xpec lock} num
7080 Lock str9 device. The str9 will only respond to an unlock command that will
7081 erase the device.
7082 @end deffn
7083
7084 @deffn Command {str9xpec part_id} num
7085 Prints the part identifier for bank @var{num}.
7086 @end deffn
7087
7088 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_cmap} num (@option{bank0}|@option{bank1})
7089 Configure str9 boot bank.
7090 @end deffn
7091
7092 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdsel} num (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
7093 Configure str9 lvd source.
7094 @end deffn
7095
7096 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdthd} num (@option{2.4v}|@option{2.7v})
7097 Configure str9 lvd threshold.
7098 @end deffn
7099
7100 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdwarn} bank (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
7101 Configure str9 lvd reset warning source.
7102 @end deffn
7103
7104 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_read} num
7105 Read str9 option bytes.
7106 @end deffn
7107
7108 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_write} num
7109 Write str9 option bytes.
7110 @end deffn
7111
7112 @deffn Command {str9xpec unlock} num
7113 unlock str9 device.
7114 @end deffn
7115
7116 @end deffn
7117
7118 @deffn {Flash Driver} swm050
7119 @cindex swm050
7120 All members of the swm050 microcontroller family from Foshan Synwit Tech.
7121
7122 @example
7123 flash bank $_FLASHNAME swm050 0x0 0x2000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7124 @end example
7125
7126 One swm050-specific command is defined:
7127
7128 @deffn Command {swm050 mass_erase} bank_id
7129 Erases the entire flash bank.
7130 @end deffn
7131
7132 @end deffn
7133
7134
7135 @deffn {Flash Driver} tms470
7136 Most members of the TMS470 microcontroller family from Texas Instruments
7137 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
7138 This driver doesn't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
7139
7140 Some tms470-specific commands are defined:
7141
7142 @deffn Command {tms470 flash_keyset} key0 key1 key2 key3
7143 Saves programming keys in a register, to enable flash erase and write commands.
7144 @end deffn
7145
7146 @deffn Command {tms470 osc_mhz} clock_mhz
7147 Reports the clock speed, which is used to calculate timings.
7148 @end deffn
7149
7150 @deffn Command {tms470 plldis} (0|1)
7151 Disables (@var{1}) or enables (@var{0}) use of the PLL to speed up
7152 the flash clock.
7153 @end deffn
7154 @end deffn
7155
7156 @deffn {Flash Driver} w600
7157 W60x series Wi-Fi SoC from WinnerMicro
7158 are designed with ARM Cortex-M3 and have 1M Byte QFLASH inside.
7159 The @var{w600} driver uses the @var{target} parameter to select the
7160 correct bank config.
7161
7162 @example
7163 flash bank $_FLASHNAME w600 0x08000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAMEs
7164 @end example
7165 @end deffn
7166
7167 @deffn {Flash Driver} xmc1xxx
7168 All members of the XMC1xxx microcontroller family from Infineon.
7169 This driver does not require the chip and bus width to be specified.
7170 @end deffn
7171
7172 @deffn {Flash Driver} xmc4xxx
7173 All members of the XMC4xxx microcontroller family from Infineon.
7174 This driver does not require the chip and bus width to be specified.
7175
7176 Some xmc4xxx-specific commands are defined:
7177
7178 @deffn Command {xmc4xxx flash_password} bank_id passwd1 passwd2
7179 Saves flash protection passwords which are used to lock the user flash
7180 @end deffn
7181
7182 @deffn Command {xmc4xxx flash_unprotect} bank_id user_level[0-1]
7183 Removes Flash write protection from the selected user bank
7184 @end deffn
7185
7186 @end deffn
7187
7188 @section NAND Flash Commands
7189 @cindex NAND
7190
7191 Compared to NOR or SPI flash, NAND devices are inexpensive
7192 and high density. Today's NAND chips, and multi-chip modules,
7193 commonly hold multiple GigaBytes of data.
7194
7195 NAND chips consist of a number of ``erase blocks'' of a given
7196 size (such as 128 KBytes), each of which is divided into a
7197 number of pages (of perhaps 512 or 2048 bytes each). Each
7198 page of a NAND flash has an ``out of band'' (OOB) area to hold
7199 Error Correcting Code (ECC) and other metadata, usually 16 bytes
7200 of OOB for every 512 bytes of page data.
7201
7202 One key characteristic of NAND flash is that its error rate
7203 is higher than that of NOR flash. In normal operation, that
7204 ECC is used to correct and detect errors. However, NAND
7205 blocks can also wear out and become unusable; those blocks
7206 are then marked "bad". NAND chips are even shipped from the
7207 manufacturer with a few bad blocks. The highest density chips
7208 use a technology (MLC) that wears out more quickly, so ECC
7209 support is increasingly important as a way to detect blocks
7210 that have begun to fail, and help to preserve data integrity
7211 with techniques such as wear leveling.
7212
7213 Software is used to manage the ECC. Some controllers don't
7214 support ECC directly; in those cases, software ECC is used.
7215 Other controllers speed up the ECC calculations with hardware.
7216 Single-bit error correction hardware is routine. Controllers
7217 geared for newer MLC chips may correct 4 or more errors for
7218 every 512 bytes of data.
7219
7220 You will need to make sure that any data you write using
7221 OpenOCD includes the appropriate kind of ECC. For example,
7222 that may mean passing the @code{oob_softecc} flag when
7223 writing NAND data, or ensuring that the correct hardware
7224 ECC mode is used.
7225
7226 The basic steps for using NAND devices include:
7227 @enumerate
7228 @item Declare via the command @command{nand device}
7229 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
7230 passing parameters as needed by the controller.
7231 @item Configure each device using @command{nand probe}.
7232 @* Do this only after the associated target is set up,
7233 such as in its reset-init script or in procures defined
7234 to access that device.
7235 @item Operate on the flash via @command{nand subcommand}
7236 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
7237 via a script in some automated way. Common task include writing a
7238 boot loader, operating system, or other data needed to initialize or
7239 de-brick a board.
7240 @end enumerate
7241
7242 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, the largest NAND
7243 flash fully supported by OpenOCD is 2 GiBytes (16 GiBits).
7244 This is because the variables used to hold offsets and lengths
7245 are only 32 bits wide.
7246 (Larger chips may work in some cases, unless an offset or length
7247 is larger than 0xffffffff, the largest 32-bit unsigned integer.)
7248 Some larger devices will work, since they are actually multi-chip
7249 modules with two smaller chips and individual chipselect lines.
7250
7251 @anchor{nandconfiguration}
7252 @subsection NAND Configuration Commands
7253 @cindex NAND configuration
7254
7255 NAND chips must be declared in configuration scripts,
7256 plus some additional configuration that's done after
7257 OpenOCD has initialized.
7258
7259 @deffn {Config Command} {nand device} name driver target [configparams...]
7260 Declares a NAND device, which can be read and written to
7261 after it has been configured through @command{nand probe}.
7262 In OpenOCD, devices are single chips; this is unlike some
7263 operating systems, which may manage multiple chips as if
7264 they were a single (larger) device.
7265 In some cases, configuring a device will activate extra
7266 commands; see the controller-specific documentation.
7267
7268 @b{NOTE:} This command is not available after OpenOCD
7269 initialization has completed. Use it in board specific
7270 configuration files, not interactively.
7271
7272 @itemize @bullet
7273 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the NAND bank
7274 in most other NAND commands. A number is also available.
7275 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the NAND controller driver
7276 associated with the NAND device being declared.
7277 @xref{nanddriverlist,,NAND Driver List}.
7278 @item @var{target} ... names the target used when issuing
7279 commands to the NAND controller.
7280 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
7281 @item @var{configparams} ... controllers may support, or require,
7282 additional parameters. See the controller-specific documentation
7283 for more information.
7284 @end itemize
7285 @end deffn
7286
7287 @deffn Command {nand list}
7288 Prints a summary of each device declared
7289 using @command{nand device}, numbered from zero.
7290 Note that un-probed devices show no details.
7291 @example
7292 > nand list
7293 #0: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
7294 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
7295 #1: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
7296 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
7297 >
7298 @end example
7299 @end deffn
7300
7301 @deffn Command {nand probe} num
7302 Probes the specified device to determine key characteristics
7303 like its page and block sizes, and how many blocks it has.
7304 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7305 You must (successfully) probe a device before you can use
7306 it with most other NAND commands.
7307 @end deffn
7308
7309 @subsection Erasing, Reading, Writing to NAND Flash
7310
7311 @deffn Command {nand dump} num filename offset length [oob_option]
7312 @cindex NAND reading
7313 Reads binary data from the NAND device and writes it to the file,
7314 starting at the specified offset.
7315 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7316
7317 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
7318 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
7319
7320 The @var{offset} and @var{length} must be exact multiples of the
7321 device's page size. They describe a data region; the OOB data
7322 associated with each such page may also be accessed.
7323
7324 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, no error correction
7325 was done on the data that's read, unless raw access was disabled
7326 and the underlying NAND controller driver had a @code{read_page}
7327 method which handled that error correction.
7328
7329 By default, only page data is saved to the specified file.
7330 Use an @var{oob_option} parameter to save OOB data:
7331 @itemize @bullet
7332 @item no oob_* parameter
7333 @*Output file holds only page data; OOB is discarded.
7334 @item @code{oob_raw}
7335 @*Output file interleaves page data and OOB data;
7336 the file will be longer than "length" by the size of the
7337 spare areas associated with each data page.
7338 Note that this kind of "raw" access is different from
7339 what's implied by @command{nand raw_access}, which just
7340 controls whether a hardware-aware access method is used.
7341 @item @code{oob_only}
7342 @*Output file has only raw OOB data, and will
7343 be smaller than "length" since it will contain only the
7344 spare areas associated with each data page.
7345 @end itemize
7346 @end deffn
7347
7348 @deffn Command {nand erase} num [offset length]
7349 @cindex NAND erasing
7350 @cindex NAND programming
7351 Erases blocks on the specified NAND device, starting at the
7352 specified @var{offset} and continuing for @var{length} bytes.
7353 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
7354 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
7355 If those parameters are not specified,
7356 the whole NAND chip will be erased.
7357 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7358
7359 @b{NOTE:} This command will try to erase bad blocks, when told
7360 to do so, which will probably invalidate the manufacturer's bad
7361 block marker.
7362 For the remainder of the current server session, @command{nand info}
7363 will still report that the block ``is'' bad.
7364 @end deffn
7365
7366 @deffn Command {nand write} num filename offset [option...]
7367 @cindex NAND writing
7368 @cindex NAND programming
7369 Writes binary data from the file into the specified NAND device,
7370 starting at the specified offset. Those pages should already
7371 have been erased; you can't change zero bits to one bits.
7372 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7373
7374 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
7375 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
7376
7377 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
7378 All data in the file will be written, assuming it doesn't run
7379 past the end of the device.
7380 Only full pages are written, and any extra space in the last
7381 page will be filled with 0xff bytes. (That includes OOB data,
7382 if that's being written.)
7383
7384 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, bad blocks are
7385 ignored. That is, this routine will not skip bad blocks,
7386 but will instead try to write them. This can cause problems.
7387
7388 Provide at most one @var{option} parameter. With some
7389 NAND drivers, the meanings of these parameters may change
7390 if @command{nand raw_access} was used to disable hardware ECC.
7391 @itemize @bullet
7392 @item no oob_* parameter
7393 @*File has only page data, which is written.
7394 If raw access is in use, the OOB area will not be written.
7395 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
7396 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may write the OOB
7397 with hardware-computed ECC data.
7398 @item @code{oob_only}
7399 @*File has only raw OOB data, which is written to the OOB area.
7400 Each page's data area stays untouched. @i{This can be a dangerous
7401 option}, since it can invalidate the ECC data.
7402 You may need to force raw access to use this mode.
7403 @item @code{oob_raw}
7404 @*File interleaves data and OOB data, both of which are written
7405 If raw access is enabled, the data is written first, then the
7406 un-altered OOB.
7407 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
7408 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may modify the OOB
7409 before it's written, to include hardware-computed ECC data.
7410 @item @code{oob_softecc}
7411 @*File has only page data, which is written.
7412 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a standard 1-bit
7413 software ECC code stored in conventional locations.
7414 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
7415 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
7416 @item @code{oob_softecc_kw}
7417 @*File has only page data, which is written.
7418 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a 4-bit software ECC
7419 specific to the boot ROM in Marvell Kirkwood SoCs.
7420 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
7421 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
7422 @end itemize
7423 @end deffn
7424
7425 @deffn Command {nand verify} num filename offset [option...]
7426 @cindex NAND verification
7427 @cindex NAND programming
7428 Verify the binary data in the file has been programmed to the
7429 specified NAND device, starting at the specified offset.
7430 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7431
7432 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
7433 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
7434
7435 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
7436 All data in the file will be read and compared to the contents of the
7437 flash, assuming it doesn't run past the end of the device.
7438 As with @command{nand write}, only full pages are verified, so any extra
7439 space in the last page will be filled with 0xff bytes.
7440
7441 The same @var{options} accepted by @command{nand write},
7442 and the file will be processed similarly to produce the buffers that
7443 can be compared against the contents produced from @command{nand dump}.
7444
7445 @b{NOTE:} This will not work when the underlying NAND controller
7446 driver's @code{write_page} routine must update the OOB with a
7447 hardware-computed ECC before the data is written. This limitation may
7448 be removed in a future release.
7449 @end deffn
7450
7451 @subsection Other NAND commands
7452 @cindex NAND other commands
7453
7454 @deffn Command {nand check_bad_blocks} num [offset length]
7455 Checks for manufacturer bad block markers on the specified NAND
7456 device. If no parameters are provided, checks the whole
7457 device; otherwise, starts at the specified @var{offset} and
7458 continues for @var{length} bytes.
7459 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
7460 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
7461 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7462
7463 @b{NOTE:} Before using this command you should force raw access
7464 with @command{nand raw_access enable} to ensure that the underlying
7465 driver will not try to apply hardware ECC.
7466 @end deffn
7467
7468 @deffn Command {nand info} num
7469 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7470 This prints the one-line summary from "nand list", plus for
7471 devices which have been probed this also prints any known
7472 status for each block.
7473 @end deffn
7474
7475 @deffn Command {nand raw_access} num (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
7476 Sets or clears an flag affecting how page I/O is done.
7477 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7478
7479 This flag is cleared (disabled) by default, but changing that
7480 value won't affect all NAND devices. The key factor is whether
7481 the underlying driver provides @code{read_page} or @code{write_page}
7482 methods. If it doesn't provide those methods, the setting of
7483 this flag is irrelevant; all access is effectively ``raw''.
7484
7485 When those methods exist, they are normally used when reading
7486 data (@command{nand dump} or reading bad block markers) or
7487 writing it (@command{nand write}). However, enabling
7488 raw access (setting the flag) prevents use of those methods,
7489 bypassing hardware ECC logic.
7490 @i{This can be a dangerous option}, since writing blocks
7491 with the wrong ECC data can cause them to be marked as bad.
7492 @end deffn
7493
7494 @anchor{nanddriverlist}
7495 @subsection NAND Driver List
7496 As noted above, the @command{nand device} command allows
7497 driver-specific options and behaviors.
7498 Some controllers also activate controller-specific commands.
7499
7500 @deffn {NAND Driver} at91sam9
7501 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on AT91SAM9 family chips from
7502 Atmel. It takes two extra parameters: address of the NAND chip;
7503 address of the ECC controller.
7504 @example
7505 nand device $NANDFLASH at91sam9 $CHIPNAME 0x40000000 0xfffffe800
7506 @end example
7507 AT91SAM9 chips support single-bit ECC hardware. The @code{write_page} and
7508 @code{read_page} methods are used to utilize the ECC hardware unless they are
7509 disabled by using the @command{nand raw_access} command. There are four
7510 additional commands that are needed to fully configure the AT91SAM9 NAND
7511 controller. Two are optional; most boards use the same wiring for ALE/CLE:
7512 @deffn Command {at91sam9 cle} num addr_line
7513 Configure the address line used for latching commands. The @var{num}
7514 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7515 @end deffn
7516 @deffn Command {at91sam9 ale} num addr_line
7517 Configure the address line used for latching addresses. The @var{num}
7518 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7519 @end deffn
7520
7521 For the next two commands, it is assumed that the pins have already been
7522 properly configured for input or output.
7523 @deffn Command {at91sam9 rdy_busy} num pio_base_addr pin
7524 Configure the RDY/nBUSY input from the NAND device. The @var{num}
7525 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
7526 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
7527 @end deffn
7528 @deffn Command {at91sam9 ce} num pio_base_addr pin
7529 Configure the chip enable input to the NAND device. The @var{num}
7530 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
7531 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
7532 @end deffn
7533 @end deffn
7534
7535 @deffn {NAND Driver} davinci
7536 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on DaVinci family
7537 chips from Texas Instruments.
7538 It takes three extra parameters:
7539 address of the NAND chip;
7540 hardware ECC mode to use (@option{hwecc1},
7541 @option{hwecc4}, @option{hwecc4_infix});
7542 address of the AEMIF controller on this processor.
7543 @example
7544 nand device davinci dm355.arm 0x02000000 hwecc4 0x01e10000
7545 @end example
7546 All DaVinci processors support the single-bit ECC hardware,
7547 and newer ones also support the four-bit ECC hardware.
7548 The @code{write_page} and @code{read_page} methods are used
7549 to implement those ECC modes, unless they are disabled using
7550 the @command{nand raw_access} command.
7551 @end deffn
7552
7553 @deffn {NAND Driver} lpc3180
7554 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
7555 parameter: the clock rate used by the controller.
7556 @deffn Command {lpc3180 select} num [mlc|slc]
7557 Configures use of the MLC or SLC controller mode.
7558 MLC implies use of hardware ECC.
7559 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7560 @end deffn
7561
7562 At this writing, this driver includes @code{write_page}
7563 and @code{read_page} methods. Using @command{nand raw_access}
7564 to disable those methods will prevent use of hardware ECC
7565 in the MLC controller mode, but won't change SLC behavior.
7566 @end deffn
7567 @comment current lpc3180 code won't issue 5-byte address cycles
7568
7569 @deffn {NAND Driver} mx3
7570 This driver handles the NAND controller in i.MX31. The mxc driver
7571 should work for this chip as well.
7572 @end deffn
7573
7574 @deffn {NAND Driver} mxc
7575 This driver handles the NAND controller found in Freescale i.MX
7576 chips. It has support for v1 (i.MX27 and i.MX31) and v2 (i.MX35).
7577 The driver takes 3 extra arguments, chip (@option{mx27},
7578 @option{mx31}, @option{mx35}), ecc (@option{noecc}, @option{hwecc})
7579 and optionally if bad block information should be swapped between
7580 main area and spare area (@option{biswap}), defaults to off.
7581 @example
7582 nand device mx35.nand mxc imx35.cpu mx35 hwecc biswap
7583 @end example
7584 @deffn Command {mxc biswap} bank_num [enable|disable]
7585 Turns on/off bad block information swapping from main area,
7586 without parameter query status.
7587 @end deffn
7588 @end deffn
7589
7590 @deffn {NAND Driver} orion
7591 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
7592 parameter: the address of the controller.
7593 @example
7594 nand device orion 0xd8000000
7595 @end example
7596 These controllers don't define any specialized commands.
7597 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
7598 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
7599 change any behavior.
7600 @end deffn
7601
7602 @deffn {NAND Driver} s3c2410
7603 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2412
7604 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2440
7605 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2443
7606 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c6400
7607 These S3C family controllers don't have any special
7608 @command{nand device} options, and don't define any
7609 specialized commands.
7610 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
7611 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
7612 change any behavior.
7613 @end deffn
7614
7615 @node Flash Programming
7616 @chapter Flash Programming
7617
7618 OpenOCD implements numerous ways to program the target flash, whether internal or external.
7619 Programming can be achieved by either using @ref{programmingusinggdb,,Programming using GDB},
7620 or using the commands given in @ref{flashprogrammingcommands,,Flash Programming Commands}.
7621
7622 @*To simplify using the flash commands directly a jimtcl script is available that handles the programming and verify stage.
7623 OpenOCD will program/verify/reset the target and optionally shutdown.
7624
7625 The script is executed as follows and by default the following actions will be performed.
7626 @enumerate
7627 @item 'init' is executed.
7628 @item 'reset init' is called to reset and halt the target, any 'reset init' scripts are executed.
7629 @item @code{flash write_image} is called to erase and write any flash using the filename given.
7630 @item If the @option{preverify} parameter is given, the target is "verified" first and only flashed if this fails.
7631 @item @code{verify_image} is called if @option{verify} parameter is given.
7632 @item @code{reset run} is called if @option{reset} parameter is given.
7633 @item OpenOCD is shutdown if @option{exit} parameter is given.
7634 @end enumerate
7635
7636 An example of usage is given below. @xref{program}.
7637
7638 @example
7639 # program and verify using elf/hex/s19. verify and reset
7640 # are optional parameters
7641 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
7642 -c "program filename.elf verify reset exit"
7643
7644 # binary files need the flash address passing
7645 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
7646 -c "program filename.bin exit 0x08000000"
7647 @end example
7648
7649 @node PLD/FPGA Commands
7650 @chapter PLD/FPGA Commands
7651 @cindex PLD
7652 @cindex FPGA
7653
7654 Programmable Logic Devices (PLDs) and the more flexible
7655 Field Programmable Gate Arrays (FPGAs) are both types of programmable hardware.
7656 OpenOCD can support programming them.
7657 Although PLDs are generally restrictive (cells are less functional, and
7658 there are no special purpose cells for memory or computational tasks),
7659 they share the same OpenOCD infrastructure.
7660 Accordingly, both are called PLDs here.
7661
7662 @section PLD/FPGA Configuration and Commands
7663
7664 As it does for JTAG TAPs, debug targets, and flash chips (both NOR and NAND),
7665 OpenOCD maintains a list of PLDs available for use in various commands.
7666 Also, each such PLD requires a driver.
7667
7668 They are referenced by the number shown by the @command{pld devices} command,
7669 and new PLDs are defined by @command{pld device driver_name}.
7670
7671 @deffn {Config Command} {pld device} driver_name tap_name [driver_options]
7672 Defines a new PLD device, supported by driver @var{driver_name},
7673 using the TAP named @var{tap_name}.
7674 The driver may make use of any @var{driver_options} to configure its
7675 behavior.
7676 @end deffn
7677
7678 @deffn {Command} {pld devices}
7679 Lists the PLDs and their numbers.
7680 @end deffn
7681
7682 @deffn {Command} {pld load} num filename
7683 Loads the file @file{filename} into the PLD identified by @var{num}.
7684 The file format must be inferred by the driver.
7685 @end deffn
7686
7687 @section PLD/FPGA Drivers, Options, and Commands
7688
7689 Drivers may support PLD-specific options to the @command{pld device}
7690 definition command, and may also define commands usable only with
7691 that particular type of PLD.
7692
7693 @deffn {FPGA Driver} virtex2 [no_jstart]
7694 Virtex-II is a family of FPGAs sold by Xilinx.
7695 It supports the IEEE 1532 standard for In-System Configuration (ISC).
7696
7697 If @var{no_jstart} is non-zero, the JSTART instruction is not used after
7698 loading the bitstream. While required for Series2, Series3, and Series6, it
7699 breaks bitstream loading on Series7.
7700
7701 @deffn {Command} {virtex2 read_stat} num
7702 Reads and displays the Virtex-II status register (STAT)
7703 for FPGA @var{num}.
7704 @end deffn
7705 @end deffn
7706
7707 @node General Commands
7708 @chapter General Commands
7709 @cindex commands
7710
7711 The commands documented in this chapter here are common commands that
7712 you, as a human, may want to type and see the output of. Configuration type
7713 commands are documented elsewhere.
7714
7715 Intent:
7716 @itemize @bullet
7717 @item @b{Source Of Commands}
7718 @* OpenOCD commands can occur in a configuration script (discussed
7719 elsewhere) or typed manually by a human or supplied programmatically,
7720 or via one of several TCP/IP Ports.
7721
7722 @item @b{From the human}
7723 @* A human should interact with the telnet interface (default port: 4444)
7724 or via GDB (default port 3333).
7725
7726 To issue commands from within a GDB session, use the @option{monitor}
7727 command, e.g. use @option{monitor poll} to issue the @option{poll}
7728 command. All output is relayed through the GDB session.
7729
7730 @item @b{Machine Interface}
7731 The Tcl interface's intent is to be a machine interface. The default Tcl
7732 port is 5555.
7733 @end itemize
7734
7735
7736 @section Server Commands
7737
7738 @deffn {Command} exit
7739 Exits the current telnet session.
7740 @end deffn
7741
7742 @deffn {Command} help [string]
7743 With no parameters, prints help text for all commands.
7744 Otherwise, prints each helptext containing @var{string}.
7745 Not every command provides helptext.
7746
7747 Configuration commands, and commands valid at any time, are
7748 explicitly noted in parenthesis.
7749 In most cases, no such restriction is listed; this indicates commands
7750 which are only available after the configuration stage has completed.
7751 @end deffn
7752
7753 @deffn Command sleep msec [@option{busy}]
7754 Wait for at least @var{msec} milliseconds before resuming.
7755 If @option{busy} is passed, busy-wait instead of sleeping.
7756 (This option is strongly discouraged.)
7757 Useful in connection with script files
7758 (@command{script} command and @command{target_name} configuration).
7759 @end deffn
7760
7761 @deffn Command shutdown [@option{error}]
7762 Close the OpenOCD server, disconnecting all clients (GDB, telnet,
7763 other). If option @option{error} is used, OpenOCD will return a
7764 non-zero exit code to the parent process.
7765
7766 Like any TCL commands, also @command{shutdown} can be redefined, e.g.:
7767 @example
7768 # redefine shutdown
7769 rename shutdown original_shutdown
7770 proc shutdown @{@} @{
7771 puts "This is my implementation of shutdown"
7772 # my own stuff before exit OpenOCD
7773 original_shutdown
7774 @}
7775 @end example
7776 If user types CTRL-C or kills OpenOCD, either the command @command{shutdown}
7777 or its replacement will be automatically executed before OpenOCD exits.
7778 @end deffn
7779
7780 @anchor{debuglevel}
7781 @deffn Command debug_level [n]
7782 @cindex message level
7783 Display debug level.
7784 If @var{n} (from 0..4) is provided, then set it to that level.
7785 This affects the kind of messages sent to the server log.
7786 Level 0 is error messages only;
7787 level 1 adds warnings;
7788 level 2 adds informational messages;
7789 level 3 adds debugging messages;
7790 and level 4 adds verbose low-level debug messages.
7791 The default is level 2, but that can be overridden on
7792 the command line along with the location of that log
7793 file (which is normally the server's standard output).
7794 @xref{Running}.
7795 @end deffn
7796
7797 @deffn Command echo [-n] message
7798 Logs a message at "user" priority.
7799 Output @var{message} to stdout.
7800 Option "-n" suppresses trailing newline.
7801 @example
7802 echo "Downloading kernel -- please wait"
7803 @end example
7804 @end deffn
7805
7806 @deffn Command log_output [filename | "default"]
7807 Redirect logging to @var{filename} or set it back to default output;
7808 the default log output channel is stderr.
7809 @end deffn
7810
7811 @deffn Command add_script_search_dir [directory]
7812 Add @var{directory} to the file/script search path.
7813 @end deffn
7814
7815 @deffn Command bindto [@var{name}]
7816 Specify hostname or IPv4 address on which to listen for incoming
7817 TCP/IP connections. By default, OpenOCD will listen on the loopback
7818 interface only. If your network environment is safe, @code{bindto
7819 0.0.0.0} can be used to cover all available interfaces.
7820 @end deffn
7821
7822 @anchor{targetstatehandling}
7823 @section Target State handling
7824 @cindex reset
7825 @cindex halt
7826 @cindex target initialization
7827
7828 In this section ``target'' refers to a CPU configured as
7829 shown earlier (@pxref{CPU Configuration}).
7830 These commands, like many, implicitly refer to
7831 a current target which is used to perform the
7832 various operations. The current target may be changed
7833 by using @command{targets} command with the name of the
7834 target which should become current.
7835
7836 @deffn Command reg [(number|name) [(value|'force')]]
7837 Access a single register by @var{number} or by its @var{name}.
7838 The target must generally be halted before access to CPU core
7839 registers is allowed. Depending on the hardware, some other
7840 registers may be accessible while the target is running.
7841
7842 @emph{With no arguments}:
7843 list all available registers for the current target,
7844 showing number, name, size, value, and cache status.
7845 For valid entries, a value is shown; valid entries
7846 which are also dirty (and will be written back later)
7847 are flagged as such.
7848
7849 @emph{With number/name}: display that register's value.
7850 Use @var{force} argument to read directly from the target,
7851 bypassing any internal cache.
7852
7853 @emph{With both number/name and value}: set register's value.
7854 Writes may be held in a writeback cache internal to OpenOCD,
7855 so that setting the value marks the register as dirty instead
7856 of immediately flushing that value. Resuming CPU execution
7857 (including by single stepping) or otherwise activating the
7858 relevant module will flush such values.
7859
7860 Cores may have surprisingly many registers in their
7861 Debug and trace infrastructure:
7862
7863 @example
7864 > reg
7865 ===== ARM registers
7866 (0) r0 (/32): 0x0000D3C2 (dirty)
7867 (1) r1 (/32): 0xFD61F31C
7868 (2) r2 (/32)
7869 ...
7870 (164) ETM_contextid_comparator_mask (/32)
7871 >
7872 @end example
7873 @end deffn
7874
7875 @deffn Command halt [ms]
7876 @deffnx Command wait_halt [ms]
7877 The @command{halt} command first sends a halt request to the target,
7878 which @command{wait_halt} doesn't.
7879 Otherwise these behave the same: wait up to @var{ms} milliseconds,
7880 or 5 seconds if there is no parameter, for the target to halt
7881 (and enter debug mode).
7882 Using 0 as the @var{ms} parameter prevents OpenOCD from waiting.
7883
7884 @quotation Warning
7885 On ARM cores, software using the @emph{wait for interrupt} operation
7886 often blocks the JTAG access needed by a @command{halt} command.
7887 This is because that operation also puts the core into a low
7888 power mode by gating the core clock;
7889 but the core clock is needed to detect JTAG clock transitions.
7890
7891 One partial workaround uses adaptive clocking: when the core is
7892 interrupted the operation completes, then JTAG clocks are accepted
7893 at least until the interrupt handler completes.
7894 However, this workaround is often unusable since the processor, board,
7895 and JTAG adapter must all support adaptive JTAG clocking.
7896 Also, it can't work until an interrupt is issued.
7897
7898 A more complete workaround is to not use that operation while you
7899 work with a JTAG debugger.
7900 Tasking environments generally have idle loops where the body is the
7901 @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
7902 (On older cores, it is a coprocessor action;
7903 newer cores have a @option{wfi} instruction.)
7904 Such loops can just remove that operation, at the cost of higher
7905 power consumption (because the CPU is needlessly clocked).
7906 @end quotation
7907
7908 @end deffn
7909
7910 @deffn Command resume [address]
7911 Resume the target at its current code position,
7912 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
7913 OpenOCD will wait 5 seconds for the target to resume.
7914 @end deffn
7915
7916 @deffn Command step [address]
7917 Single-step the target at its current code position,
7918 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
7919 @end deffn
7920
7921 @anchor{resetcommand}
7922 @deffn Command reset
7923 @deffnx Command {reset run}
7924 @deffnx Command {reset halt}
7925 @deffnx Command {reset init}
7926 Perform as hard a reset as possible, using SRST if possible.
7927 @emph{All defined targets will be reset, and target
7928 events will fire during the reset sequence.}
7929
7930 The optional parameter specifies what should
7931 happen after the reset.
7932 If there is no parameter, a @command{reset run} is executed.
7933 The other options will not work on all systems.
7934 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
7935
7936 @itemize @minus
7937 @item @b{run} Let the target run
7938 @item @b{halt} Immediately halt the target
7939 @item @b{init} Immediately halt the target, and execute the reset-init script
7940 @end itemize
7941 @end deffn
7942
7943 @deffn Command soft_reset_halt
7944 Requesting target halt and executing a soft reset. This is often used
7945 when a target cannot be reset and halted. The target, after reset is
7946 released begins to execute code. OpenOCD attempts to stop the CPU and
7947 then sets the program counter back to the reset vector. Unfortunately
7948 the code that was executed may have left the hardware in an unknown
7949 state.
7950 @end deffn
7951
7952 @deffn Command {adapter assert} [signal [assert|deassert signal]]
7953 @deffnx Command {adapter deassert} [signal [assert|deassert signal]]
7954 Set values of reset signals.
7955 Without parameters returns current status of the signals.
7956 The @var{signal} parameter values may be
7957 @option{srst}, indicating that srst signal is to be asserted or deasserted,
7958 @option{trst}, indicating that trst signal is to be asserted or deasserted.
7959
7960 The @command{reset_config} command should already have been used
7961 to configure how the board and the adapter treat these two
7962 signals, and to say if either signal is even present.
7963 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
7964 Trying to assert a signal that is not present triggers an error.
7965 If a signal is present on the adapter and not specified in the command,
7966 the signal will not be modified.
7967
7968 @quotation Note
7969 TRST is specially handled.
7970 It actually signifies JTAG's @sc{reset} state.
7971 So if the board doesn't support the optional TRST signal,
7972 or it doesn't support it along with the specified SRST value,
7973 JTAG reset is triggered with TMS and TCK signals
7974 instead of the TRST signal.
7975 And no matter how that JTAG reset is triggered, once
7976 the scan chain enters @sc{reset} with TRST inactive,
7977 TAP @code{post-reset} events are delivered to all TAPs
7978 with handlers for that event.
7979 @end quotation
7980 @end deffn
7981
7982 @section I/O Utilities
7983
7984 These commands are available when
7985 OpenOCD is built with @option{--enable-ioutil}.
7986 They are mainly useful on embedded targets,
7987 notably the ZY1000.
7988 Hosts with operating systems have complementary tools.
7989
7990 @emph{Note:} there are several more such commands.
7991
7992 @deffn Command append_file filename [string]*
7993 Appends the @var{string} parameters to
7994 the text file @file{filename}.
7995 Each string except the last one is followed by one space.
7996 The last string is followed by a newline.
7997 @end deffn
7998
7999 @deffn Command cat filename
8000 Reads and displays the text file @file{filename}.
8001 @end deffn
8002
8003 @deffn Command cp src_filename dest_filename
8004 Copies contents from the file @file{src_filename}
8005 into @file{dest_filename}.
8006 @end deffn
8007
8008 @deffn Command ip
8009 @emph{No description provided.}
8010 @end deffn
8011
8012 @deffn Command ls
8013 @emph{No description provided.}
8014 @end deffn
8015
8016 @deffn Command mac
8017 @emph{No description provided.}
8018 @end deffn
8019
8020 @deffn Command meminfo
8021 Display available RAM memory on OpenOCD host.
8022 Used in OpenOCD regression testing scripts.
8023 @end deffn
8024
8025 @deffn Command peek
8026 @emph{No description provided.}
8027 @end deffn
8028
8029 @deffn Command poke
8030 @emph{No description provided.}
8031 @end deffn
8032
8033 @deffn Command rm filename
8034 @c "rm" has both normal and Jim-level versions??
8035 Unlinks the file @file{filename}.
8036 @end deffn
8037
8038 @deffn Command trunc filename
8039 Removes all data in the file @file{filename}.
8040 @end deffn
8041
8042 @anchor{memoryaccess}
8043 @section Memory access commands
8044 @cindex memory access
8045
8046 These commands allow accesses of a specific size to the memory
8047 system. Often these are used to configure the current target in some
8048 special way. For example - one may need to write certain values to the
8049 SDRAM controller to enable SDRAM.
8050
8051 @enumerate
8052 @item Use the @command{targets} (plural) command
8053 to change the current target.
8054 @item In system level scripts these commands are deprecated.
8055 Please use their TARGET object siblings to avoid making assumptions
8056 about what TAP is the current target, or about MMU configuration.
8057 @end enumerate
8058
8059 @deffn Command mdd [phys] addr [count]
8060 @deffnx Command mdw [phys] addr [count]
8061 @deffnx Command mdh [phys] addr [count]
8062 @deffnx Command mdb [phys] addr [count]
8063 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
8064 64-bit doublewords (@command{mdd}),
8065 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
8066 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
8067 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
8068 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
8069 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
8070 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
8071 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
8072 (If you want to manipulate the data instead of displaying it,
8073 see the @code{mem2array} primitives.)
8074 @end deffn
8075
8076 @deffn Command mwd [phys] addr doubleword [count]
8077 @deffnx Command mww [phys] addr word [count]
8078 @deffnx Command mwh [phys] addr halfword [count]
8079 @deffnx Command mwb [phys] addr byte [count]
8080 Writes the specified @var{doubleword} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
8081 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) value,
8082 at the specified address @var{addr}.
8083 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
8084 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
8085 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
8086 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
8087 If @var{count} is specified, fills that many units of consecutive address.
8088 @end deffn
8089
8090 @anchor{imageaccess}
8091 @section Image loading commands
8092 @cindex image loading
8093 @cindex image dumping
8094
8095 @deffn Command {dump_image} filename address size
8096 Dump @var{size} bytes of target memory starting at @var{address} to the
8097 binary file named @var{filename}.
8098 @end deffn
8099
8100 @deffn Command {fast_load}
8101 Loads an image stored in memory by @command{fast_load_image} to the
8102 current target. Must be preceded by fast_load_image.
8103 @end deffn
8104
8105 @deffn Command {fast_load_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}]
8106 Normally you should be using @command{load_image} or GDB load. However, for
8107 testing purposes or when I/O overhead is significant(OpenOCD running on an embedded
8108 host), storing the image in memory and uploading the image to the target
8109 can be a way to upload e.g. multiple debug sessions when the binary does not change.
8110 Arguments are the same as @command{load_image}, but the image is stored in OpenOCD host
8111 memory, i.e. does not affect target. This approach is also useful when profiling
8112 target programming performance as I/O and target programming can easily be profiled
8113 separately.
8114 @end deffn
8115
8116 @deffn Command {load_image} filename address [[@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}] @option{min_addr} @option{max_length}]
8117 Load image from file @var{filename} to target memory offset by @var{address} from its load address.
8118 The file format may optionally be specified
8119 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, @option{elf}, or @option{s19}).
8120 In addition the following arguments may be specified:
8121 @var{min_addr} - ignore data below @var{min_addr} (this is w.r.t. to the target's load address + @var{address})
8122 @var{max_length} - maximum number of bytes to load.
8123 @example
8124 proc load_image_bin @{fname foffset address length @} @{
8125 # Load data from fname filename at foffset offset to
8126 # target at address. Load at most length bytes.
8127 load_image $fname [expr $address - $foffset] bin \
8128 $address $length
8129 @}
8130 @end example
8131 @end deffn
8132
8133 @deffn Command {test_image} filename [address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]]
8134 Displays image section sizes and addresses
8135 as if @var{filename} were loaded into target memory
8136 starting at @var{address} (defaults to zero).
8137 The file format may optionally be specified
8138 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
8139 @end deffn
8140
8141 @deffn Command {verify_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
8142 Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
8143 The file format may optionally be specified
8144 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
8145 This will first attempt a comparison using a CRC checksum, if this fails it will try a binary compare.
8146 @end deffn
8147
8148 @deffn Command {verify_image_checksum} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
8149 Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
8150 The file format may optionally be specified
8151 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
8152 This perform a comparison using a CRC checksum only
8153 @end deffn
8154
8155
8156 @section Breakpoint and Watchpoint commands
8157 @cindex breakpoint
8158 @cindex watchpoint
8159
8160 CPUs often make debug modules accessible through JTAG, with
8161 hardware support for a handful of code breakpoints and data
8162 watchpoints.
8163 In addition, CPUs almost always support software breakpoints.
8164
8165 @deffn Command {bp} [address len [@option{hw}]]
8166 With no parameters, lists all active breakpoints.
8167 Else sets a breakpoint on code execution starting
8168 at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
8169 This is a software breakpoint, unless @option{hw} is specified
8170 in which case it will be a hardware breakpoint.
8171
8172 (@xref{arm9vectorcatch,,arm9 vector_catch}, or @pxref{xscalevectorcatch,,xscale vector_catch},
8173 for similar mechanisms that do not consume hardware breakpoints.)
8174 @end deffn
8175
8176 @deffn Command {rbp} @option{all} | address
8177 Remove the breakpoint at @var{address} or all breakpoints.
8178 @end deffn
8179
8180 @deffn Command {rwp} address
8181 Remove data watchpoint on @var{address}
8182 @end deffn
8183
8184 @deffn Command {wp} [address len [(@option{r}|@option{w}|@option{a}) [value [mask]]]]
8185 With no parameters, lists all active watchpoints.
8186 Else sets a data watchpoint on data from @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
8187 The watch point is an "access" watchpoint unless
8188 the @option{r} or @option{w} parameter is provided,
8189 defining it as respectively a read or write watchpoint.
8190 If a @var{value} is provided, that value is used when determining if
8191 the watchpoint should trigger. The value may be first be masked
8192 using @var{mask} to mark ``don't care'' fields.
8193 @end deffn
8194
8195 @section Misc Commands
8196
8197 @cindex profiling
8198 @deffn Command {profile} seconds filename [start end]
8199 Profiling samples the CPU's program counter as quickly as possible,
8200 which is useful for non-intrusive stochastic profiling.
8201 Saves up to 10000 samples in @file{filename} using ``gmon.out''
8202 format. Optional @option{start} and @option{end} parameters allow to
8203 limit the address range.
8204 @end deffn
8205
8206 @deffn Command {version}
8207 Displays a string identifying the version of this OpenOCD server.
8208 @end deffn
8209
8210 @deffn Command {virt2phys} virtual_address
8211 Requests the current target to map the specified @var{virtual_address}
8212 to its corresponding physical address, and displays the result.
8213 @end deffn
8214
8215 @node Architecture and Core Commands
8216 @chapter Architecture and Core Commands
8217 @cindex Architecture Specific Commands
8218 @cindex Core Specific Commands
8219
8220 Most CPUs have specialized JTAG operations to support debugging.
8221 OpenOCD packages most such operations in its standard command framework.
8222 Some of those operations don't fit well in that framework, so they are
8223 exposed here as architecture or implementation (core) specific commands.
8224
8225 @anchor{armhardwaretracing}
8226 @section ARM Hardware Tracing
8227 @cindex tracing
8228 @cindex ETM
8229 @cindex ETB
8230
8231 CPUs based on ARM cores may include standard tracing interfaces,
8232 based on an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM) which sends voluminous
8233 address and data bus trace records to a ``Trace Port''.
8234
8235 @itemize
8236 @item
8237 Development-oriented boards will sometimes provide a high speed
8238 trace connector for collecting that data, when the particular CPU
8239 supports such an interface.
8240 (The standard connector is a 38-pin Mictor, with both JTAG
8241 and trace port support.)
8242 Those trace connectors are supported by higher end JTAG adapters
8243 and some logic analyzer modules; frequently those modules can
8244 buffer several megabytes of trace data.
8245 Configuring an ETM coupled to such an external trace port belongs
8246 in the board-specific configuration file.
8247 @item
8248 If the CPU doesn't provide an external interface, it probably
8249 has an ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB) on the chip, which is a
8250 dedicated SRAM. 4KBytes is one common ETB size.
8251 Configuring an ETM coupled only to an ETB belongs in the CPU-specific
8252 (target) configuration file, since it works the same on all boards.
8253 @end itemize
8254
8255 ETM support in OpenOCD doesn't seem to be widely used yet.
8256
8257 @quotation Issues
8258 ETM support may be buggy, and at least some @command{etm config}
8259 parameters should be detected by asking the ETM for them.
8260
8261 ETM trigger events could also implement a kind of complex
8262 hardware breakpoint, much more powerful than the simple
8263 watchpoint hardware exported by EmbeddedICE modules.
8264 @emph{Such breakpoints can be triggered even when using the
8265 dummy trace port driver}.
8266
8267 It seems like a GDB hookup should be possible,
8268 as well as tracing only during specific states
8269 (perhaps @emph{handling IRQ 23} or @emph{calls foo()}).
8270
8271 There should be GUI tools to manipulate saved trace data and help
8272 analyse it in conjunction with the source code.
8273 It's unclear how much of a common interface is shared
8274 with the current XScale trace support, or should be
8275 shared with eventual Nexus-style trace module support.
8276
8277 At this writing (November 2009) only ARM7, ARM9, and ARM11 support
8278 for ETM modules is available. The code should be able to
8279 work with some newer cores; but not all of them support
8280 this original style of JTAG access.
8281 @end quotation
8282
8283 @subsection ETM Configuration
8284 ETM setup is coupled with the trace port driver configuration.
8285
8286 @deffn {Config Command} {etm config} target width mode clocking driver
8287 Declares the ETM associated with @var{target}, and associates it
8288 with a given trace port @var{driver}. @xref{traceportdrivers,,Trace Port Drivers}.
8289
8290 Several of the parameters must reflect the trace port capabilities,
8291 which are a function of silicon capabilities (exposed later
8292 using @command{etm info}) and of what hardware is connected to
8293 that port (such as an external pod, or ETB).
8294 The @var{width} must be either 4, 8, or 16,
8295 except with ETMv3.0 and newer modules which may also
8296 support 1, 2, 24, 32, 48, and 64 bit widths.
8297 (With those versions, @command{etm info} also shows whether
8298 the selected port width and mode are supported.)
8299
8300 The @var{mode} must be @option{normal}, @option{multiplexed},
8301 or @option{demultiplexed}.
8302 The @var{clocking} must be @option{half} or @option{full}.
8303
8304 @quotation Warning
8305 With ETMv3.0 and newer, the bits set with the @var{mode} and
8306 @var{clocking} parameters both control the mode.
8307 This modified mode does not map to the values supported by
8308 previous ETM modules, so this syntax is subject to change.
8309 @end quotation
8310
8311 @quotation Note
8312 You can see the ETM registers using the @command{reg} command.
8313 Not all possible registers are present in every ETM.
8314 Most of the registers are write-only, and are used to configure
8315 what CPU activities are traced.
8316 @end quotation
8317 @end deffn
8318
8319 @deffn Command {etm info}
8320 Displays information about the current target's ETM.
8321 This includes resource counts from the @code{ETM_CONFIG} register,
8322 as well as silicon capabilities (except on rather old modules).
8323 from the @code{ETM_SYS_CONFIG} register.
8324 @end deffn
8325
8326 @deffn Command {etm status}
8327 Displays status of the current target's ETM and trace port driver:
8328 is the ETM idle, or is it collecting data?
8329 Did trace data overflow?
8330 Was it triggered?
8331 @end deffn
8332
8333 @deffn Command {etm tracemode} [type context_id_bits cycle_accurate branch_output]
8334 Displays what data that ETM will collect.
8335 If arguments are provided, first configures that data.
8336 When the configuration changes, tracing is stopped
8337 and any buffered trace data is invalidated.
8338
8339 @itemize
8340 @item @var{type} ... describing how data accesses are traced,
8341 when they pass any ViewData filtering that that was set up.
8342 The value is one of
8343 @option{none} (save nothing),
8344 @option{data} (save data),
8345 @option{address} (save addresses),
8346 @option{all} (save data and addresses)
8347 @item @var{context_id_bits} ... 0, 8, 16, or 32
8348 @item @var{cycle_accurate} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}
8349 cycle-accurate instruction tracing.
8350 Before ETMv3, enabling this causes much extra data to be recorded.
8351 @item @var{branch_output} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}.
8352 Disable this unless you need to try reconstructing the instruction
8353 trace stream without an image of the code.
8354 @end itemize
8355 @end deffn
8356
8357 @deffn Command {etm trigger_debug} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
8358 Displays whether ETM triggering debug entry (like a breakpoint) is
8359 enabled or disabled, after optionally modifying that configuration.
8360 The default behaviour is @option{disable}.
8361 Any change takes effect after the next @command{etm start}.
8362
8363 By using script commands to configure ETM registers, you can make the
8364 processor enter debug state automatically when certain conditions,
8365 more complex than supported by the breakpoint hardware, happen.
8366 @end deffn
8367
8368 @subsection ETM Trace Operation
8369
8370 After setting up the ETM, you can use it to collect data.
8371 That data can be exported to files for later analysis.
8372 It can also be parsed with OpenOCD, for basic sanity checking.
8373
8374 To configure what is being traced, you will need to write
8375 various trace registers using @command{reg ETM_*} commands.
8376 For the definitions of these registers, read ARM publication
8377 @emph{IHI 0014, ``Embedded Trace Macrocell, Architecture Specification''}.
8378 Be aware that most of the relevant registers are write-only,
8379 and that ETM resources are limited. There are only a handful
8380 of address comparators, data comparators, counters, and so on.
8381
8382 Examples of scenarios you might arrange to trace include:
8383
8384 @itemize
8385 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{excluding} subroutines
8386 it calls. Use address range comparators to enable tracing
8387 for instruction access within that function's body.
8388 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{including} subroutines
8389 it calls. Use the sequencer and address comparators to activate
8390 tracing on an ``entered function'' state, then deactivate it by
8391 exiting that state when the function's exit code is invoked.
8392 @item Code flow starting at the fifth invocation of a function,
8393 combining one of the above models with a counter.
8394 @item CPU data accesses to the registers for a particular device,
8395 using address range comparators and the ViewData logic.
8396 @item Such data accesses only during IRQ handling, combining the above
8397 model with sequencer triggers which on entry and exit to the IRQ handler.
8398 @item @emph{... more}
8399 @end itemize
8400
8401 At this writing, September 2009, there are no Tcl utility
8402 procedures to help set up any common tracing scenarios.
8403
8404 @deffn Command {etm analyze}
8405 Reads trace data into memory, if it wasn't already present.
8406 Decodes and prints the data that was collected.
8407 @end deffn
8408
8409 @deffn Command {etm dump} filename
8410 Stores the captured trace data in @file{filename}.
8411 @end deffn
8412
8413 @deffn Command {etm image} filename [base_address] [type]
8414 Opens an image file.
8415 @end deffn
8416
8417 @deffn Command {etm load} filename
8418 Loads captured trace data from @file{filename}.
8419 @end deffn
8420
8421 @deffn Command {etm start}
8422 Starts trace data collection.
8423 @end deffn
8424
8425 @deffn Command {etm stop}
8426 Stops trace data collection.
8427 @end deffn
8428
8429 @anchor{traceportdrivers}
8430 @subsection Trace Port Drivers
8431
8432 To use an ETM trace port it must be associated with a driver.
8433
8434 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} dummy
8435 Use the @option{dummy} driver if you are configuring an ETM that's
8436 not connected to anything (on-chip ETB or off-chip trace connector).
8437 @emph{This driver lets OpenOCD talk to the ETM, but it does not expose
8438 any trace data collection.}
8439 @deffn {Config Command} {etm_dummy config} target
8440 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with a dummy driver.
8441 @end deffn
8442 @end deffn
8443
8444 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} etb
8445 Use the @option{etb} driver if you are configuring an ETM
8446 to use on-chip ETB memory.
8447 @deffn {Config Command} {etb config} target etb_tap
8448 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with the ETB at @var{etb_tap}.
8449 You can see the ETB registers using the @command{reg} command.
8450 @end deffn
8451 @deffn Command {etb trigger_percent} [percent]
8452 This displays, or optionally changes, ETB behavior after the
8453 ETM's configured @emph{trigger} event fires.
8454 It controls how much more trace data is saved after the (single)
8455 trace trigger becomes active.
8456
8457 @itemize
8458 @item The default corresponds to @emph{trace around} usage,
8459 recording 50 percent data before the event and the rest
8460 afterwards.
8461 @item The minimum value of @var{percent} is 2 percent,
8462 recording almost exclusively data before the trigger.
8463 Such extreme @emph{trace before} usage can help figure out
8464 what caused that event to happen.
8465 @item The maximum value of @var{percent} is 100 percent,
8466 recording data almost exclusively after the event.
8467 This extreme @emph{trace after} usage might help sort out
8468 how the event caused trouble.
8469 @end itemize
8470 @c REVISIT allow "break" too -- enter debug mode.
8471 @end deffn
8472
8473 @end deffn
8474
8475 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} oocd_trace
8476 This driver isn't available unless OpenOCD was explicitly configured
8477 with the @option{--enable-oocd_trace} option. You probably don't want
8478 to configure it unless you've built the appropriate prototype hardware;
8479 it's @emph{proof-of-concept} software.
8480
8481 Use the @option{oocd_trace} driver if you are configuring an ETM that's
8482 connected to an off-chip trace connector.
8483
8484 @deffn {Config Command} {oocd_trace config} target tty
8485 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with a trace driver which
8486 collects data through the serial port @var{tty}.
8487 @end deffn
8488
8489 @deffn Command {oocd_trace resync}
8490 Re-synchronizes with the capture clock.
8491 @end deffn
8492
8493 @deffn Command {oocd_trace status}
8494 Reports whether the capture clock is locked or not.
8495 @end deffn
8496 @end deffn
8497
8498 @anchor{armcrosstrigger}
8499 @section ARM Cross-Trigger Interface
8500 @cindex CTI
8501
8502 The ARM Cross-Trigger Interface (CTI) is a generic CoreSight component
8503 that connects event sources like tracing components or CPU cores with each
8504 other through a common trigger matrix (CTM). For ARMv8 architecture, a
8505 CTI is mandatory for core run control and each core has an individual
8506 CTI instance attached to it. OpenOCD has limited support for CTI using
8507 the @emph{cti} group of commands.
8508
8509 @deffn Command {cti create} cti_name @option{-dap} dap_name @option{-ap-num} apn @option{-ctibase} base_address
8510 Creates a CTI instance @var{cti_name} on the DAP instance @var{dap_name} on MEM-AP
8511 @var{apn}. The @var{base_address} must match the base address of the CTI
8512 on the respective MEM-AP. All arguments are mandatory. This creates a
8513 new command @command{$cti_name} which is used for various purposes
8514 including additional configuration.
8515 @end deffn
8516
8517 @deffn Command {$cti_name enable} @option{on|off}
8518 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) the CTI.
8519 @end deffn
8520
8521 @deffn Command {$cti_name dump}
8522 Displays a register dump of the CTI.
8523 @end deffn
8524
8525 @deffn Command {$cti_name write } @var{reg_name} @var{value}
8526 Write @var{value} to the CTI register with the symbolic name @var{reg_name}.
8527 @end deffn
8528
8529 @deffn Command {$cti_name read} @var{reg_name}
8530 Print the value read from the CTI register with the symbolic name @var{reg_name}.
8531 @end deffn
8532
8533 @deffn Command {$cti_name ack} @var{event}
8534 Acknowledge a CTI @var{event}.
8535 @end deffn
8536
8537 @deffn Command {$cti_name channel} @var{channel_number} @var{operation}
8538 Perform a specific channel operation, the possible operations are:
8539 gate, ungate, set, clear and pulse
8540 @end deffn
8541
8542 @deffn Command {$cti_name testmode} @option{on|off}
8543 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) the integration test mode
8544 of the CTI.
8545 @end deffn
8546
8547 @deffn Command {cti names}
8548 Prints a list of names of all CTI objects created. This command is mainly
8549 useful in TCL scripting.
8550 @end deffn
8551
8552 @section Generic ARM
8553 @cindex ARM
8554
8555 These commands should be available on all ARM processors.
8556 They are available in addition to other core-specific
8557 commands that may be available.
8558
8559 @deffn Command {arm core_state} [@option{arm}|@option{thumb}]
8560 Displays the core_state, optionally changing it to process
8561 either @option{arm} or @option{thumb} instructions.
8562 The target may later be resumed in the currently set core_state.
8563 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
8564 that is not currently supported in OpenOCD.)
8565 @end deffn
8566
8567 @deffn Command {arm disassemble} address [count [@option{thumb}]]
8568 @cindex disassemble
8569 Disassembles @var{count} instructions starting at @var{address}.
8570 If @var{count} is not specified, a single instruction is disassembled.
8571 If @option{thumb} is specified, or the low bit of the address is set,
8572 Thumb2 (mixed 16/32-bit) instructions are used;
8573 else ARM (32-bit) instructions are used.
8574 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
8575 those instructions are not currently understood by OpenOCD.)
8576
8577 Note that all Thumb instructions are Thumb2 instructions,
8578 so older processors (without Thumb2 support) will still
8579 see correct disassembly of Thumb code.
8580 Also, ThumbEE opcodes are the same as Thumb2,
8581 with a handful of exceptions.
8582 ThumbEE disassembly currently has no explicit support.
8583 @end deffn
8584
8585 @deffn Command {arm mcr} pX op1 CRn CRm op2 value
8586 Write @var{value} to a coprocessor @var{pX} register
8587 passing parameters @var{CRn},
8588 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
8589 and using the MCR instruction.
8590 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
8591 an ARM register.)
8592 @end deffn
8593
8594 @deffn Command {arm mrc} pX coproc op1 CRn CRm op2
8595 Read a coprocessor @var{pX} register passing parameters @var{CRn},
8596 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
8597 and the MRC instruction.
8598 Returns the result so it can be manipulated by Jim scripts.
8599 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
8600 an ARM register.)
8601 @end deffn
8602
8603 @deffn Command {arm reg}
8604 Display a table of all banked core registers, fetching the current value from every
8605 core mode if necessary.
8606 @end deffn
8607
8608 @deffn Command {arm semihosting} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8609 @cindex ARM semihosting
8610 Display status of semihosting, after optionally changing that status.
8611
8612 Semihosting allows for code executing on an ARM target to use the
8613 I/O facilities on the host computer i.e. the system where OpenOCD
8614 is running. The target application must be linked against a library
8615 implementing the ARM semihosting convention that forwards operation
8616 requests by using a special SVC instruction that is trapped at the
8617 Supervisor Call vector by OpenOCD.
8618 @end deffn
8619
8620 @deffn Command {arm semihosting_cmdline} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8621 @cindex ARM semihosting
8622 Set the command line to be passed to the debugger.
8623
8624 @example
8625 arm semihosting_cmdline argv0 argv1 argv2 ...
8626 @end example
8627
8628 This option lets one set the command line arguments to be passed to
8629 the program. The first argument (argv0) is the program name in a
8630 standard C environment (argv[0]). Depending on the program (not much
8631 programs look at argv[0]), argv0 is ignored and can be any string.
8632 @end deffn
8633
8634 @deffn Command {arm semihosting_fileio} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8635 @cindex ARM semihosting
8636 Display status of semihosting fileio, after optionally changing that
8637 status.
8638
8639 Enabling this option forwards semihosting I/O to GDB process using the
8640 File-I/O remote protocol extension. This is especially useful for
8641 interacting with remote files or displaying console messages in the
8642 debugger.
8643 @end deffn
8644
8645 @deffn Command {arm semihosting_resexit} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8646 @cindex ARM semihosting
8647 Enable resumable SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT.
8648
8649 When SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT is called outside a debug session,
8650 things are simple, the openocd process calls exit() and passes
8651 the value returned by the target.
8652
8653 When SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT is called during a debug session,
8654 by default execution returns to the debugger, leaving the
8655 debugger in a HALT state, similar to the state entered when
8656 encountering a break.
8657
8658 In some use cases, it is useful to have SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT
8659 return normally, as any semihosting call, and do not break
8660 to the debugger.
8661 The standard allows this to happen, but the condition
8662 to trigger it is a bit obscure ("by performing an RDI_Execute
8663 request or equivalent").
8664
8665 To make the SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT call return normally, enable
8666 this option (default: disabled).
8667 @end deffn
8668
8669 @section ARMv4 and ARMv5 Architecture
8670 @cindex ARMv4
8671 @cindex ARMv5
8672
8673 The ARMv4 and ARMv5 architectures are widely used in embedded systems,
8674 and introduced core parts of the instruction set in use today.
8675 That includes the Thumb instruction set, introduced in the ARMv4T
8676 variant.
8677
8678 @subsection ARM7 and ARM9 specific commands
8679 @cindex ARM7
8680 @cindex ARM9
8681
8682 These commands are specific to ARM7 and ARM9 cores, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T,
8683 ARM9TDMI, ARM920T or ARM926EJ-S.
8684 They are available in addition to the ARM commands,
8685 and any other core-specific commands that may be available.
8686
8687 @deffn Command {arm7_9 dbgrq} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8688 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the
8689 the EmbeddedIce DBGRQ signal to force entry into debug mode,
8690 instead of breakpoints.
8691 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
8692
8693 This should be
8694 safe for all but ARM7TDMI-S cores (like NXP LPC).
8695 This feature is enabled by default on most ARM9 cores,
8696 including ARM9TDMI, ARM920T, and ARM926EJ-S.
8697 @end deffn
8698
8699 @deffn Command {arm7_9 dcc_downloads} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8700 @cindex DCC
8701 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the debug communications
8702 channel (DCC) to write larger (>128 byte) amounts of memory.
8703 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
8704
8705 DCC downloads offer a huge speed increase, but might be
8706 unsafe, especially with targets running at very low speeds. This command was introduced
8707 with OpenOCD rev. 60, and requires a few bytes of working area.
8708 @end deffn
8709
8710 @deffn Command {arm7_9 fast_memory_access} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8711 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of memory writes and reads
8712 that don't check completion of the operation.
8713 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
8714
8715 This provides a huge speed increase, especially with USB JTAG
8716 cables (FT2232), but might be unsafe if used with targets running at very low
8717 speeds, like the 32kHz startup clock of an AT91RM9200.
8718 @end deffn
8719
8720 @subsection ARM720T specific commands
8721 @cindex ARM720T
8722
8723 These commands are available to ARM720T based CPUs,
8724 which are implementations of the ARMv4T architecture
8725 based on the ARM7TDMI-S integer core.
8726 They are available in addition to the ARM and ARM7/ARM9 commands.
8727
8728 @deffn Command {arm720t cp15} opcode [value]
8729 @emph{DEPRECATED -- avoid using this.
8730 Use the @command{arm mrc} or @command{arm mcr} commands instead.}
8731
8732 Display cp15 register returned by the ARM instruction @var{opcode};
8733 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
8734 The @var{opcode} should be the value of either an MRC or MCR instruction.
8735 @end deffn
8736
8737 @subsection ARM9 specific commands
8738 @cindex ARM9
8739
8740 ARM9-family cores are built around ARM9TDMI or ARM9E (including ARM9EJS)
8741 integer processors.
8742 Such cores include the ARM920T, ARM926EJ-S, and ARM966.
8743
8744 @c 9-june-2009: tried this on arm920t, it didn't work.
8745 @c no-params always lists nothing caught, and that's how it acts.
8746 @c 23-oct-2009: doesn't work _consistently_ ... as if the ICE
8747 @c versions have different rules about when they commit writes.
8748
8749 @anchor{arm9vectorcatch}
8750 @deffn Command {arm9 vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
8751 @cindex vector_catch
8752 Vector Catch hardware provides a sort of dedicated breakpoint
8753 for hardware events such as reset, interrupt, and abort.
8754 You can use this to conserve normal breakpoint resources,
8755 so long as you're not concerned with code that branches directly
8756 to those hardware vectors.
8757
8758 This always finishes by listing the current configuration.
8759 If parameters are provided, it first reconfigures the
8760 vector catch hardware to intercept
8761 @option{all} of the hardware vectors,
8762 @option{none} of them,
8763 or a list with one or more of the following:
8764 @option{reset} @option{undef} @option{swi} @option{pabt} @option{dabt}
8765 @option{irq} @option{fiq}.
8766 @end deffn
8767
8768 @subsection ARM920T specific commands
8769 @cindex ARM920T
8770
8771 These commands are available to ARM920T based CPUs,
8772 which are implementations of the ARMv4T architecture
8773 built using the ARM9TDMI integer core.
8774 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
8775 and ARM9 commands.
8776
8777 @deffn Command {arm920t cache_info}
8778 Print information about the caches found. This allows to see whether your target
8779 is an ARM920T (2x16kByte cache) or ARM922T (2x8kByte cache).
8780 @end deffn
8781
8782 @deffn Command {arm920t cp15} regnum [value]
8783 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
8784 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
8785 This uses "physical access" and the register number is as
8786 shown in bits 38..33 of table 9-9 in the ARM920T TRM.
8787 (Not all registers can be written.)
8788 @end deffn
8789
8790 @deffn Command {arm920t cp15i} opcode [value [address]]
8791 @emph{DEPRECATED -- avoid using this.
8792 Use the @command{arm mrc} or @command{arm mcr} commands instead.}
8793
8794 Interpreted access using ARM instruction @var{opcode}, which should
8795 be the value of either an MRC or MCR instruction
8796 (as shown tables 9-11, 9-12, and 9-13 in the ARM920T TRM).
8797 If no @var{value} is provided, the result is displayed.
8798 Else if that value is written using the specified @var{address},
8799 or using zero if no other address is provided.
8800 @end deffn
8801
8802 @deffn Command {arm920t read_cache} filename
8803 Dump the content of ICache and DCache to a file named @file{filename}.
8804 @end deffn
8805
8806 @deffn Command {arm920t read_mmu} filename
8807 Dump the content of the ITLB and DTLB to a file named @file{filename}.
8808 @end deffn
8809
8810 @subsection ARM926ej-s specific commands
8811 @cindex ARM926ej-s
8812
8813 These commands are available to ARM926ej-s based CPUs,
8814 which are implementations of the ARMv5TEJ architecture
8815 based on the ARM9EJ-S integer core.
8816 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
8817 and ARM9 commands.
8818
8819 The Feroceon cores also support these commands, although
8820 they are not built from ARM926ej-s designs.
8821
8822 @deffn Command {arm926ejs cache_info}
8823 Print information about the caches found.
8824 @end deffn
8825
8826 @subsection ARM966E specific commands
8827 @cindex ARM966E
8828
8829 These commands are available to ARM966 based CPUs,
8830 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
8831 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
8832 and ARM9 commands.
8833
8834 @deffn Command {arm966e cp15} regnum [value]
8835 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
8836 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
8837 The six bit @var{regnum} values are bits 37..32 from table 7-2 of the
8838 ARM966E-S TRM.
8839 There is no current control over bits 31..30 from that table,
8840 as required for BIST support.
8841 @end deffn
8842
8843 @subsection XScale specific commands
8844 @cindex XScale
8845
8846 Some notes about the debug implementation on the XScale CPUs:
8847
8848 The XScale CPU provides a special debug-only mini-instruction cache
8849 (mini-IC) in which exception vectors and target-resident debug handler
8850 code are placed by OpenOCD. In order to get access to the CPU, OpenOCD
8851 must point vector 0 (the reset vector) to the entry of the debug
8852 handler. However, this means that the complete first cacheline in the
8853 mini-IC is marked valid, which makes the CPU fetch all exception
8854 handlers from the mini-IC, ignoring the code in RAM.
8855
8856 To address this situation, OpenOCD provides the @code{xscale
8857 vector_table} command, which allows the user to explicitly write
8858 individual entries to either the high or low vector table stored in
8859 the mini-IC.
8860
8861 It is recommended to place a pc-relative indirect branch in the vector
8862 table, and put the branch destination somewhere in memory. Doing so
8863 makes sure the code in the vector table stays constant regardless of
8864 code layout in memory:
8865 @example
8866 _vectors:
8867 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8868 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8869 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8870 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8871 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8872 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8873 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8874 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8875 .org 0x100
8876 .long real_reset_vector
8877 .long real_ui_handler
8878 .long real_swi_handler
8879 .long real_pf_abort
8880 .long real_data_abort
8881 .long 0 /* unused */
8882 .long real_irq_handler
8883 .long real_fiq_handler
8884 @end example
8885
8886 Alternatively, you may choose to keep some or all of the mini-IC
8887 vector table entries synced with those written to memory by your
8888 system software. The mini-IC can not be modified while the processor
8889 is executing, but for each vector table entry not previously defined
8890 using the @code{xscale vector_table} command, OpenOCD will copy the
8891 value from memory to the mini-IC every time execution resumes from a
8892 halt. This is done for both high and low vector tables (although the
8893 table not in use may not be mapped to valid memory, and in this case
8894 that copy operation will silently fail). This means that you will
8895 need to briefly halt execution at some strategic point during system
8896 start-up; e.g., after the software has initialized the vector table,
8897 but before exceptions are enabled. A breakpoint can be used to
8898 accomplish this once the appropriate location in the start-up code has
8899 been identified. A watchpoint over the vector table region is helpful
8900 in finding the location if you're not sure. Note that the same
8901 situation exists any time the vector table is modified by the system
8902 software.
8903
8904 The debug handler must be placed somewhere in the address space using
8905 the @code{xscale debug_handler} command. The allowed locations for the
8906 debug handler are either (0x800 - 0x1fef800) or (0xfe000800 -
8907 0xfffff800). The default value is 0xfe000800.
8908
8909 XScale has resources to support two hardware breakpoints and two
8910 watchpoints. However, the following restrictions on watchpoint
8911 functionality apply: (1) the value and mask arguments to the @code{wp}
8912 command are not supported, (2) the watchpoint length must be a
8913 power of two and not less than four, and can not be greater than the
8914 watchpoint address, and (3) a watchpoint with a length greater than
8915 four consumes all the watchpoint hardware resources. This means that
8916 at any one time, you can have enabled either two watchpoints with a
8917 length of four, or one watchpoint with a length greater than four.
8918
8919 These commands are available to XScale based CPUs,
8920 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
8921
8922 @deffn Command {xscale analyze_trace}
8923 Displays the contents of the trace buffer.
8924 @end deffn
8925
8926 @deffn Command {xscale cache_clean_address} address
8927 Changes the address used when cleaning the data cache.
8928 @end deffn
8929
8930 @deffn Command {xscale cache_info}
8931 Displays information about the CPU caches.
8932 @end deffn
8933
8934 @deffn Command {xscale cp15} regnum [value]
8935 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
8936 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
8937 @end deffn
8938
8939 @deffn Command {xscale debug_handler} target address
8940 Changes the address used for the specified target's debug handler.
8941 @end deffn
8942
8943 @deffn Command {xscale dcache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8944 Enables or disable the CPU's data cache.
8945 @end deffn
8946
8947 @deffn Command {xscale dump_trace} filename
8948 Dumps the raw contents of the trace buffer to @file{filename}.
8949 @end deffn
8950
8951 @deffn Command {xscale icache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8952 Enables or disable the CPU's instruction cache.
8953 @end deffn
8954
8955 @deffn Command {xscale mmu} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8956 Enables or disable the CPU's memory management unit.
8957 @end deffn
8958
8959 @deffn Command {xscale trace_buffer} [@option{enable}|@option{disable} [@option{fill} [n] | @option{wrap}]]
8960 Displays the trace buffer status, after optionally
8961 enabling or disabling the trace buffer
8962 and modifying how it is emptied.
8963 @end deffn
8964
8965 @deffn Command {xscale trace_image} filename [offset [type]]
8966 Opens a trace image from @file{filename}, optionally rebasing
8967 its segment addresses by @var{offset}.
8968 The image @var{type} may be one of
8969 @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
8970 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19),
8971 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
8972 @end deffn
8973
8974 @anchor{xscalevectorcatch}
8975 @deffn Command {xscale vector_catch} [mask]
8976 @cindex vector_catch
8977 Display a bitmask showing the hardware vectors to catch.
8978 If the optional parameter is provided, first set the bitmask to that value.
8979
8980 The mask bits correspond with bit 16..23 in the DCSR:
8981 @example
8982 0x01 Trap Reset
8983 0x02 Trap Undefined Instructions
8984 0x04 Trap Software Interrupt
8985 0x08 Trap Prefetch Abort
8986 0x10 Trap Data Abort
8987 0x20 reserved
8988 0x40 Trap IRQ
8989 0x80 Trap FIQ
8990 @end example
8991 @end deffn
8992
8993 @deffn Command {xscale vector_table} [(@option{low}|@option{high}) index value]
8994 @cindex vector_table
8995
8996 Set an entry in the mini-IC vector table. There are two tables: one for
8997 low vectors (at 0x00000000), and one for high vectors (0xFFFF0000), each
8998 holding the 8 exception vectors. @var{index} can be 1-7, because vector 0
8999 points to the debug handler entry and can not be overwritten.
9000 @var{value} holds the 32-bit opcode that is placed in the mini-IC.
9001
9002 Without arguments, the current settings are displayed.
9003
9004 @end deffn
9005
9006 @section ARMv6 Architecture
9007 @cindex ARMv6
9008
9009 @subsection ARM11 specific commands
9010 @cindex ARM11
9011
9012 @deffn Command {arm11 memwrite burst} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9013 Displays the value of the memwrite burst-enable flag,
9014 which is enabled by default.
9015 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9016 Burst writes are only used for memory writes larger than 1 word.
9017 They improve performance by assuming that the CPU has read each data
9018 word over JTAG and completed its write before the next word arrives,
9019 instead of polling for a status flag to verify that completion.
9020 This is usually safe, because JTAG runs much slower than the CPU.
9021 @end deffn
9022
9023 @deffn Command {arm11 memwrite error_fatal} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9024 Displays the value of the memwrite error_fatal flag,
9025 which is enabled by default.
9026 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9027 When set, certain memory write errors cause earlier transfer termination.
9028 @end deffn
9029
9030 @deffn Command {arm11 step_irq_enable} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9031 Displays the value of the flag controlling whether
9032 IRQs are enabled during single stepping;
9033 they are disabled by default.
9034 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that.
9035 @end deffn
9036
9037 @deffn Command {arm11 vcr} [value]
9038 @cindex vector_catch
9039 Displays the value of the @emph{Vector Catch Register (VCR)},
9040 coprocessor 14 register 7.
9041 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
9042
9043 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
9044 for certain hardware events.
9045 The specific bit values are core-specific (as in fact is using
9046 coprocessor 14 register 7 itself) but all current ARM11
9047 cores @emph{except the ARM1176} use the same six bits.
9048 @end deffn
9049
9050 @section ARMv7 and ARMv8 Architecture
9051 @cindex ARMv7
9052 @cindex ARMv8
9053
9054 @subsection ARMv7-A specific commands
9055 @cindex Cortex-A
9056
9057 @deffn Command {cortex_a cache_info}
9058 display information about target caches
9059 @end deffn
9060
9061 @deffn Command {cortex_a dacrfixup [@option{on}|@option{off}]}
9062 Work around issues with software breakpoints when the program text is
9063 mapped read-only by the operating system. This option sets the CP15 DACR
9064 to "all-manager" to bypass MMU permission checks on memory access.
9065 Defaults to 'off'.
9066 @end deffn
9067
9068 @deffn Command {cortex_a dbginit}
9069 Initialize core debug
9070 Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
9071 @end deffn
9072
9073 @deffn Command {cortex_a smp} [on|off]
9074 Display/set the current SMP mode
9075 @end deffn
9076
9077 @deffn Command {cortex_a smp_gdb} [core_id]
9078 Display/set the current core displayed in GDB
9079 @end deffn
9080
9081 @deffn Command {cortex_a maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
9082 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
9083 @end deffn
9084
9085 @deffn Command {cache_config l2x} [base way]
9086 configure l2x cache
9087 @end deffn
9088
9089 @deffn Command {cortex_a mmu dump} [@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{addr} address [@option{num_entries}]]
9090 Dump the MMU translation table from TTB0 or TTB1 register, or from physical
9091 memory location @var{address}. When dumping the table from @var{address}, print at most
9092 @var{num_entries} page table entries. @var{num_entries} is optional, if omitted, the maximum
9093 possible (4096) entries are printed.
9094 @end deffn
9095
9096 @subsection ARMv7-R specific commands
9097 @cindex Cortex-R
9098
9099 @deffn Command {cortex_r dbginit}
9100 Initialize core debug
9101 Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
9102 @end deffn
9103
9104 @deffn Command {cortex_r maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
9105 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
9106 @end deffn
9107
9108
9109 @subsection ARMv7-M specific commands
9110 @cindex tracing
9111 @cindex SWO
9112 @cindex SWV
9113 @cindex TPIU
9114 @cindex ITM
9115 @cindex ETM
9116
9117 @deffn Command {tpiu config} (@option{disable} | ((@option{external} | @option{internal (@var{filename} | -)}) @
9118 (@option{sync @var{port_width}} | ((@option{manchester} | @option{uart}) @var{formatter_enable})) @
9119 @var{TRACECLKIN_freq} [@var{trace_freq}]))
9120
9121 ARMv7-M architecture provides several modules to generate debugging
9122 information internally (ITM, DWT and ETM). Their output is directed
9123 through TPIU to be captured externally either on an SWO pin (this
9124 configuration is called SWV) or on a synchronous parallel trace port.
9125
9126 This command configures the TPIU module of the target and, if internal
9127 capture mode is selected, starts to capture trace output by using the
9128 debugger adapter features.
9129
9130 Some targets require additional actions to be performed in the
9131 @b{trace-config} handler for trace port to be activated.
9132
9133 Command options:
9134 @itemize @minus
9135 @item @option{disable} disable TPIU handling;
9136 @item @option{external} configure TPIU to let user capture trace
9137 output externally (with an additional UART or logic analyzer hardware);
9138 @item @option{internal @var{filename}} configure TPIU and debug adapter to
9139 gather trace data and append it to @var{filename} (which can be
9140 either a regular file or a named pipe);
9141 @item @option{internal -} configure TPIU and debug adapter to
9142 gather trace data, but not write to any file. Useful in conjunction with the @command{tcl_trace} command;
9143 @item @option{sync @var{port_width}} use synchronous parallel trace output
9144 mode, and set port width to @var{port_width};
9145 @item @option{manchester} use asynchronous SWO mode with Manchester
9146 coding;
9147 @item @option{uart} use asynchronous SWO mode with NRZ (same as
9148 regular UART 8N1) coding;
9149 @item @var{formatter_enable} is @option{on} or @option{off} to enable
9150 or disable TPIU formatter which needs to be used when both ITM and ETM
9151 data is to be output via SWO;
9152 @item @var{TRACECLKIN_freq} this should be specified to match target's
9153 current TRACECLKIN frequency (usually the same as HCLK);
9154 @item @var{trace_freq} trace port frequency. Can be omitted in
9155 internal mode to let the adapter driver select the maximum supported
9156 rate automatically.
9157 @end itemize
9158
9159 Example usage:
9160 @enumerate
9161 @item STM32L152 board is programmed with an application that configures
9162 PLL to provide core clock with 24MHz frequency; to use ITM output it's
9163 enough to:
9164 @example
9165 #include <libopencm3/cm3/itm.h>
9166 ...
9167 ITM_STIM8(0) = c;
9168 ...
9169 @end example
9170 (the most obvious way is to use the first stimulus port for printf,
9171 for that this ITM_STIM8 assignment can be used inside _write(); to make it
9172 blocking to avoid data loss, add @code{while (!(ITM_STIM8(0) &
9173 ITM_STIM_FIFOREADY));});
9174 @item An FT2232H UART is connected to the SWO pin of the board;
9175 @item Commands to configure UART for 12MHz baud rate:
9176 @example
9177 $ setserial /dev/ttyUSB1 spd_cust divisor 5
9178 $ stty -F /dev/ttyUSB1 38400
9179 @end example
9180 (FT2232H's base frequency is 60MHz, spd_cust allows to alias 38400
9181 baud with our custom divisor to get 12MHz)
9182 @item @code{itmdump -f /dev/ttyUSB1 -d1}
9183 @item OpenOCD invocation line:
9184 @example
9185 openocd -f interface/stlink.cfg \
9186 -c "transport select hla_swd" \
9187 -f target/stm32l1.cfg \
9188 -c "tpiu config external uart off 24000000 12000000"
9189 @end example
9190 @end enumerate
9191 @end deffn
9192
9193 @deffn Command {itm port} @var{port} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
9194 Enable or disable trace output for ITM stimulus @var{port} (counting
9195 from 0). Port 0 is enabled on target creation automatically.
9196 @end deffn
9197
9198 @deffn Command {itm ports} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
9199 Enable or disable trace output for all ITM stimulus ports.
9200 @end deffn
9201
9202 @subsection Cortex-M specific commands
9203 @cindex Cortex-M
9204
9205 @deffn Command {cortex_m maskisr} (@option{auto}|@option{on}|@option{off}|@option{steponly})
9206 Control masking (disabling) interrupts during target step/resume.
9207
9208 The @option{auto} option handles interrupts during stepping in a way that they
9209 get served but don't disturb the program flow. The step command first allows
9210 pending interrupt handlers to execute, then disables interrupts and steps over
9211 the next instruction where the core was halted. After the step interrupts
9212 are enabled again. If the interrupt handlers don't complete within 500ms,
9213 the step command leaves with the core running.
9214
9215 The @option{steponly} option disables interrupts during single-stepping but
9216 enables them during normal execution. This can be used as a partial workaround
9217 for 702596 erratum in Cortex-M7 r0p1. See "Cortex-M7 (AT610) and Cortex-M7 with
9218 FPU (AT611) Software Developer Errata Notice" from ARM for further details.
9219
9220 Note that a free hardware (FPB) breakpoint is required for the @option{auto}
9221 option. If no breakpoint is available at the time of the step, then the step
9222 is taken with interrupts enabled, i.e. the same way the @option{off} option
9223 does.
9224
9225 Default is @option{auto}.
9226 @end deffn
9227
9228 @deffn Command {cortex_m vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
9229 @cindex vector_catch
9230 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
9231 for certain hardware events.
9232
9233 Parameters request interception of
9234 @option{all} of these hardware event vectors,
9235 @option{none} of them,
9236 or one or more of the following:
9237 @option{hard_err} for a HardFault exception;
9238 @option{mm_err} for a MemManage exception;
9239 @option{bus_err} for a BusFault exception;
9240 @option{irq_err},
9241 @option{state_err},
9242 @option{chk_err}, or
9243 @option{nocp_err} for various UsageFault exceptions; or
9244 @option{reset}.
9245 If NVIC setup code does not enable them,
9246 MemManage, BusFault, and UsageFault exceptions
9247 are mapped to HardFault.
9248 UsageFault checks for
9249 divide-by-zero and unaligned access
9250 must also be explicitly enabled.
9251
9252 This finishes by listing the current vector catch configuration.
9253 @end deffn
9254
9255 @deffn Command {cortex_m reset_config} (@option{sysresetreq}|@option{vectreset})
9256 Control reset handling if hardware srst is not fitted
9257 @xref{reset_config,,reset_config}.
9258
9259 @itemize @minus
9260 @item @option{sysresetreq} use AIRCR SYSRESETREQ to reset system.
9261 @item @option{vectreset} use AIRCR VECTRESET to reset system (default).
9262 @end itemize
9263
9264 Using @option{vectreset} is a safe option for Cortex-M3, M4 and M7 cores.
9265 This however has the disadvantage of only resetting the core, all peripherals
9266 are unaffected. A solution would be to use a @code{reset-init} event handler
9267 to manually reset the peripherals.
9268 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
9269
9270 Cortex-M0, M0+ and M1 do not support @option{vectreset}, use @option{sysresetreq}
9271 instead.
9272 @end deffn
9273
9274 @subsection ARMv8-A specific commands
9275 @cindex ARMv8-A
9276 @cindex aarch64
9277
9278 @deffn Command {aarch64 cache_info}
9279 Display information about target caches
9280 @end deffn
9281
9282 @deffn Command {aarch64 dbginit}
9283 This command enables debugging by clearing the OS Lock and sticky power-down and reset
9284 indications. It also establishes the expected, basic cross-trigger configuration the aarch64
9285 target code relies on. In a configuration file, the command would typically be called from a
9286 @code{reset-end} or @code{reset-deassert-post} handler, to re-enable debugging after a system reset.
9287 However, normally it is not necessary to use the command at all.
9288 @end deffn
9289
9290 @deffn Command {aarch64 smp} [on|off]
9291 Display, enable or disable SMP handling mode. The state of SMP handling influences the way targets in an SMP group
9292 are handled by the run control. With SMP handling enabled, issuing halt or resume to one core will trigger
9293 halting or resuming of all cores in the group. The command @code{target smp} defines which targets are in the SMP
9294 group. With SMP handling disabled, all targets need to be treated individually.
9295 @end deffn
9296
9297 @deffn Command {aarch64 maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
9298 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping. The default configuration is
9299 @option{on}.
9300 @end deffn
9301
9302 @deffn Command {$target_name catch_exc} [@option{off}|@option{sec_el1}|@option{sec_el3}|@option{nsec_el1}|@option{nsec_el2}]+
9303 Cause @command{$target_name} to halt when an exception is taken. Any combination of
9304 Secure (sec) EL1/EL3 or Non-Secure (nsec) EL1/EL2 is valid. The target
9305 @command{$target_name} will halt before taking the exception. In order to resume
9306 the target, the exception catch must be disabled again with @command{$target_name catch_exc off}.
9307 Issuing the command without options prints the current configuration.
9308 @end deffn
9309
9310 @section EnSilica eSi-RISC Architecture
9311
9312 eSi-RISC is a highly configurable microprocessor architecture for embedded systems
9313 provided by EnSilica. (See: @url{http://www.ensilica.com/risc-ip/}.)
9314
9315 @subsection eSi-RISC Configuration
9316
9317 @deffn Command {esirisc cache_arch} (@option{harvard}|@option{von_neumann})
9318 Configure the caching architecture. Targets with the @code{UNIFIED_ADDRESS_SPACE}
9319 option disabled employ a Harvard architecture. By default, @option{von_neumann} is assumed.
9320 @end deffn
9321
9322 @deffn Command {esirisc hwdc} (@option{all}|@option{none}|mask ...)
9323 Configure hardware debug control. The HWDC register controls which exceptions return
9324 control back to the debugger. Possible masks are @option{all}, @option{none},
9325 @option{reset}, @option{interrupt}, @option{syscall}, @option{error}, and @option{debug}.
9326 By default, @option{reset}, @option{error}, and @option{debug} are enabled.
9327 @end deffn
9328
9329 @subsection eSi-RISC Operation
9330
9331 @deffn Command {esirisc flush_caches}
9332 Flush instruction and data caches. This command requires that the target is halted
9333 when the command is issued and configured with an instruction or data cache.
9334 @end deffn
9335
9336 @subsection eSi-Trace Configuration
9337
9338 eSi-RISC targets may be configured with support for instruction tracing. Trace
9339 data may be written to an in-memory buffer or FIFO. If a FIFO is configured, DMA
9340 is typically employed to move trace data off-device using a high-speed
9341 peripheral (eg. SPI). Collected trace data is encoded in one of three different
9342 formats. At a minimum, @command{esirisc trace buffer} or @command{esirisc trace
9343 fifo} must be issued along with @command{esirisc trace format} before trace data
9344 can be collected.
9345
9346 OpenOCD provides rudimentary analysis of collected trace data. If more detail is
9347 needed, collected trace data can be dumped to a file and processed by external
9348 tooling.
9349
9350 @quotation Issues
9351 OpenOCD is unable to process trace data sent to a FIFO. A potential workaround
9352 for this issue is to configure DMA to copy trace data to an in-memory buffer,
9353 which can then be passed to the @command{esirisc trace analyze} and
9354 @command{esirisc trace dump} commands.
9355
9356 It is possible to corrupt trace data when using a FIFO if the peripheral
9357 responsible for draining data from the FIFO is not fast enough. This can be
9358 managed by enabling flow control, however this can impact timing-sensitive
9359 software operation on the CPU.
9360 @end quotation
9361
9362 @deffn Command {esirisc trace buffer} address size [@option{wrap}]
9363 Configure trace buffer using the provided address and size. If the @option{wrap}
9364 option is specified, trace collection will continue once the end of the buffer
9365 is reached. By default, wrap is disabled.
9366 @end deffn
9367
9368 @deffn Command {esirisc trace fifo} address
9369 Configure trace FIFO using the provided address.
9370 @end deffn
9371
9372 @deffn Command {esirisc trace flow_control} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
9373 Enable or disable stalling the CPU to collect trace data. By default, flow
9374 control is disabled.
9375 @end deffn
9376
9377 @deffn Command {esirisc trace format} (@option{full}|@option{branch}|@option{icache}) pc_bits
9378 Configure trace format and number of PC bits to be captured. @option{pc_bits}
9379 must be within 1 and 31 as the LSB is not collected. If external tooling is used
9380 to analyze collected trace data, these values must match.
9381
9382 Supported trace formats:
9383 @itemize
9384 @item @option{full} capture full trace data, allowing execution history and
9385 timing to be determined.
9386 @item @option{branch} capture taken branch instructions and branch target
9387 addresses.
9388 @item @option{icache} capture instruction cache misses.
9389 @end itemize
9390 @end deffn
9391
9392 @deffn Command {esirisc trace trigger start} (@option{condition}) [start_data start_mask]
9393 Configure trigger start condition using the provided start data and mask. A
9394 brief description of each condition is provided below; for more detail on how
9395 these values are used, see the eSi-RISC Architecture Manual.
9396
9397 Supported conditions:
9398 @itemize
9399 @item @option{none} manual tracing (see @command{esirisc trace start}).
9400 @item @option{pc} start tracing if the PC matches start data and mask.
9401 @item @option{load} start tracing if the effective address of a load
9402 instruction matches start data and mask.
9403 @item @option{store} start tracing if the effective address of a store
9404 instruction matches start data and mask.
9405 @item @option{exception} start tracing if the EID of an exception matches start
9406 data and mask.
9407 @item @option{eret} start tracing when an @code{ERET} instruction is executed.
9408 @item @option{wait} start tracing when a @code{WAIT} instruction is executed.
9409 @item @option{stop} start tracing when a @code{STOP} instruction is executed.
9410 @item @option{high} start tracing when an external signal is a logical high.
9411 @item @option{low} start tracing when an external signal is a logical low.
9412 @end itemize
9413 @end deffn
9414
9415 @deffn Command {esirisc trace trigger stop} (@option{condition}) [stop_data stop_mask]
9416 Configure trigger stop condition using the provided stop data and mask. A brief
9417 description of each condition is provided below; for more detail on how these
9418 values are used, see the eSi-RISC Architecture Manual.
9419
9420 Supported conditions:
9421 @itemize
9422 @item @option{none} manual tracing (see @command{esirisc trace stop}).
9423 @item @option{pc} stop tracing if the PC matches stop data and mask.
9424 @item @option{load} stop tracing if the effective address of a load
9425 instruction matches stop data and mask.
9426 @item @option{store} stop tracing if the effective address of a store
9427 instruction matches stop data and mask.
9428 @item @option{exception} stop tracing if the EID of an exception matches stop
9429 data and mask.
9430 @item @option{eret} stop tracing when an @code{ERET} instruction is executed.
9431 @item @option{wait} stop tracing when a @code{WAIT} instruction is executed.
9432 @item @option{stop} stop tracing when a @code{STOP} instruction is executed.
9433 @end itemize
9434 @end deffn
9435
9436 @deffn Command {esirisc trace trigger delay} (@option{trigger}) [cycles]
9437 Configure trigger start/stop delay in clock cycles.
9438
9439 Supported triggers:
9440 @itemize
9441 @item @option{none} no delay to start or stop collection.
9442 @item @option{start} delay @option{cycles} after trigger to start collection.
9443 @item @option{stop} delay @option{cycles} after trigger to stop collection.
9444 @item @option{both} delay @option{cycles} after both triggers to start or stop
9445 collection.
9446 @end itemize
9447 @end deffn
9448
9449 @subsection eSi-Trace Operation
9450
9451 @deffn Command {esirisc trace init}
9452 Initialize trace collection. This command must be called any time the
9453 configuration changes. If a trace buffer has been configured, the contents will
9454 be overwritten when trace collection starts.
9455 @end deffn
9456
9457 @deffn Command {esirisc trace info}
9458 Display trace configuration.
9459 @end deffn
9460
9461 @deffn Command {esirisc trace status}
9462 Display trace collection status.
9463 @end deffn
9464
9465 @deffn Command {esirisc trace start}
9466 Start manual trace collection.
9467 @end deffn
9468
9469 @deffn Command {esirisc trace stop}
9470 Stop manual trace collection.
9471 @end deffn
9472
9473 @deffn Command {esirisc trace analyze} [address size]
9474 Analyze collected trace data. This command may only be used if a trace buffer
9475 has been configured. If a trace FIFO has been configured, trace data must be
9476 copied to an in-memory buffer identified by the @option{address} and
9477 @option{size} options using DMA.
9478 @end deffn
9479
9480 @deffn Command {esirisc trace dump} [address size] @file{filename}
9481 Dump collected trace data to file. This command may only be used if a trace
9482 buffer has been configured. If a trace FIFO has been configured, trace data must
9483 be copied to an in-memory buffer identified by the @option{address} and
9484 @option{size} options using DMA.
9485 @end deffn
9486
9487 @section Intel Architecture
9488
9489 Intel Quark X10xx is the first product in the Quark family of SoCs. It is an IA-32
9490 (Pentium x86 ISA) compatible SoC. The core CPU in the X10xx is codenamed Lakemont.
9491 Lakemont version 1 (LMT1) is used in X10xx. The CPU TAP (Lakemont TAP) is used for
9492 software debug and the CLTAP is used for SoC level operations.
9493 Useful docs are here: https://communities.intel.com/community/makers/documentation
9494 @itemize
9495 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 OpenOCD/GDB/Eclipse App Note (web search for doc num 330015)
9496 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Debug Operations User Guide (web search for doc num 329866)
9497 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Datasheet (web search for doc num 329676)
9498 @end itemize
9499
9500 @subsection x86 32-bit specific commands
9501 The three main address spaces for x86 are memory, I/O and configuration space.
9502 These commands allow a user to read and write to the 64Kbyte I/O address space.
9503
9504 @deffn Command {x86_32 idw} address
9505 Display the contents of a 32-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9506 @end deffn
9507
9508 @deffn Command {x86_32 idh} address
9509 Display the contents of a 16-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9510 @end deffn
9511
9512 @deffn Command {x86_32 idb} address
9513 Display the contents of a 8-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9514 @end deffn
9515
9516 @deffn Command {x86_32 iww} address
9517 Write the contents of a 32-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9518 @end deffn
9519
9520 @deffn Command {x86_32 iwh} address
9521 Write the contents of a 16-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9522 @end deffn
9523
9524 @deffn Command {x86_32 iwb} address
9525 Write the contents of a 8-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9526 @end deffn
9527
9528 @section OpenRISC Architecture
9529
9530 The OpenRISC CPU is a soft core. It is used in a programmable SoC which can be
9531 configured with any of the TAP / Debug Unit available.
9532
9533 @subsection TAP and Debug Unit selection commands
9534 @deffn Command {tap_select} (@option{vjtag}|@option{mohor}|@option{xilinx_bscan})
9535 Select between the Altera Virtual JTAG , Xilinx Virtual JTAG and Mohor TAP.
9536 @end deffn
9537 @deffn Command {du_select} (@option{adv}|@option{mohor}) [option]
9538 Select between the Advanced Debug Interface and the classic one.
9539
9540 An option can be passed as a second argument to the debug unit.
9541
9542 When using the Advanced Debug Interface, option = 1 means the RTL core is
9543 configured with ADBG_USE_HISPEED = 1. This configuration skips status checking
9544 between bytes while doing read or write bursts.
9545 @end deffn
9546
9547 @subsection Registers commands
9548 @deffn Command {addreg} [name] [address] [feature] [reg_group]
9549 Add a new register in the cpu register list. This register will be
9550 included in the generated target descriptor file.
9551
9552 @strong{[feature]} must be "org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group[0..10]".
9553
9554 @strong{[reg_group]} can be anything. The default register list defines "system",
9555 "dmmu", "immu", "dcache", "icache", "mac", "debug", "perf", "power", "pic"
9556 and "timer" groups.
9557
9558 @emph{example:}
9559 @example
9560 addreg rtest 0x1234 org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group0 system
9561 @end example
9562
9563
9564 @end deffn
9565 @deffn Command {readgroup} (@option{group})
9566 Display all registers in @emph{group}.
9567
9568 @emph{group} can be "system",
9569 "dmmu", "immu", "dcache", "icache", "mac", "debug", "perf", "power", "pic",
9570 "timer" or any new group created with addreg command.
9571 @end deffn
9572
9573 @section RISC-V Architecture
9574
9575 @uref{http://riscv.org/, RISC-V} is a free and open ISA. OpenOCD supports JTAG
9576 debug of RV32 and RV64 cores in heterogeneous multicore systems of up to 32
9577 harts. (It's possible to increase this limit to 1024 by changing
9578 RISCV_MAX_HARTS in riscv.h.) OpenOCD primarily supports 0.13 of the RISC-V
9579 Debug Specification, but there is also support for legacy targets that
9580 implement version 0.11.
9581
9582 @subsection RISC-V Terminology
9583
9584 A @emph{hart} is a hardware thread. A hart may share resources (eg. FPU) with
9585 another hart, or may be a separate core. RISC-V treats those the same, and
9586 OpenOCD exposes each hart as a separate core.
9587
9588 @subsection RISC-V Debug Configuration Commands
9589
9590 @deffn Command {riscv expose_csrs} n0[-m0][,n1[-m1]]...
9591 Configure a list of inclusive ranges for CSRs to expose in addition to the
9592 standard ones. This must be executed before `init`.
9593
9594 By default OpenOCD attempts to expose only CSRs that are mentioned in a spec,
9595 and then only if the corresponding extension appears to be implemented. This
9596 command can be used if OpenOCD gets this wrong, or a target implements custom
9597 CSRs.
9598 @end deffn
9599
9600 @deffn Command {riscv expose_custom} n0[-m0][,n1[-m1]]...
9601 The RISC-V Debug Specification allows targets to expose custom registers
9602 through abstract commands. (See Section 3.5.1.1 in that document.) This command
9603 configures a list of inclusive ranges of those registers to expose. Number 0
9604 indicates the first custom register, whose abstract command number is 0xc000.
9605 This command must be executed before `init`.
9606 @end deffn
9607
9608 @deffn Command {riscv set_command_timeout_sec} [seconds]
9609 Set the wall-clock timeout (in seconds) for individual commands. The default
9610 should work fine for all but the slowest targets (eg. simulators).
9611 @end deffn
9612
9613 @deffn Command {riscv set_reset_timeout_sec} [seconds]
9614 Set the maximum time to wait for a hart to come out of reset after reset is
9615 deasserted.
9616 @end deffn
9617
9618 @deffn Command {riscv set_scratch_ram} none|[address]
9619 Set the address of 16 bytes of scratch RAM the debugger can use, or 'none'.
9620 This is used to access 64-bit floating point registers on 32-bit targets.
9621 @end deffn
9622
9623 @deffn Command {riscv set_prefer_sba} on|off
9624 When on, prefer to use System Bus Access to access memory. When off, prefer to
9625 use the Program Buffer to access memory.
9626 @end deffn
9627
9628 @deffn Command {riscv set_ir} (@option{idcode}|@option{dtmcs}|@option{dmi}) [value]
9629 Set the IR value for the specified JTAG register. This is useful, for
9630 example, when using the existing JTAG interface on a Xilinx FPGA by
9631 way of BSCANE2 primitives that only permit a limited selection of IR
9632 values.
9633
9634 When utilizing version 0.11 of the RISC-V Debug Specification,
9635 @option{dtmcs} and @option{dmi} set the IR values for the DTMCONTROL
9636 and DBUS registers, respectively.
9637 @end deffn
9638
9639 @subsection RISC-V Authentication Commands
9640
9641 The following commands can be used to authenticate to a RISC-V system. Eg. a
9642 trivial challenge-response protocol could be implemented as follows in a
9643 configuration file, immediately following @command{init}:
9644 @example
9645 set challenge [riscv authdata_read]
9646 riscv authdata_write [expr $challenge + 1]
9647 @end example
9648
9649 @deffn Command {riscv authdata_read}
9650 Return the 32-bit value read from authdata.
9651 @end deffn
9652
9653 @deffn Command {riscv authdata_write} value
9654 Write the 32-bit value to authdata.
9655 @end deffn
9656
9657 @subsection RISC-V DMI Commands
9658
9659 The following commands allow direct access to the Debug Module Interface, which
9660 can be used to interact with custom debug features.
9661
9662 @deffn Command {riscv dmi_read}
9663 Perform a 32-bit DMI read at address, returning the value.
9664 @end deffn
9665
9666 @deffn Command {riscv dmi_write} address value
9667 Perform a 32-bit DMI write of value at address.
9668 @end deffn
9669
9670 @anchor{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing}
9671 @section Software Debug Messages and Tracing
9672 @cindex Linux-ARM DCC support
9673 @cindex tracing
9674 @cindex libdcc
9675 @cindex DCC
9676 OpenOCD can process certain requests from target software, when
9677 the target uses appropriate libraries.
9678 The most powerful mechanism is semihosting, but there is also
9679 a lighter weight mechanism using only the DCC channel.
9680
9681 Currently @command{target_request debugmsgs}
9682 is supported only for @option{arm7_9} and @option{cortex_m} cores.
9683 These messages are received as part of target polling, so
9684 you need to have @command{poll on} active to receive them.
9685 They are intrusive in that they will affect program execution
9686 times. If that is a problem, @pxref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.
9687
9688 See @file{libdcc} in the contrib dir for more details.
9689 In addition to sending strings, characters, and
9690 arrays of various size integers from the target,
9691 @file{libdcc} also exports a software trace point mechanism.
9692 The target being debugged may
9693 issue trace messages which include a 24-bit @dfn{trace point} number.
9694 Trace point support includes two distinct mechanisms,
9695 each supported by a command:
9696
9697 @itemize
9698 @item @emph{History} ... A circular buffer of trace points
9699 can be set up, and then displayed at any time.
9700 This tracks where code has been, which can be invaluable in
9701 finding out how some fault was triggered.
9702
9703 The buffer may overflow, since it collects records continuously.
9704 It may be useful to use some of the 24 bits to represent a
9705 particular event, and other bits to hold data.
9706
9707 @item @emph{Counting} ... An array of counters can be set up,
9708 and then displayed at any time.
9709 This can help establish code coverage and identify hot spots.
9710
9711 The array of counters is directly indexed by the trace point
9712 number, so trace points with higher numbers are not counted.
9713 @end itemize
9714
9715 Linux-ARM kernels have a ``Kernel low-level debugging
9716 via EmbeddedICE DCC channel'' option (CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC,
9717 depends on CONFIG_DEBUG_LL) which uses this mechanism to
9718 deliver messages before a serial console can be activated.
9719 This is not the same format used by @file{libdcc}.
9720 Other software, such as the U-Boot boot loader, sometimes
9721 does the same thing.
9722
9723 @deffn Command {target_request debugmsgs} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{charmsg}]
9724 Displays current handling of target DCC message requests.
9725 These messages may be sent to the debugger while the target is running.
9726 The optional @option{enable} and @option{charmsg} parameters
9727 both enable the messages, while @option{disable} disables them.
9728
9729 With @option{charmsg} the DCC words each contain one character,
9730 as used by Linux with CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC;
9731 otherwise the libdcc format is used.
9732 @end deffn
9733
9734 @deffn Command {trace history} [@option{clear}|count]
9735 With no parameter, displays all the trace points that have triggered
9736 in the order they triggered.
9737 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace history records.
9738 With a @var{count} parameter, allocates space for that many
9739 history records.
9740 @end deffn
9741
9742 @deffn Command {trace point} [@option{clear}|identifier]
9743 With no parameter, displays all trace point identifiers and how many times
9744 they have been triggered.
9745 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace point counters.
9746 With a numeric @var{identifier} parameter, creates a new a trace point counter
9747 and associates it with that identifier.
9748
9749 @emph{Important:} The identifier and the trace point number
9750 are not related except by this command.
9751 These trace point numbers always start at zero (from server startup,
9752 or after @command{trace point clear}) and count up from there.
9753 @end deffn
9754
9755
9756 @node JTAG Commands
9757 @chapter JTAG Commands
9758 @cindex JTAG Commands
9759 Most general purpose JTAG commands have been presented earlier.
9760 (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}, @ref{Reset Configuration}, and @ref{TAP Declaration}.)
9761 Lower level JTAG commands, as presented here,
9762 may be needed to work with targets which require special
9763 attention during operations such as reset or initialization.
9764
9765 To use these commands you will need to understand some
9766 of the basics of JTAG, including:
9767
9768 @itemize @bullet
9769 @item A JTAG scan chain consists of a sequence of individual TAP
9770 devices such as a CPUs.
9771 @item Control operations involve moving each TAP through the same
9772 standard state machine (in parallel)
9773 using their shared TMS and clock signals.
9774 @item Data transfer involves shifting data through the chain of
9775 instruction or data registers of each TAP, writing new register values
9776 while the reading previous ones.
9777 @item Data register sizes are a function of the instruction active in
9778 a given TAP, while instruction register sizes are fixed for each TAP.
9779 All TAPs support a BYPASS instruction with a single bit data register.
9780 @item The way OpenOCD differentiates between TAP devices is by
9781 shifting different instructions into (and out of) their instruction
9782 registers.
9783 @end itemize
9784
9785 @section Low Level JTAG Commands
9786
9787 These commands are used by developers who need to access
9788 JTAG instruction or data registers, possibly controlling
9789 the order of TAP state transitions.
9790 If you're not debugging OpenOCD internals, or bringing up a
9791 new JTAG adapter or a new type of TAP device (like a CPU or
9792 JTAG router), you probably won't need to use these commands.
9793 In a debug session that doesn't use JTAG for its transport protocol,
9794 these commands are not available.
9795
9796 @deffn Command {drscan} tap [numbits value]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
9797 Loads the data register of @var{tap} with a series of bit fields
9798 that specify the entire register.
9799 Each field is @var{numbits} bits long with
9800 a numeric @var{value} (hexadecimal encouraged).
9801 The return value holds the original value of each
9802 of those fields.
9803
9804 For example, a 38 bit number might be specified as one
9805 field of 32 bits then one of 6 bits.
9806 @emph{For portability, never pass fields which are more
9807 than 32 bits long. Many OpenOCD implementations do not
9808 support 64-bit (or larger) integer values.}
9809
9810 All TAPs other than @var{tap} must be in BYPASS mode.
9811 The single bit in their data registers does not matter.
9812
9813 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
9814 in that state.
9815 For example @sc{drpause} might be specified, so that more
9816 instructions can be issued before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
9817 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
9818
9819 @quotation Warning
9820 OpenOCD does not record information about data register lengths,
9821 so @emph{it is important that you get the bit field lengths right}.
9822 Remember that different JTAG instructions refer to different
9823 data registers, which may have different lengths.
9824 Moreover, those lengths may not be fixed;
9825 the SCAN_N instruction can change the length of
9826 the register accessed by the INTEST instruction
9827 (by connecting a different scan chain).
9828 @end quotation
9829 @end deffn
9830
9831 @deffn Command {flush_count}
9832 Returns the number of times the JTAG queue has been flushed.
9833 This may be used for performance tuning.
9834
9835 For example, flushing a queue over USB involves a
9836 minimum latency, often several milliseconds, which does
9837 not change with the amount of data which is written.
9838 You may be able to identify performance problems by finding
9839 tasks which waste bandwidth by flushing small transfers too often,
9840 instead of batching them into larger operations.
9841 @end deffn
9842
9843 @deffn Command {irscan} [tap instruction]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
9844 For each @var{tap} listed, loads the instruction register
9845 with its associated numeric @var{instruction}.
9846 (The number of bits in that instruction may be displayed
9847 using the @command{scan_chain} command.)
9848 For other TAPs, a BYPASS instruction is loaded.
9849
9850 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
9851 in that state.
9852 For example @sc{irpause} might be specified, so the data register
9853 can be loaded before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
9854 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
9855
9856 @quotation Note
9857 OpenOCD currently supports only a single field for instruction
9858 register values, unlike data register values.
9859 For TAPs where the instruction register length is more than 32 bits,
9860 portable scripts currently must issue only BYPASS instructions.
9861 @end quotation
9862 @end deffn
9863
9864 @deffn Command {pathmove} start_state [next_state ...]
9865 Start by moving to @var{start_state}, which
9866 must be one of the @emph{stable} states.
9867 Unless it is the only state given, this will often be the
9868 current state, so that no TCK transitions are needed.
9869 Then, in a series of single state transitions
9870 (conforming to the JTAG state machine) shift to
9871 each @var{next_state} in sequence, one per TCK cycle.
9872 The final state must also be stable.
9873 @end deffn
9874
9875 @deffn Command {runtest} @var{num_cycles}
9876 Move to the @sc{run/idle} state, and execute at least
9877 @var{num_cycles} of the JTAG clock (TCK).
9878 Instructions often need some time
9879 to execute before they take effect.
9880 @end deffn
9881
9882 @c tms_sequence (short|long)
9883 @c ... temporary, debug-only, other than USBprog bug workaround...
9884
9885 @deffn Command {verify_ircapture} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
9886 Verify values captured during @sc{ircapture} and returned
9887 during IR scans. Default is enabled, but this can be
9888 overridden by @command{verify_jtag}.
9889 This flag is ignored when validating JTAG chain configuration.
9890 @end deffn
9891
9892 @deffn Command {verify_jtag} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
9893 Enables verification of DR and IR scans, to help detect
9894 programming errors. For IR scans, @command{verify_ircapture}
9895 must also be enabled.
9896 Default is enabled.
9897 @end deffn
9898
9899 @section TAP state names
9900 @cindex TAP state names
9901
9902 The @var{tap_state} names used by OpenOCD in the @command{drscan},
9903 @command{irscan}, and @command{pathmove} commands are the same
9904 as those used in SVF boundary scan documents, except that
9905 SVF uses @sc{idle} instead of @sc{run/idle}.
9906
9907 @itemize @bullet
9908 @item @b{RESET} ... @emph{stable} (with TMS high);
9909 acts as if TRST were pulsed
9910 @item @b{RUN/IDLE} ... @emph{stable}; don't assume this always means IDLE
9911 @item @b{DRSELECT}
9912 @item @b{DRCAPTURE}
9913 @item @b{DRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
9914 through the data register
9915 @item @b{DREXIT1}
9916 @item @b{DRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; data register ready
9917 for update or more shifting
9918 @item @b{DREXIT2}
9919 @item @b{DRUPDATE}
9920 @item @b{IRSELECT}
9921 @item @b{IRCAPTURE}
9922 @item @b{IRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
9923 through the instruction register
9924 @item @b{IREXIT1}
9925 @item @b{IRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; instruction register ready
9926 for update or more shifting
9927 @item @b{IREXIT2}
9928 @item @b{IRUPDATE}
9929 @end itemize
9930
9931 Note that only six of those states are fully ``stable'' in the
9932 face of TMS fixed (low except for @sc{reset})
9933 and a free-running JTAG clock. For all the
9934 others, the next TCK transition changes to a new state.
9935
9936 @itemize @bullet
9937 @item From @sc{drshift} and @sc{irshift}, clock transitions will
9938 produce side effects by changing register contents. The values
9939 to be latched in upcoming @sc{drupdate} or @sc{irupdate} states
9940 may not be as expected.
9941 @item @sc{run/idle}, @sc{drpause}, and @sc{irpause} are reasonable
9942 choices after @command{drscan} or @command{irscan} commands,
9943 since they are free of JTAG side effects.
9944 @item @sc{run/idle} may have side effects that appear at non-JTAG
9945 levels, such as advancing the ARM9E-S instruction pipeline.
9946 Consult the documentation for the TAP(s) you are working with.
9947 @end itemize
9948
9949 @node Boundary Scan Commands
9950 @chapter Boundary Scan Commands
9951
9952 One of the original purposes of JTAG was to support
9953 boundary scan based hardware testing.
9954 Although its primary focus is to support On-Chip Debugging,
9955 OpenOCD also includes some boundary scan commands.
9956
9957 @section SVF: Serial Vector Format
9958 @cindex Serial Vector Format
9959 @cindex SVF
9960
9961 The Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{SVF}, is a
9962 way to represent JTAG test patterns in text files.
9963 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
9964 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
9965
9966 @deffn Command {svf} @file{filename} [@option{-tap @var{tapname}}] [@option{[-]quiet}] @
9967 [@option{[-]nil}] [@option{[-]progress}] [@option{[-]ignore_error}]
9968 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
9969 runs the SVF script from @file{filename}.
9970
9971 Arguments can be specified in any order; the optional dash doesn't
9972 affect their semantics.
9973
9974 Command options:
9975 @itemize @minus
9976 @item @option{-tap @var{tapname}} ignore IR and DR headers and footers
9977 specified by the SVF file with HIR, TIR, HDR and TDR commands;
9978 instead, calculate them automatically according to the current JTAG
9979 chain configuration, targeting @var{tapname};
9980 @item @option{[-]quiet} do not log every command before execution;
9981 @item @option{[-]nil} ``dry run'', i.e., do not perform any operations
9982 on the real interface;
9983 @item @option{[-]progress} enable progress indication;
9984 @item @option{[-]ignore_error} continue execution despite TDO check
9985 errors.
9986 @end itemize
9987 @end deffn
9988
9989 @section XSVF: Xilinx Serial Vector Format
9990 @cindex Xilinx Serial Vector Format
9991 @cindex XSVF
9992
9993 The Xilinx Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{XSVF}, is a
9994 binary representation of SVF which is optimized for use with
9995 Xilinx devices.
9996 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
9997 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
9998
9999 @quotation Important
10000 Not all XSVF commands are supported.
10001 @end quotation
10002
10003 @deffn Command {xsvf} (tapname|@option{plain}) filename [@option{virt2}] [@option{quiet}]
10004 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
10005 runs the XSVF script from @file{filename}.
10006 When a @var{tapname} is specified, the commands are directed at
10007 that TAP.
10008 When @option{virt2} is specified, the @sc{xruntest} command counts
10009 are interpreted as TCK cycles instead of microseconds.
10010 Unless the @option{quiet} option is specified,
10011 messages are logged for comments and some retries.
10012 @end deffn
10013
10014 The OpenOCD sources also include two utility scripts
10015 for working with XSVF; they are not currently installed
10016 after building the software.
10017 You may find them useful:
10018
10019 @itemize
10020 @item @emph{svf2xsvf} ... converts SVF files into the extended XSVF
10021 syntax understood by the @command{xsvf} command; see notes below.
10022 @item @emph{xsvfdump} ... converts XSVF files into a text output format;
10023 understands the OpenOCD extensions.
10024 @end itemize
10025
10026 The input format accepts a handful of non-standard extensions.
10027 These include three opcodes corresponding to SVF extensions
10028 from Lattice Semiconductor (LCOUNT, LDELAY, LDSR), and
10029 two opcodes supporting a more accurate translation of SVF
10030 (XTRST, XWAITSTATE).
10031 If @emph{xsvfdump} shows a file is using those opcodes, it
10032 probably will not be usable with other XSVF tools.
10033
10034
10035 @node Utility Commands
10036 @chapter Utility Commands
10037 @cindex Utility Commands
10038
10039 @section RAM testing
10040 @cindex RAM testing
10041
10042 There is often a need to stress-test random access memory (RAM) for
10043 errors. OpenOCD comes with a Tcl implementation of well-known memory
10044 testing procedures allowing the detection of all sorts of issues with
10045 electrical wiring, defective chips, PCB layout and other common
10046 hardware problems.
10047
10048 To use them, you usually need to initialise your RAM controller first;
10049 consult your SoC's documentation to get the recommended list of
10050 register operations and translate them to the corresponding
10051 @command{mww}/@command{mwb} commands.
10052
10053 Load the memory testing functions with
10054
10055 @example
10056 source [find tools/memtest.tcl]
10057 @end example
10058
10059 to get access to the following facilities:
10060
10061 @deffn Command {memTestDataBus} address
10062 Test the data bus wiring in a memory region by performing a walking
10063 1's test at a fixed address within that region.
10064 @end deffn
10065
10066 @deffn Command {memTestAddressBus} baseaddress size
10067 Perform a walking 1's test on the relevant bits of the address and
10068 check for aliasing. This test will find single-bit address failures
10069 such as stuck-high, stuck-low, and shorted pins.
10070 @end deffn
10071
10072 @deffn Command {memTestDevice} baseaddress size
10073 Test the integrity of a physical memory device by performing an
10074 increment/decrement test over the entire region. In the process every
10075 storage bit in the device is tested as zero and as one.
10076 @end deffn
10077
10078 @deffn Command {runAllMemTests} baseaddress size
10079 Run all of the above tests over a specified memory region.
10080 @end deffn
10081
10082 @section Firmware recovery helpers
10083 @cindex Firmware recovery
10084
10085 OpenOCD includes an easy-to-use script to facilitate mass-market
10086 devices recovery with JTAG.
10087
10088 For quickstart instructions run:
10089 @example
10090 openocd -f tools/firmware-recovery.tcl -c firmware_help
10091 @end example
10092
10093 @node TFTP
10094 @chapter TFTP
10095 @cindex TFTP
10096 If OpenOCD runs on an embedded host (as ZY1000 does), then TFTP can
10097 be used to access files on PCs (either the developer's PC or some other PC).
10098
10099 The way this works on the ZY1000 is to prefix a filename by
10100 "/tftp/ip/" and append the TFTP path on the TFTP
10101 server (tftpd). For example,
10102
10103 @example
10104 load_image /tftp/10.0.0.96/c:\temp\abc.elf
10105 @end example
10106
10107 will load c:\temp\abc.elf from the developer pc (10.0.0.96) into memory as
10108 if the file was hosted on the embedded host.
10109
10110 In order to achieve decent performance, you must choose a TFTP server
10111 that supports a packet size bigger than the default packet size (512 bytes). There
10112 are numerous TFTP servers out there (free and commercial) and you will have to do
10113 a bit of googling to find something that fits your requirements.
10114
10115 @node GDB and OpenOCD
10116 @chapter GDB and OpenOCD
10117 @cindex GDB
10118 OpenOCD complies with the remote gdbserver protocol and, as such, can be used
10119 to debug remote targets.
10120 Setting up GDB to work with OpenOCD can involve several components:
10121
10122 @itemize
10123 @item The OpenOCD server support for GDB may need to be configured.
10124 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
10125 @item GDB's support for OpenOCD may need configuration,
10126 as shown in this chapter.
10127 @item If you have a GUI environment like Eclipse,
10128 that also will probably need to be configured.
10129 @end itemize
10130
10131 Of course, the version of GDB you use will need to be one which has
10132 been built to know about the target CPU you're using. It's probably
10133 part of the tool chain you're using. For example, if you are doing
10134 cross-development for ARM on an x86 PC, instead of using the native
10135 x86 @command{gdb} command you might use @command{arm-none-eabi-gdb}
10136 if that's the tool chain used to compile your code.
10137
10138 @section Connecting to GDB
10139 @cindex Connecting to GDB
10140 Use GDB 6.7 or newer with OpenOCD if you run into trouble. For
10141 instance GDB 6.3 has a known bug that produces bogus memory access
10142 errors, which has since been fixed; see
10143 @url{http://osdir.com/ml/gdb.bugs.discuss/2004-12/msg00018.html}
10144
10145 OpenOCD can communicate with GDB in two ways:
10146
10147 @enumerate
10148 @item
10149 A socket (TCP/IP) connection is typically started as follows:
10150 @example
10151 target remote localhost:3333
10152 @end example
10153 This would cause GDB to connect to the gdbserver on the local pc using port 3333.
10154
10155 It is also possible to use the GDB extended remote protocol as follows:
10156 @example
10157 target extended-remote localhost:3333
10158 @end example
10159 @item
10160 A pipe connection is typically started as follows:
10161 @example
10162 target remote | openocd -c "gdb_port pipe; log_output openocd.log"
10163 @end example
10164 This would cause GDB to run OpenOCD and communicate using pipes (stdin/stdout).
10165 Using this method has the advantage of GDB starting/stopping OpenOCD for the debug
10166 session. log_output sends the log output to a file to ensure that the pipe is
10167 not saturated when using higher debug level outputs.
10168 @end enumerate
10169
10170 To list the available OpenOCD commands type @command{monitor help} on the
10171 GDB command line.
10172
10173 @section Sample GDB session startup
10174
10175 With the remote protocol, GDB sessions start a little differently
10176 than they do when you're debugging locally.
10177 Here's an example showing how to start a debug session with a
10178 small ARM program.
10179 In this case the program was linked to be loaded into SRAM on a Cortex-M3.
10180 Most programs would be written into flash (address 0) and run from there.
10181
10182 @example
10183 $ arm-none-eabi-gdb example.elf
10184 (gdb) target remote localhost:3333
10185 Remote debugging using localhost:3333
10186 ...
10187 (gdb) monitor reset halt
10188 ...
10189 (gdb) load
10190 Loading section .vectors, size 0x100 lma 0x20000000
10191 Loading section .text, size 0x5a0 lma 0x20000100
10192 Loading section .data, size 0x18 lma 0x200006a0
10193 Start address 0x2000061c, load size 1720
10194 Transfer rate: 22 KB/sec, 573 bytes/write.
10195 (gdb) continue
10196 Continuing.
10197 ...
10198 @end example
10199
10200 You could then interrupt the GDB session to make the program break,
10201 type @command{where} to show the stack, @command{list} to show the
10202 code around the program counter, @command{step} through code,
10203 set breakpoints or watchpoints, and so on.
10204
10205 @section Configuring GDB for OpenOCD
10206
10207 OpenOCD supports the gdb @option{qSupported} packet, this enables information
10208 to be sent by the GDB remote server (i.e. OpenOCD) to GDB. Typical information includes
10209 packet size and the device's memory map.
10210 You do not need to configure the packet size by hand,
10211 and the relevant parts of the memory map should be automatically
10212 set up when you declare (NOR) flash banks.
10213
10214 However, there are other things which GDB can't currently query.
10215 You may need to set those up by hand.
10216 As OpenOCD starts up, you will often see a line reporting
10217 something like:
10218
10219 @example
10220 Info : lm3s.cpu: hardware has 6 breakpoints, 4 watchpoints
10221 @end example
10222
10223 You can pass that information to GDB with these commands:
10224
10225 @example
10226 set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit 6
10227 set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit 4
10228 @end example
10229
10230 With that particular hardware (Cortex-M3) the hardware breakpoints
10231 only work for code running from flash memory. Most other ARM systems
10232 do not have such restrictions.
10233
10234 Rather than typing such commands interactively, you may prefer to
10235 save them in a file and have GDB execute them as it starts, perhaps
10236 using a @file{.gdbinit} in your project directory or starting GDB
10237 using @command{gdb -x filename}.
10238
10239 @section Programming using GDB
10240 @cindex Programming using GDB
10241 @anchor{programmingusinggdb}
10242
10243 By default the target memory map is sent to GDB. This can be disabled by
10244 the following OpenOCD configuration option:
10245 @example
10246 gdb_memory_map disable
10247 @end example
10248 For this to function correctly a valid flash configuration must also be set
10249 in OpenOCD. For faster performance you should also configure a valid
10250 working area.
10251
10252 Informing GDB of the memory map of the target will enable GDB to protect any
10253 flash areas of the target and use hardware breakpoints by default. This means
10254 that the OpenOCD option @command{gdb_breakpoint_override} is not required when
10255 using a memory map. @xref{gdbbreakpointoverride,,gdb_breakpoint_override}.
10256
10257 To view the configured memory map in GDB, use the GDB command @option{info mem}.
10258 All other unassigned addresses within GDB are treated as RAM.
10259
10260 GDB 6.8 and higher set any memory area not in the memory map as inaccessible.
10261 This can be changed to the old behaviour by using the following GDB command
10262 @example
10263 set mem inaccessible-by-default off
10264 @end example
10265
10266 If @command{gdb_flash_program enable} is also used, GDB will be able to
10267 program any flash memory using the vFlash interface.
10268
10269 GDB will look at the target memory map when a load command is given, if any
10270 areas to be programmed lie within the target flash area the vFlash packets
10271 will be used.
10272
10273 If the target needs configuring before GDB programming, set target
10274 event gdb-flash-erase-start:
10275 @example
10276 $_TARGETNAME configure -event gdb-flash-erase-start BODY
10277 @end example
10278 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}, for other GDB programming related events.
10279
10280 To verify any flash programming the GDB command @option{compare-sections}
10281 can be used.
10282
10283 @section Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector
10284 @cindex Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector
10285 @anchor{gdbmeminspect}
10286
10287 If your project controls more than a blinking LED, let's say a heavy industrial
10288 robot or an experimental nuclear reactor, stopping the controlling process
10289 just because you want to attach GDB is not a good option.
10290
10291 OpenOCD does not support GDB non-stop mode (might be implemented in the future).
10292 Though there is a possible setup where the target does not get stopped
10293 and GDB treats it as it were running.
10294 If the target supports background access to memory while it is running,
10295 you can use GDB in this mode to inspect memory (mainly global variables)
10296 without any intrusion of the target process.
10297
10298 Remove default setting of gdb-attach event. @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
10299 Place following command after target configuration:
10300 @example
10301 $_TARGETNAME configure -event gdb-attach @{@}
10302 @end example
10303
10304 If any of installed flash banks does not support probe on running target,
10305 switch off gdb_memory_map:
10306 @example
10307 gdb_memory_map disable
10308 @end example
10309
10310 Ensure GDB is configured without interrupt-on-connect.
10311 Some GDB versions set it by default, some does not.
10312 @example
10313 set remote interrupt-on-connect off
10314 @end example
10315
10316 If you switched gdb_memory_map off, you may want to setup GDB memory map
10317 manually or issue @command{set mem inaccessible-by-default off}
10318
10319 Now you can issue GDB command @command{target remote ...} and inspect memory
10320 of a running target. Do not use GDB commands @command{continue},
10321 @command{step} or @command{next} as they synchronize GDB with your target
10322 and GDB would require stopping the target to get the prompt back.
10323
10324 Do not use this mode under an IDE like Eclipse as it caches values of
10325 previously shown varibles.
10326
10327 @section RTOS Support
10328 @cindex RTOS Support
10329 @anchor{gdbrtossupport}
10330
10331 OpenOCD includes RTOS support, this will however need enabling as it defaults to disabled.
10332 It can be enabled by passing @option{-rtos} arg to the target. @xref{rtostype,,RTOS Type}.
10333
10334 @xref{Threads, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads,
10335 Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads, gdb, GDB manual}, for details about relevant
10336 GDB commands.
10337
10338 @* An example setup is below:
10339
10340 @example
10341 $_TARGETNAME configure -rtos auto
10342 @end example
10343
10344 This will attempt to auto detect the RTOS within your application.
10345
10346 Currently supported rtos's include:
10347 @itemize @bullet
10348 @item @option{eCos}
10349 @item @option{ThreadX}
10350 @item @option{FreeRTOS}
10351 @item @option{linux}
10352 @item @option{ChibiOS}
10353 @item @option{embKernel}
10354 @item @option{mqx}
10355 @item @option{uCOS-III}
10356 @item @option{nuttx}
10357 @item @option{hwthread} (This is not an actual RTOS. @xref{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb,,Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB}.)
10358 @end itemize
10359
10360 Before an RTOS can be detected, it must export certain symbols; otherwise, it cannot
10361 be used by OpenOCD. Below is a list of the required symbols for each supported RTOS.
10362
10363 @table @code
10364 @item eCos symbols
10365 Cyg_Thread::thread_list, Cyg_Scheduler_Base::current_thread.
10366 @item ThreadX symbols
10367 _tx_thread_current_ptr, _tx_thread_created_ptr, _tx_thread_created_count.
10368 @item FreeRTOS symbols
10369 @c The following is taken from recent texinfo to provide compatibility
10370 @c with ancient versions that do not support @raggedright
10371 @tex
10372 \begingroup
10373 \rightskip0pt plus2em \spaceskip.3333em \xspaceskip.5em\relax
10374 pxCurrentTCB, pxReadyTasksLists, xDelayedTaskList1, xDelayedTaskList2,
10375 pxDelayedTaskList, pxOverflowDelayedTaskList, xPendingReadyList,
10376 uxCurrentNumberOfTasks, uxTopUsedPriority.
10377 \par
10378 \endgroup
10379 @end tex
10380 @item linux symbols
10381 init_task.
10382 @item ChibiOS symbols
10383 rlist, ch_debug, chSysInit.
10384 @item embKernel symbols
10385 Rtos::sCurrentTask, Rtos::sListReady, Rtos::sListSleep,
10386 Rtos::sListSuspended, Rtos::sMaxPriorities, Rtos::sCurrentTaskCount.
10387 @item mqx symbols
10388 _mqx_kernel_data, MQX_init_struct.
10389 @item uC/OS-III symbols
10390 OSRunning, OSTCBCurPtr, OSTaskDbgListPtr, OSTaskQty
10391 @item nuttx symbols
10392 g_readytorun, g_tasklisttable
10393 @end table
10394
10395 For most RTOS supported the above symbols will be exported by default. However for
10396 some, eg. FreeRTOS and uC/OS-III, extra steps must be taken.
10397
10398 These RTOSes may require additional OpenOCD-specific file to be linked
10399 along with the project:
10400
10401 @table @code
10402 @item FreeRTOS
10403 contrib/rtos-helpers/FreeRTOS-openocd.c
10404 @item uC/OS-III
10405 contrib/rtos-helpers/uCOS-III-openocd.c
10406 @end table
10407
10408 @anchor{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb}
10409 @section Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB
10410 @cindex SMP
10411 @cindex RTOS
10412 @cindex hwthread
10413 OpenOCD includes a pseudo RTOS called @emph{hwthread} that presents CPU cores
10414 ("hardware threads") in an SMP system as threads to GDB. With this extension,
10415 GDB can be used to inspect the state of an SMP system in a natural way.
10416 After halting the system, using the GDB command @command{info threads} will
10417 list the context of each active CPU core in the system. GDB's @command{thread}
10418 command can be used to switch the view to a different CPU core.
10419 The @command{step} and @command{stepi} commands can be used to step a specific core
10420 while other cores are free-running or remain halted, depending on the
10421 scheduler-locking mode configured in GDB.
10422
10423 @section Legacy SMP core switching support
10424 @quotation Note
10425 This method is deprecated in favor of the @emph{hwthread} pseudo RTOS.
10426 @end quotation
10427
10428 For SMP support following GDB serial protocol packet have been defined :
10429 @itemize @bullet
10430 @item j - smp status request
10431 @item J - smp set request
10432 @end itemize
10433
10434 OpenOCD implements :
10435 @itemize @bullet
10436 @item @option{jc} packet for reading core id displayed by
10437 GDB connection. Reply is @option{XXXXXXXX} (8 hex digits giving core id) or
10438 @option{E01} for target not smp.
10439 @item @option{JcXXXXXXXX} (8 hex digits) packet for setting core id displayed at next GDB continue
10440 (core id -1 is reserved for returning to normal resume mode). Reply @option{E01}
10441 for target not smp or @option{OK} on success.
10442 @end itemize
10443
10444 Handling of this packet within GDB can be done :
10445 @itemize @bullet
10446 @item by the creation of an internal variable (i.e @option{_core}) by mean
10447 of function allocate_computed_value allowing following GDB command.
10448 @example
10449 set $_core 1
10450 #Jc01 packet is sent
10451 print $_core
10452 #jc packet is sent and result is affected in $
10453 @end example
10454
10455 @item by the usage of GDB maintenance command as described in following example (2 cpus in SMP with
10456 core id 0 and 1 @pxref{definecputargetsworkinginsmp,,Define CPU targets working in SMP}).
10457
10458 @example
10459 # toggle0 : force display of coreid 0
10460 define toggle0
10461 maint packet Jc0
10462 continue
10463 main packet Jc-1
10464 end
10465 # toggle1 : force display of coreid 1
10466 define toggle1
10467 maint packet Jc1
10468 continue
10469 main packet Jc-1
10470 end
10471 @end example
10472 @end itemize
10473
10474 @node Tcl Scripting API
10475 @chapter Tcl Scripting API
10476 @cindex Tcl Scripting API
10477 @cindex Tcl scripts
10478 @section API rules
10479
10480 Tcl commands are stateless; e.g. the @command{telnet} command has
10481 a concept of currently active target, the Tcl API proc's take this sort
10482 of state information as an argument to each proc.
10483
10484 There are three main types of return values: single value, name value
10485 pair list and lists.
10486
10487 Name value pair. The proc 'foo' below returns a name/value pair
10488 list.
10489
10490 @example
10491 > set foo(me) Duane
10492 > set foo(you) Oyvind
10493 > set foo(mouse) Micky
10494 > set foo(duck) Donald
10495 @end example
10496
10497 If one does this:
10498
10499 @example
10500 > set foo
10501 @end example
10502
10503 The result is:
10504
10505 @example
10506 me Duane you Oyvind mouse Micky duck Donald
10507 @end example
10508
10509 Thus, to get the names of the associative array is easy:
10510
10511 @verbatim
10512 foreach { name value } [set foo] {
10513 puts "Name: $name, Value: $value"
10514 }
10515 @end verbatim
10516
10517 Lists returned should be relatively small. Otherwise, a range
10518 should be passed in to the proc in question.
10519
10520 @section Internal low-level Commands
10521
10522 By "low-level," we mean commands that a human would typically not
10523 invoke directly.
10524
10525 @itemize @bullet
10526 @item @b{mem2array} <@var{varname}> <@var{width}> <@var{addr}> <@var{nelems}>
10527
10528 Read memory and return as a Tcl array for script processing
10529 @item @b{array2mem} <@var{varname}> <@var{width}> <@var{addr}> <@var{nelems}>
10530
10531 Convert a Tcl array to memory locations and write the values
10532 @item @b{flash banks} <@var{driver}> <@var{base}> <@var{size}> <@var{chip_width}> <@var{bus_width}> <@var{target}> [@option{driver options} ...]
10533
10534 Return information about the flash banks
10535
10536 @item @b{capture} <@var{command}>
10537
10538 Run <@var{command}> and return full log output that was produced during
10539 its execution. Example:
10540
10541 @example
10542 > capture "reset init"
10543 @end example
10544
10545 @end itemize
10546
10547 OpenOCD commands can consist of two words, e.g. "flash banks". The
10548 @file{startup.tcl} "unknown" proc will translate this into a Tcl proc
10549 called "flash_banks".
10550
10551 @section OpenOCD specific Global Variables
10552
10553 Real Tcl has ::tcl_platform(), and platform::identify, and many other
10554 variables. JimTCL, as implemented in OpenOCD creates $ocd_HOSTOS which
10555 holds one of the following values:
10556
10557 @itemize @bullet
10558 @item @b{cygwin} Running under Cygwin
10559 @item @b{darwin} Darwin (Mac-OS) is the underlying operating system.
10560 @item @b{freebsd} Running under FreeBSD
10561 @item @b{openbsd} Running under OpenBSD
10562 @item @b{netbsd} Running under NetBSD
10563 @item @b{linux} Linux is the underlying operating system
10564 @item @b{mingw32} Running under MingW32
10565 @item @b{winxx} Built using Microsoft Visual Studio
10566 @item @b{ecos} Running under eCos
10567 @item @b{other} Unknown, none of the above.
10568 @end itemize
10569
10570 Note: 'winxx' was chosen because today (March-2009) no distinction is made between Win32 and Win64.
10571
10572 @quotation Note
10573 We should add support for a variable like Tcl variable
10574 @code{tcl_platform(platform)}, it should be called
10575 @code{jim_platform} (because it
10576 is jim, not real tcl).
10577 @end quotation
10578
10579 @section Tcl RPC server
10580 @cindex RPC
10581
10582 OpenOCD provides a simple RPC server that allows to run arbitrary Tcl
10583 commands and receive the results.
10584
10585 To access it, your application needs to connect to a configured TCP port
10586 (see @command{tcl_port}). Then it can pass any string to the
10587 interpreter terminating it with @code{0x1a} and wait for the return
10588 value (it will be terminated with @code{0x1a} as well). This can be
10589 repeated as many times as desired without reopening the connection.
10590
10591 It is not needed anymore to prefix the OpenOCD commands with
10592 @code{ocd_} to get the results back. But sometimes you might need the
10593 @command{capture} command.
10594
10595 See @file{contrib/rpc_examples/} for specific client implementations.
10596
10597 @section Tcl RPC server notifications
10598 @cindex RPC Notifications
10599
10600 Notifications are sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
10601 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
10602
10603 Target event, state and reset notifications are emitted as Tcl associative arrays
10604 in the following format.
10605
10606 @verbatim
10607 type target_event event [event-name]
10608 type target_state state [state-name]
10609 type target_reset mode [reset-mode]
10610 @end verbatim
10611
10612 @deffn {Command} tcl_notifications [on/off]
10613 Toggle output of target notifications to the current Tcl RPC server.
10614 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
10615 Defaults to off.
10616
10617 @end deffn
10618
10619 @section Tcl RPC server trace output
10620 @cindex RPC trace output
10621
10622 Trace data is sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
10623 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
10624
10625 Target trace data is emitted as a Tcl associative array in the following format.
10626
10627 @verbatim
10628 type target_trace data [trace-data-hex-encoded]
10629 @end verbatim
10630
10631 @deffn {Command} tcl_trace [on/off]
10632 Toggle output of target trace data to the current Tcl RPC server.
10633 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
10634 Defaults to off.
10635
10636 See an example application here:
10637 @url{https://github.com/apmorton/OpenOcdTraceUtil} [OpenOcdTraceUtil]
10638
10639 @end deffn
10640
10641 @node FAQ
10642 @chapter FAQ
10643 @cindex faq
10644 @enumerate
10645 @anchor{faqrtck}
10646 @item @b{RTCK, also known as: Adaptive Clocking - What is it?}
10647 @cindex RTCK
10648 @cindex adaptive clocking
10649 @*
10650
10651 In digital circuit design it is often referred to as ``clock
10652 synchronisation'' the JTAG interface uses one clock (TCK or TCLK)
10653 operating at some speed, your CPU target is operating at another.
10654 The two clocks are not synchronised, they are ``asynchronous''
10655
10656 In order for the two to work together they must be synchronised
10657 well enough to work; JTAG can't go ten times faster than the CPU,
10658 for example. There are 2 basic options:
10659 @enumerate
10660 @item
10661 Use a special "adaptive clocking" circuit to change the JTAG
10662 clock rate to match what the CPU currently supports.
10663 @item
10664 The JTAG clock must be fixed at some speed that's enough slower than
10665 the CPU clock that all TMS and TDI transitions can be detected.
10666 @end enumerate
10667
10668 @b{Does this really matter?} For some chips and some situations, this
10669 is a non-issue, like a 500MHz ARM926 with a 5 MHz JTAG link;
10670 the CPU has no difficulty keeping up with JTAG.
10671 Startup sequences are often problematic though, as are other
10672 situations where the CPU clock rate changes (perhaps to save
10673 power).
10674
10675 For example, Atmel AT91SAM chips start operation from reset with
10676 a 32kHz system clock. Boot firmware may activate the main oscillator
10677 and PLL before switching to a faster clock (perhaps that 500 MHz
10678 ARM926 scenario).
10679 If you're using JTAG to debug that startup sequence, you must slow
10680 the JTAG clock to sometimes 1 to 4kHz. After startup completes,
10681 JTAG can use a faster clock.
10682
10683 Consider also debugging a 500MHz ARM926 hand held battery powered
10684 device that enters a low power ``deep sleep'' mode, at 32kHz CPU
10685 clock, between keystrokes unless it has work to do. When would
10686 that 5 MHz JTAG clock be usable?
10687
10688 @b{Solution #1 - A special circuit}
10689
10690 In order to make use of this,
10691 your CPU, board, and JTAG adapter must all support the RTCK
10692 feature. Not all of them support this; keep reading!
10693
10694 The RTCK ("Return TCK") signal in some ARM chips is used to help with
10695 this problem. ARM has a good description of the problem described at
10696 this link: @url{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} [checked
10697 28/nov/2008]. Link title: ``How does the JTAG synchronisation logic
10698 work? / how does adaptive clocking work?''.
10699
10700 The nice thing about adaptive clocking is that ``battery powered hand
10701 held device example'' - the adaptiveness works perfectly all the
10702 time. One can set a break point or halt the system in the deep power
10703 down code, slow step out until the system speeds up.
10704
10705 Note that adaptive clocking may also need to work at the board level,
10706 when a board-level scan chain has multiple chips.
10707 Parallel clock voting schemes are good way to implement this,
10708 both within and between chips, and can easily be implemented
10709 with a CPLD.
10710 It's not difficult to have logic fan a module's input TCK signal out
10711 to each TAP in the scan chain, and then wait until each TAP's RTCK comes
10712 back with the right polarity before changing the output RTCK signal.
10713 Texas Instruments makes some clock voting logic available
10714 for free (with no support) in VHDL form; see
10715 @url{http://tiexpressdsp.com/index.php/Adaptive_Clocking}
10716
10717 @b{Solution #2 - Always works - but may be slower}
10718
10719 Often this is a perfectly acceptable solution.
10720
10721 In most simple terms: Often the JTAG clock must be 1/10 to 1/12 of
10722 the target clock speed. But what that ``magic division'' is varies
10723 depending on the chips on your board.
10724 @b{ARM rule of thumb} Most ARM based systems require an 6:1 division;
10725 ARM11 cores use an 8:1 division.
10726 @b{Xilinx rule of thumb} is 1/12 the clock speed.
10727
10728 Note: most full speed FT2232 based JTAG adapters are limited to a
10729 maximum of 6MHz. The ones using USB high speed chips (FT2232H)
10730 often support faster clock rates (and adaptive clocking).
10731
10732 You can still debug the 'low power' situations - you just need to
10733 either use a fixed and very slow JTAG clock rate ... or else
10734 manually adjust the clock speed at every step. (Adjusting is painful
10735 and tedious, and is not always practical.)
10736
10737 It is however easy to ``code your way around it'' - i.e.: Cheat a little,
10738 have a special debug mode in your application that does a ``high power
10739 sleep''. If you are careful - 98% of your problems can be debugged
10740 this way.
10741
10742 Note that on ARM you may need to avoid using the @emph{wait for interrupt}
10743 operation in your idle loops even if you don't otherwise change the CPU
10744 clock rate.
10745 That operation gates the CPU clock, and thus the JTAG clock; which
10746 prevents JTAG access. One consequence is not being able to @command{halt}
10747 cores which are executing that @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
10748
10749 To set the JTAG frequency use the command:
10750
10751 @example
10752 # Example: 1.234MHz
10753 adapter speed 1234
10754 @end example
10755
10756
10757 @item @b{Win32 Pathnames} Why don't backslashes work in Windows paths?
10758
10759 OpenOCD uses Tcl and a backslash is an escape char. Use @{ and @}
10760 around Windows filenames.
10761
10762 @example
10763 > echo \a
10764
10765 > echo @{\a@}
10766 \a
10767 > echo "\a"
10768
10769 >
10770 @end example
10771
10772
10773 @item @b{Missing: cygwin1.dll} OpenOCD complains about a missing cygwin1.dll.
10774
10775 Make sure you have Cygwin installed, or at least a version of OpenOCD that
10776 claims to come with all the necessary DLLs. When using Cygwin, try launching
10777 OpenOCD from the Cygwin shell.
10778
10779 @item @b{Breakpoint Issue} I'm trying to set a breakpoint using GDB (or a front-end like Insight or
10780 Eclipse), but OpenOCD complains that "Info: arm7_9_common.c:213
10781 arm7_9_add_breakpoint(): sw breakpoint requested, but software breakpoints not enabled".
10782
10783 GDB issues software breakpoints when a normal breakpoint is requested, or to implement
10784 source-line single-stepping. On ARMv4T systems, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T or ARM920T,
10785 software breakpoints consume one of the two available hardware breakpoints.
10786
10787 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} When erasing or writing LPC2000 on-chip flash, the operation fails at random.
10788
10789 Make sure the core frequency specified in the @option{flash lpc2000} line matches the
10790 clock at the time you're programming the flash. If you've specified the crystal's
10791 frequency, make sure the PLL is disabled. If you've specified the full core speed
10792 (e.g. 60MHz), make sure the PLL is enabled.
10793
10794 @item @b{Amontec Chameleon} When debugging using an Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
10795 I keep getting "Error: amt_jtagaccel.c:184 amt_wait_scan_busy(): amt_jtagaccel timed
10796 out while waiting for end of scan, rtck was disabled".
10797
10798 Make sure your PC's parallel port operates in EPP mode. You might have to try several
10799 settings in your PC BIOS (ECP, EPP, and different versions of those).
10800
10801 @item @b{Data Aborts} When debugging with OpenOCD and GDB (plain GDB, Insight, or Eclipse),
10802 I get lots of "Error: arm7_9_common.c:1771 arm7_9_read_memory():
10803 memory read caused data abort".
10804
10805 The errors are non-fatal, and are the result of GDB trying to trace stack frames
10806 beyond the last valid frame. It might be possible to prevent this by setting up
10807 a proper "initial" stack frame, if you happen to know what exactly has to
10808 be done, feel free to add this here.
10809
10810 @b{Simple:} In your startup code - push 8 registers of zeros onto the
10811 stack before calling main(). What GDB is doing is ``climbing'' the run
10812 time stack by reading various values on the stack using the standard
10813 call frame for the target. GDB keeps going - until one of 2 things
10814 happen @b{#1} an invalid frame is found, or @b{#2} some huge number of
10815 stackframes have been processed. By pushing zeros on the stack, GDB
10816 gracefully stops.
10817
10818 @b{Debugging Interrupt Service Routines} - In your ISR before you call
10819 your C code, do the same - artificially push some zeros onto the stack,
10820 remember to pop them off when the ISR is done.
10821
10822 @b{Also note:} If you have a multi-threaded operating system, they
10823 often do not @b{in the intrest of saving memory} waste these few
10824 bytes. Painful...
10825
10826
10827 @item @b{JTAG Reset Config} I get the following message in the OpenOCD console (or log file):
10828 "Warning: arm7_9_common.c:679 arm7_9_assert_reset(): srst resets test logic, too".
10829
10830 This warning doesn't indicate any serious problem, as long as you don't want to
10831 debug your core right out of reset. Your .cfg file specified @option{reset_config
10832 trst_and_srst srst_pulls_trst} to tell OpenOCD that either your board,
10833 your debugger or your target uC (e.g. LPC2000) can't assert the two reset signals
10834 independently. With this setup, it's not possible to halt the core right out of
10835 reset, everything else should work fine.
10836
10837 @item @b{USB Power} When using OpenOCD in conjunction with Amontec JTAGkey and the Yagarto
10838 toolchain (Eclipse, arm-elf-gcc, arm-elf-gdb), the debugging seems to be
10839 unstable. When single-stepping over large blocks of code, GDB and OpenOCD
10840 quit with an error message. Is there a stability issue with OpenOCD?
10841
10842 No, this is not a stability issue concerning OpenOCD. Most users have solved
10843 this issue by simply using a self-powered USB hub, which they connect their
10844 Amontec JTAGkey to. Apparently, some computers do not provide a USB power
10845 supply stable enough for the Amontec JTAGkey to be operated.
10846
10847 @b{Laptops running on battery have this problem too...}
10848
10849 @item @b{GDB Disconnects} When using the Amontec JTAGkey, sometimes OpenOCD crashes with the following
10850 error message: "Error: gdb_server.c:101 gdb_get_char(): read: 10054".
10851 What does that mean and what might be the reason for this?
10852
10853 Error code 10054 corresponds to WSAECONNRESET, which means that the debugger (GDB)
10854 has closed the connection to OpenOCD. This might be a GDB issue.
10855
10856 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} In the configuration file in the section where flash device configurations
10857 are described, there is a parameter for specifying the clock frequency
10858 for LPC2000 internal flash devices (e.g. @option{flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000
10859 0x0 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME lpc2000_v1 14746 calc_checksum}), which must be
10860 specified in kilohertz. However, I do have a quartz crystal of a
10861 frequency that contains fractions of kilohertz (e.g. 14,745,600 Hz,
10862 i.e. 14,745.600 kHz). Is it possible to specify real numbers for the
10863 clock frequency?
10864
10865 No. The clock frequency specified here must be given as an integral number.
10866 However, this clock frequency is used by the In-Application-Programming (IAP)
10867 routines of the LPC2000 family only, which seems to be very tolerant concerning
10868 the given clock frequency, so a slight difference between the specified clock
10869 frequency and the actual clock frequency will not cause any trouble.
10870
10871 @item @b{Command Order} Do I have to keep a specific order for the commands in the configuration file?
10872
10873 Well, yes and no. Commands can be given in arbitrary order, yet the
10874 devices listed for the JTAG scan chain must be given in the right
10875 order (jtag newdevice), with the device closest to the TDO-Pin being
10876 listed first. In general, whenever objects of the same type exist
10877 which require an index number, then these objects must be given in the
10878 right order (jtag newtap, targets and flash banks - a target
10879 references a jtag newtap and a flash bank references a target).
10880
10881 You can use the ``scan_chain'' command to verify and display the tap order.
10882
10883 Also, some commands can't execute until after @command{init} has been
10884 processed. Such commands include @command{nand probe} and everything
10885 else that needs to write to controller registers, perhaps for setting
10886 up DRAM and loading it with code.
10887
10888 @anchor{faqtaporder}
10889 @item @b{JTAG TAP Order} Do I have to declare the TAPS in some
10890 particular order?
10891
10892 Yes; whenever you have more than one, you must declare them in
10893 the same order used by the hardware.
10894
10895 Many newer devices have multiple JTAG TAPs. For example:
10896 STMicroelectronics STM32 chips have two TAPs, a ``boundary scan TAP'' and
10897 ``Cortex-M3'' TAP. Example: The STM32 reference manual, Document ID:
10898 RM0008, Section 26.5, Figure 259, page 651/681, the ``TDI'' pin is
10899 connected to the boundary scan TAP, which then connects to the
10900 Cortex-M3 TAP, which then connects to the TDO pin.
10901
10902 Thus, the proper order for the STM32 chip is: (1) The Cortex-M3, then
10903 (2) The boundary scan TAP. If your board includes an additional JTAG
10904 chip in the scan chain (for example a Xilinx CPLD or FPGA) you could
10905 place it before or after the STM32 chip in the chain. For example:
10906
10907 @itemize @bullet
10908 @item OpenOCD_TDI(output) -> STM32 TDI Pin (BS Input)
10909 @item STM32 BS TDO (output) -> STM32 Cortex-M3 TDI (input)
10910 @item STM32 Cortex-M3 TDO (output) -> SM32 TDO Pin
10911 @item STM32 TDO Pin (output) -> Xilinx TDI Pin (input)
10912 @item Xilinx TDO Pin -> OpenOCD TDO (input)
10913 @end itemize
10914
10915 The ``jtag device'' commands would thus be in the order shown below. Note:
10916
10917 @itemize @bullet
10918 @item jtag newtap Xilinx tap -irlen ...
10919 @item jtag newtap stm32 cpu -irlen ...
10920 @item jtag newtap stm32 bs -irlen ...
10921 @item # Create the debug target and say where it is
10922 @item target create stm32.cpu -chain-position stm32.cpu ...
10923 @end itemize
10924
10925
10926 @item @b{SYSCOMP} Sometimes my debugging session terminates with an error. When I look into the
10927 log file, I can see these error messages: Error: arm7_9_common.c:561
10928 arm7_9_execute_sys_speed(): timeout waiting for SYSCOMP
10929
10930 TODO.
10931
10932 @end enumerate
10933
10934 @node Tcl Crash Course
10935 @chapter Tcl Crash Course
10936 @cindex Tcl
10937
10938 Not everyone knows Tcl - this is not intended to be a replacement for
10939 learning Tcl, the intent of this chapter is to give you some idea of
10940 how the Tcl scripts work.
10941
10942 This chapter is written with two audiences in mind. (1) OpenOCD users
10943 who need to understand a bit more of how Jim-Tcl works so they can do
10944 something useful, and (2) those that want to add a new command to
10945 OpenOCD.
10946
10947 @section Tcl Rule #1
10948 There is a famous joke, it goes like this:
10949 @enumerate
10950 @item Rule #1: The wife is always correct
10951 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
10952 @end enumerate
10953
10954 The Tcl equal is this:
10955
10956 @enumerate
10957 @item Rule #1: Everything is a string
10958 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
10959 @end enumerate
10960
10961 As in the famous joke, the consequences of Rule #1 are profound. Once
10962 you understand Rule #1, you will understand Tcl.
10963
10964 @section Tcl Rule #1b
10965 There is a second pair of rules.
10966 @enumerate
10967 @item Rule #1: Control flow does not exist. Only commands
10968 @* For example: the classic FOR loop or IF statement is not a control
10969 flow item, they are commands, there is no such thing as control flow
10970 in Tcl.
10971 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
10972 @* Actually what happens is this: There are commands that by
10973 convention, act like control flow key words in other languages. One of
10974 those commands is the word ``for'', another command is ``if''.
10975 @end enumerate
10976
10977 @section Per Rule #1 - All Results are strings
10978 Every Tcl command results in a string. The word ``result'' is used
10979 deliberately. No result is just an empty string. Remember: @i{Rule #1 -
10980 Everything is a string}
10981
10982 @section Tcl Quoting Operators
10983 In life of a Tcl script, there are two important periods of time, the
10984 difference is subtle.
10985 @enumerate
10986 @item Parse Time
10987 @item Evaluation Time
10988 @end enumerate
10989
10990 The two key items here are how ``quoted things'' work in Tcl. Tcl has
10991 three primary quoting constructs, the [square-brackets] the
10992 @{curly-braces@} and ``double-quotes''
10993
10994 By now you should know $VARIABLES always start with a $DOLLAR
10995 sign. BTW: To set a variable, you actually use the command ``set'', as
10996 in ``set VARNAME VALUE'' much like the ancient BASIC language ``let x
10997 = 1'' statement, but without the equal sign.
10998
10999 @itemize @bullet
11000 @item @b{[square-brackets]}
11001 @* @b{[square-brackets]} are command substitutions. It operates much
11002 like Unix Shell `back-ticks`. The result of a [square-bracket]
11003 operation is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything is a
11004 string}. These two statements are roughly identical:
11005 @example
11006 # bash example
11007 X=`date`
11008 echo "The Date is: $X"
11009 # Tcl example
11010 set X [date]
11011 puts "The Date is: $X"
11012 @end example
11013 @item @b{``double-quoted-things''}
11014 @* @b{``double-quoted-things''} are just simply quoted
11015 text. $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are expanded in place - the
11016 result however is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything
11017 is a string}
11018 @example
11019 set x "Dinner"
11020 puts "It is now \"[date]\", $x is in 1 hour"
11021 @end example
11022 @item @b{@{Curly-Braces@}}
11023 @*@b{@{Curly-Braces@}} are magic: $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are
11024 parsed, but are NOT expanded or executed. @{Curly-Braces@} are like
11025 'single-quote' operators in BASH shell scripts, with the added
11026 feature: @{curly-braces@} can be nested, single quotes can not. @{@{@{this is
11027 nested 3 times@}@}@} NOTE: [date] is a bad example;
11028 at this writing, Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command.
11029 @end itemize
11030
11031 @section Consequences of Rule 1/2/3/4
11032
11033 The consequences of Rule 1 are profound.
11034
11035 @subsection Tokenisation & Execution.
11036
11037 Of course, whitespace, blank lines and #comment lines are handled in
11038 the normal way.
11039
11040 As a script is parsed, each (multi) line in the script file is
11041 tokenised and according to the quoting rules. After tokenisation, that
11042 line is immediately executed.
11043
11044 Multi line statements end with one or more ``still-open''
11045 @{curly-braces@} which - eventually - closes a few lines later.
11046
11047 @subsection Command Execution
11048
11049 Remember earlier: There are no ``control flow''
11050 statements in Tcl. Instead there are COMMANDS that simply act like
11051 control flow operators.
11052
11053 Commands are executed like this:
11054
11055 @enumerate
11056 @item Parse the next line into (argc) and (argv[]).
11057 @item Look up (argv[0]) in a table and call its function.
11058 @item Repeat until End Of File.
11059 @end enumerate
11060
11061 It sort of works like this:
11062 @example
11063 for(;;)@{
11064 ReadAndParse( &argc, &argv );
11065
11066 cmdPtr = LookupCommand( argv[0] );
11067
11068 (*cmdPtr->Execute)( argc, argv );
11069 @}
11070 @end example
11071
11072 When the command ``proc'' is parsed (which creates a procedure
11073 function) it gets 3 parameters on the command line. @b{1} the name of
11074 the proc (function), @b{2} the list of parameters, and @b{3} the body
11075 of the function. Not the choice of words: LIST and BODY. The PROC
11076 command stores these items in a table somewhere so it can be found by
11077 ``LookupCommand()''
11078
11079 @subsection The FOR command
11080
11081 The most interesting command to look at is the FOR command. In Tcl,
11082 the FOR command is normally implemented in C. Remember, FOR is a
11083 command just like any other command.
11084
11085 When the ascii text containing the FOR command is parsed, the parser
11086 produces 5 parameter strings, @i{(If in doubt: Refer to Rule #1)} they
11087 are:
11088
11089 @enumerate 0
11090 @item The ascii text 'for'
11091 @item The start text
11092 @item The test expression
11093 @item The next text
11094 @item The body text
11095 @end enumerate
11096
11097 Sort of reminds you of ``main( int argc, char **argv )'' does it not?
11098 Remember @i{Rule #1 - Everything is a string.} The key point is this:
11099 Often many of those parameters are in @{curly-braces@} - thus the
11100 variables inside are not expanded or replaced until later.
11101
11102 Remember that every Tcl command looks like the classic ``main( argc,
11103 argv )'' function in C. In JimTCL - they actually look like this:
11104
11105 @example
11106 int
11107 MyCommand( Jim_Interp *interp,
11108 int *argc,
11109 Jim_Obj * const *argvs );
11110 @end example
11111
11112 Real Tcl is nearly identical. Although the newer versions have
11113 introduced a byte-code parser and interpreter, but at the core, it
11114 still operates in the same basic way.
11115
11116 @subsection FOR command implementation
11117
11118 To understand Tcl it is perhaps most helpful to see the FOR
11119 command. Remember, it is a COMMAND not a control flow structure.
11120
11121 In Tcl there are two underlying C helper functions.
11122
11123 Remember Rule #1 - You are a string.
11124
11125 The @b{first} helper parses and executes commands found in an ascii
11126 string. Commands can be separated by semicolons, or newlines. While
11127 parsing, variables are expanded via the quoting rules.
11128
11129 The @b{second} helper evaluates an ascii string as a numerical
11130 expression and returns a value.
11131
11132 Here is an example of how the @b{FOR} command could be
11133 implemented. The pseudo code below does not show error handling.
11134 @example
11135 void Execute_AsciiString( void *interp, const char *string );
11136
11137 int Evaluate_AsciiExpression( void *interp, const char *string );
11138
11139 int
11140 MyForCommand( void *interp,
11141 int argc,
11142 char **argv )
11143 @{
11144 if( argc != 5 )@{
11145 SetResult( interp, "WRONG number of parameters");
11146 return ERROR;
11147 @}
11148
11149 // argv[0] = the ascii string just like C
11150
11151 // Execute the start statement.
11152 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[1] );
11153
11154 // Top of loop test
11155 for(;;)@{
11156 i = Evaluate_AsciiExpression(interp, argv[2]);
11157 if( i == 0 )
11158 break;
11159
11160 // Execute the body
11161 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[3] );
11162
11163 // Execute the LOOP part
11164 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[4] );
11165 @}
11166
11167 // Return no error
11168 SetResult( interp, "" );
11169 return SUCCESS;
11170 @}
11171 @end example
11172
11173 Every other command IF, WHILE, FORMAT, PUTS, EXPR, everything works
11174 in the same basic way.
11175
11176 @section OpenOCD Tcl Usage
11177
11178 @subsection source and find commands
11179 @b{Where:} In many configuration files
11180 @* Example: @b{ source [find FILENAME] }
11181 @*Remember the parsing rules
11182 @enumerate
11183 @item The @command{find} command is in square brackets,
11184 and is executed with the parameter FILENAME. It should find and return
11185 the full path to a file with that name; it uses an internal search path.
11186 The RESULT is a string, which is substituted into the command line in
11187 place of the bracketed @command{find} command.
11188 (Don't try to use a FILENAME which includes the "#" character.
11189 That character begins Tcl comments.)
11190 @item The @command{source} command is executed with the resulting filename;
11191 it reads a file and executes as a script.
11192 @end enumerate
11193 @subsection format command
11194 @b{Where:} Generally occurs in numerous places.
11195 @* Tcl has no command like @b{printf()}, instead it has @b{format}, which is really more like
11196 @b{sprintf()}.
11197 @b{Example}
11198 @example
11199 set x 6
11200 set y 7
11201 puts [format "The answer: %d" [expr $x * $y]]
11202 @end example
11203 @enumerate
11204 @item The SET command creates 2 variables, X and Y.
11205 @item The double [nested] EXPR command performs math
11206 @* The EXPR command produces numerical result as a string.
11207 @* Refer to Rule #1
11208 @item The format command is executed, producing a single string
11209 @* Refer to Rule #1.
11210 @item The PUTS command outputs the text.
11211 @end enumerate
11212 @subsection Body or Inlined Text
11213 @b{Where:} Various TARGET scripts.
11214 @example
11215 #1 Good
11216 proc someproc @{@} @{
11217 ... multiple lines of stuff ...
11218 @}
11219 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO someproc
11220 #2 Good - no variables
11221 $_TARGETNAME configure -event foo "this ; that;"
11222 #3 Good Curly Braces
11223 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO @{
11224 puts "Time: [date]"
11225 @}
11226 #4 DANGER DANGER DANGER
11227 $_TARGETNAME configure -event foo "puts \"Time: [date]\""
11228 @end example
11229 @enumerate
11230 @item The $_TARGETNAME is an OpenOCD variable convention.
11231 @*@b{$_TARGETNAME} represents the last target created, the value changes
11232 each time a new target is created. Remember the parsing rules. When
11233 the ascii text is parsed, the @b{$_TARGETNAME} becomes a simple string,
11234 the name of the target which happens to be a TARGET (object)
11235 command.
11236 @item The 2nd parameter to the @option{-event} parameter is a TCBODY
11237 @*There are 4 examples:
11238 @enumerate
11239 @item The TCLBODY is a simple string that happens to be a proc name
11240 @item The TCLBODY is several simple commands separated by semicolons
11241 @item The TCLBODY is a multi-line @{curly-brace@} quoted string
11242 @item The TCLBODY is a string with variables that get expanded.
11243 @end enumerate
11244
11245 In the end, when the target event FOO occurs the TCLBODY is
11246 evaluated. Method @b{#1} and @b{#2} are functionally identical. For
11247 Method @b{#3} and @b{#4} it is more interesting. What is the TCLBODY?
11248
11249 Remember the parsing rules. In case #3, @{curly-braces@} mean the
11250 $VARS and [square-brackets] are expanded later, when the EVENT occurs,
11251 and the text is evaluated. In case #4, they are replaced before the
11252 ``Target Object Command'' is executed. This occurs at the same time
11253 $_TARGETNAME is replaced. In case #4 the date will never
11254 change. @{BTW: [date] is a bad example; at this writing,
11255 Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command@}
11256 @end enumerate
11257 @subsection Global Variables
11258 @b{Where:} You might discover this when writing your own procs @* In
11259 simple terms: Inside a PROC, if you need to access a global variable
11260 you must say so. See also ``upvar''. Example:
11261 @example
11262 proc myproc @{ @} @{
11263 set y 0 #Local variable Y
11264 global x #Global variable X
11265 puts [format "X=%d, Y=%d" $x $y]
11266 @}
11267 @end example
11268 @section Other Tcl Hacks
11269 @b{Dynamic variable creation}
11270 @example
11271 # Dynamically create a bunch of variables.
11272 for @{ set x 0 @} @{ $x < 32 @} @{ set x [expr $x + 1]@} @{
11273 # Create var name
11274 set vn [format "BIT%d" $x]
11275 # Make it a global
11276 global $vn
11277 # Set it.
11278 set $vn [expr (1 << $x)]
11279 @}
11280 @end example
11281 @b{Dynamic proc/command creation}
11282 @example
11283 # One "X" function - 5 uart functions.
11284 foreach who @{A B C D E@}
11285 proc [format "show_uart%c" $who] @{ @} "show_UARTx $who"
11286 @}
11287 @end example
11288
11289 @include fdl.texi
11290
11291 @node OpenOCD Concept Index
11292 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
11293 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
11294 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
11295 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
11296 @unnumbered OpenOCD Concept Index
11297
11298 @printindex cp
11299
11300 @node Command and Driver Index
11301 @unnumbered Command and Driver Index
11302 @printindex fn
11303
11304 @bye

Linking to existing account procedure

If you already have an account and want to add another login method you MUST first sign in with your existing account and then change URL to read https://review.openocd.org/login/?link to get to this page again but this time it'll work for linking. Thank you.

SSH host keys fingerprints

1024 SHA256:YKx8b7u5ZWdcbp7/4AeXNaqElP49m6QrwfXaqQGJAOk gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (DSA)
384 SHA256:jHIbSQa4REvwCFG4cq5LBlBLxmxSqelQPem/EXIrxjk gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
521 SHA256:UAOPYkU9Fjtcao0Ul/Rrlnj/OsQvt+pgdYSZ4jOYdgs gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:A13M5QlnozFOvTllybRZH6vm7iSt0XLxbA48yfc2yfY gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:spYMBqEYoAOtK7yZBrcwE8ZpYt6b68Cfh9yEVetvbXg gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ED25519)
+--[ED25519 256]--+
|=..              |
|+o..   .         |
|*.o   . .        |
|+B . . .         |
|Bo. = o S        |
|Oo.+ + =         |
|oB=.* = . o      |
| =+=.+   + E     |
|. .=o   . o      |
+----[SHA256]-----+
2048 SHA256:0Onrb7/PHjpo6iVZ7xQX2riKN83FJ3KGU0TvI0TaFG4 gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (RSA)